DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DM385 and DM388 DaVinci™ Digital Media Processor Check for Samples: DM385, DM388 1 High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) 1.1 Features 1234 • High-Performance DaVinci Digital Media Processors – Up to 1000-MHz ARM® Cortex™-A8 RISC Processor – Up to 2000 ARM Cortex-A8 MIPS • ARM Cortex-A8 Core – ARMv7 Architecture • In-Order, Dual-Issue, Superscalar Processor Core • NEON™ Multimedia Architecture • Supports Integer and Floating Point • Jazelle® RCT Execution Environment • ARM Cortex-A8 Memory Architecture – 32KB of Instruction and Data Caches – 256KB of L2 Cache with ECC – 64KB of RAM, 48KB of Boot ROM • 256KB of On-Chip Memory Controller (OCMC) RAM • Imaging Subsystem (ISS) – Camera Sensor Connection • Parallel Connection for Raw (up to 16-Bit) and BT.656/BT.1120 (8- or 16-Bit) • CSI2 Serial Connection – Image Sensor Interface (ISIF) for Handling Image and Video Data From the Camera Sensor – Image Pipe Interface (IPIPEIF) for Image and Video Data Connection Between Camera Sensor, ISIF, IPIPE, and DRAM – Image Pipe (IPIPE) for Real-Time Image and Video Processing – Resizer • Resizing Image and Video From 1/16x to 8x • Generating Two Different Resizing Outputs Concurrently • Hardware 3A Engine (H3A) for Generating Key Statistics for 3A (AE, AWB, and AF) Control • Face Detect (FD) Engine – Hardware Face Detection for up to 35 Faces Per Frame • Programmable High-Definition Video Image Coprocessing (HDVICP v2) Engine – Encode, Decode, Transcode Operations – H.264 BP/MP/HP, MPEG-2, VC-1, MPEG-4 SP/ASP, JPEG/MJPEG – Fourth-Generation Motion-Compensated Noise Filter (DM388 Only) • Media Controller – Controls the HDVPSS, HDVICP2, and ISS • Endianness – ARM Instructions and Data – Little Endian • HD Video Processing Subsystem (HDVPSS) – Two 165-MHz HD Video Capture Inputs • One 16- or 24-Bit Input, Splittable Into Dual 8-Bit SD Capture Ports • One 8-, 16-, or 24-Bit HD Input and 8-Bit SD Input Capture Port – Two 165-MHz HD Video Display Outputs • One 16-, 24-, or 30-Bit and One 16- or 24Bit Output – Component HD Analog Output – Composite Analog Output – Digital HDMI 1.3 Transmitter with Integrated PHY – Advanced Video Processing Features Such as Scan, Format, and Rate Conversion – Three Graphics Layers and Compositors • 32-Bit DDR2, DDR3, and DDR3L SDRAM Interface – Supports up to 400 MHz for DDR2, 533 MHz for DDR3, and 533 MHz for DDR3L – Up to Two x 16 Devices, 2GB of Total Address Space – Dynamic Memory Manager (DMM) • Programmable Multi-Zone Memory Mapping • Enables Efficient 2D Block Accesses • Supports Tiled Objects in 0°, 90°, 180°, or 270° Orientation and Mirroring 1 2 3 4 Please be aware that an important notice concerning availability, standard warranty, and use in critical applications of Texas Instruments semiconductor products and disclaimers thereto appears at the end of this data sheet. Device/BIOS, XDS are trademarks of Texas Instruments. Skype is a trademark of Skype. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. PRODUCTION DATA information is current as of publication date. Products conform to specifications per the terms of the Texas Instruments standard warranty. Production processing does not necessarily include testing of all parameters. Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com • General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) – 8- or 16-Bit Multiplexed Address and Data Bus – 512MB of Total Address Space Divided Among up to 8 Chip Selects – Glueless Interface to NOR Flash, NAND Flash (BCH/Hamming Error Code Detection), SRAM and Pseudo-SRAM – Error Locator Module (ELM) Outside of GPMC to Provide up to 16-Bit or 512-Byte Hardware ECC for NAND – Flexible Asynchronous Protocol Control for Interface to FPGA, CPLD, ASICs, and More • Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) Controller – Four Transfer Controllers – 64 Independent DMA Channels – 8 QDMA Channels • Ethernet Switch with Dual 10-, 100-, or 1000-Mbps External Interfaces (EMAC Software) – IEEE 802.3 Compliant (3.3-V I/O Only) – MII/RMII/GMII/RGMII Media Independent Interfaces – Management Data I/O (MDIO) Module – Reset Isolation – IEEE 1588 Time-Stamping and Industrial Ethernet Protocols • Dual USB 2.0 Ports with Integrated PHYs – USB2.0 High- and Full-Speed Clients – USB2.0 High-, Full-, and Low-Speed Hosts – Supports End Points 0-15 • One PCI Express 2.0 Port with Integrated PHY – Supported on • All DM385 Devices • DM388 Devices with PCIe Enabled – Single Port with 1 Lane at 5.0 GT/s – Configurable as Root Complex or Endpoint • Eight 32-Bit General-Purpose Timers (Timer1–8) • One System Watchdog Timer (WDT0) • Three Configurable UART/IrDA/CIR Modules – UART0 with Modem Control Signals – Supports up to 3.6864 Mbps – SIR, MIR, FIR (4.0 MBAUD), and CIR • Four Serial Peripheral Interfaces (SPIs) (up to 48 MHz) – Each with Four Chip Selects • Three MMC/SD/SDIO Serial Interfaces (up to 48 MHz) – Supporting up to 1-, 4-, or 8-Bit Modes 2 • Four Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C Bus™) Ports • Two Multichannel Audio Serial Ports (McASP) – Six Serializer Transmit and Receive Ports – Two Serializer Transmit and Receive Ports – DIT-Capable For S/PDIF (All Ports) • Four Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) Modules • Real-Time Clock (RTC) – One-Time or Periodic Interrupt Generation • Up to 125 General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Pins • One Spin Lock Module with up to 128 Hardware Semaphores • One Mailbox Module with 12 Mailboxes • On-Chip ARM ROM Bootloader (RBL) • Power, Reset, and Clock Management – SmartReflex™ Technology (Level 2b) – Multiple Independent Core Power Domains – Multiple Independent Core Voltage Domains – Support for Multiple Operating Points per Voltage Domain – Clock Enable and Disable Control for Subsystems and Peripherals • 32KB of Embedded Trace Buffer™ (ETB™) and 5-pin Trace Interface for Debug • IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Compatible • 609-Pin Pb-Free BGA Package (AAR Suffix), 0.8-mm Effective Pitch with Via Channel Technology to Reduce PCB Cost (0.5-mm Ball Spacing) • 45-nm CMOS Technology • 1.8- and 3.3-V Dual Voltage Buffers for General I/O High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 1.2 • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • • SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Applications IP Netcam Video IP Phones Embedded USB Encoding Cameras All Camera Applications HD Video Conferencing - Skype™ Endpoints Digital Signage Media Players and Adapters Mobile Medical Imaging Network Projectors Home Audio and Video Equipment Embedded Vision Portable Medical Imaging and Diagnostics and Patient Monitoring Remote Media Display Thin Clients Camcorders Digital Scanner Video Doorbells Digital Photo Frames Intrusion Control Panels with Video Access Control Panels with Video High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 3 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 1.3 www.ti.com Description DM385 and DM388 DaVinci Digital Media Processors are a highly integrated, cost-effective, low-power, programmable platform that leverages TI’s DaVinci processor technology to meet the processing needs of HD Video Conferencing - Skype endpoints, IP Netcam, Digital Signage, Media Players and Adapters, Mobile Medical Imaging, Network Projectors, Home Audio and Video Equipment, and similar devices in SD, HD, and 4K x 2K resolutions. The Programmable High-Definition Video Image Processor of the device supports 1080p60 of real time H.264BP/MP/HP video encode or decode. The included best-inclass H.264 encoder provides high-quality video encode for the lowest possible bit rate under all conditions, reducing valuable storage space to a minimum. In addition, the device also supports other video codecs such as MJPEG, MPEG-2, and MPEG-4. The device provides a full set of video preprocessing and postprocessing functions to ensure the best video quality. The low power consumption and high performance of the device makes it particularly suitable for portable and automotive applications. The DM388 is uniquely capable of running the Fourth-Generation Motion-Compensated Noise Filtering technology of TI. The device enables original-equipment manufacturers (OEMs) and original-design manufacturers (ODMs) to quickly bring to market devices featuring robust operating systems support, rich user interfaces, and high processing performance through the maximum flexibility of a fully integrated mixed processor solution. The device also combines programmable video and audio processing with a highly integrated peripheral set. The device processors include a high-definition video and imaging coprocessor 2 (HDVICP2), to off-load many video and imaging processing tasks for common video and imaging algorithms. Programmability is provided by an ARM Cortex-A8 RISC CPU with NEON extension and high-definition video and imaging coprocessors. The ARM lets developers separate control functions from A/V algorithms programmed on coprocessors, thus reducing the complexity of the system software. The ARM Cortex-A8 32-bit RISC processor with NEON floating-point extension includes: 32KB of instruction cache; 32KB of data cache; 256KB of L2 cache with ECC; 48KB of boot ROM; and 64KB of RAM. The rich peripheral set provides the ability to control external peripheral devices and communicate with external processors. For details on each peripheral, see the related sections in this document and the associated peripheral reference guides. The peripheral set includes: HD Video Processing Subsystem; Dual-Port Gigabit Ethernet MACs (10/100/1000 Mbps) (Ethernet Switch) with MII/RMII/GMII/RGMII and MDIO interface supporting IEEE 1588 Time-Stamping, and Industrial Ethernet Protocols; two USB ports with integrated 2.0 PHY; PCIe x1 GEN2-Compliant interface; two serializer McASP audio serial ports (with DIT mode); three UARTs with IrDA and CIR support; four SPI serial interfaces; a CSI2 serial connection; three MMC/SD/SDIO serial interfaces; four I2C master and slave interfaces; a parallel camera interface (CAM); up to 125 general-purpose I/Os (GPIOs); eight 32-bit general-purpose timers; system watchdog timer; DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L SDRAM interface; flexible 8- or 16-bit asynchronous memory interface; a Spin Lock; and Mailbox. Additionally, TI provides a complete set of development tools for the ARM which include C compilers and a Microsoft® Windows® debugger interface for visibility into source code execution. 4 High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 1.4 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Functional Block Diagram Figure 1-1 shows the functional block diagram of the device. RAM 64 KB Media Controller Subsystem Boot ROM 48 KB Face Detect (FD) 256 KB L2 Cache with ECC (1) 32 KB D-Cache Noise Filtering Engine 32 KB I-Cache 256 KB On-Chip RAM NEON FPU High Definition Video Image Coprocessor (HDVICP) ARM Subsystem CortexTM -A8 CPU Video Processing Subsystem Imaging Subsystem Video Capture Parallel Cam Input Display Processing CSI2 Serial Input HD OSD SD OSD IPIPE HD VENC SD VENC Resizer SD DAC H3A HDMI Xmt ICE Crusher HD DAC (3) System Interconnect Peripherals System Control Real-Time Clock PRCM GP Timer (8) JTAG GPIO (4) Serial Interfaces McASP (2) SPI (4) Watchdog Timer (1) (2) EMAC (R)(G)MII (2) GPMC + ELM DDR2/3 32-bit I2C (4) USB 2.0 Ctrl/PHY (2) MDIO (2) PCIe 2.0 (One x1 Port) MMC/SD/ SDIO (3) UART (3) Spinlock Connectivity Program/Data Storage EDMA Miscellaneous Mailbox Noise Filtering Engine is available only on DM388. PCIe is supported on all DM385 devices and also on DM388 devices with PCIe enabled. Figure 1-1. Functional Block Diagram High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 5 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com ......... 1 ............................................. 1 1.2 Applications .......................................... 3 1.3 Description ........................................... 4 1.4 Functional Block Diagram ........................... 5 Revision History .............................................. 7 2 Device Overview ........................................ 8 2.1 Device Comparison .................................. 8 2.2 Device Characteristics ............................... 8 2.3 Device Compatibility ................................ 10 1 High-Performance System-on-Chip (SoC) 1.1 4 5 6 .............................................. ........................................... 7.5 Interrupts .......................................... Peripheral Information and Timings ............. 8.1 Parameter Information ............................ 7.3 Reset 137 7.4 Clocking 145 159 162 8.3 Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) ARM® Cortex™-A8 Microprocessor Unit (Processor) Subsystem Overview .................. 10 8.4 EDMA ......................... 12 ................................ 12 2.7 Face Detect (FD) Overview ........................ 12 2.8 Spinlock Module Overview ......................... 13 2.9 Mailbox Module Overview .......................... 14 2.10 Memory Map Summary ............................. 15 Device Pins ............................................. 22 3.1 Pin Maps ........................................... 22 3.2 Pin Assignments .................................... 33 3.3 Terminal Functions ................................. 63 Device Configurations .............................. 108 4.1 Control Module Registers ......................... 108 4.2 Boot Modes ....................................... 108 4.3 Pin Multiplexing Control ........................... 115 4.4 Handling Unused Pins ............................ 117 4.5 DeBugging Considerations ........................ 117 System Interconnect ................................ 119 Device Operating Conditions ...................... 123 6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ....................... 123 6.2 Recommended Operating Conditions ............. 124 6.3 Reliability Data .................................... 126 8.5 2.5 Media Controller Overview 8.6 2.6 HDVICP2 Overview 8.7 8.8 Electrical Characteristics Over Recommended Ranges of Supply Voltage and Operating Temperature (Unless Otherwise Noted) .......... 127 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts 7.1 6 8 129 Power .............................................. 129 162 Recommended Clock and Control Signal Transition Behavior ........................................... 163 6.4 7 7.2 8.2 2.4 3 ............................................ Module Features ......... Power, Reset and Clock Management (PRCM) 129 165 168 172 181 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) and Error Location Module (ELM) ..................... 183 High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) ...... 198 High-Definition Video Processing Subsystem (HDVPSS) ......................................... 201 8.11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) 209 8.12 Imaging Subsystem (ISS) 212 8.14 8.15 8.16 ...................... ......................... DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller .......... Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) .......... 217 251 MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output (MMC/SD/SDIO) ........................... 256 Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) ..................................................... 258 .................. ............................................. 8.17 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) 8.18 8.19 Timers 267 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) ............................................ 269 .................... ............. 9.1 Device Support .................................... 9.2 Documentation Support ........................... 9.3 Community Resources ............................ Mechanical ............................................ 10.1 Thermal Data for the AAR ........................ 10.2 Packaging Information ............................ 8.20 10 164 8.9 8.10 8.13 9 ....................... ............................................. Emulation Features and Capability ............... Ethernet MAC Switch (EMAC SW) ................ General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) ............ 261 Universal Serial Bus (USB2.0) 271 Device and Documentation Support 273 Contents 273 275 275 276 276 276 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Revision History NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version. This revision history highlights the technical changes made to the document in the current revision. Revision History SEE Global ADDITIONS/MODIFICATIONS/DELETIONS Added notes specifying PCIe support on all DM385 devices and also on DM388 devices with PCIe enabled to: • Section 1.1, Features • Figure 1-1, Functional Block Diagram • Section 3.3.15, PCI Express (PCIe) Terminal Functions • Table 4-10, Pins Used in PCIe Bootmode • Section 8.16, Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) • Figure 9-1, Device Nomenclature Added support for 4K x 2K resolution: • Section 1.3, Description • Section 2.6, HDVICP2 Overview • Section 8.12, Imaging Subsystem (ISS) Added notes specifying OPP100 is supported only on DM388 commercial temperature devices to: • Section 6.2, Recommended Operating Conditions • Section 6.3, Reliability Data • Section 7.2.2.1, Dynamic Voltage Frequency Scaling • Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs) • Table 7-4, Supported OPP Combinations Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Changed OPP100 speed from 500 to 600 MHz for ARM Cortex-A8 in Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs). Removed requirement that the maximum voltage difference between CVDD and any other CVDD_x voltage domain must be < 150 mV. • Table 7-4, Supported OPP Combinations Contents Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 7 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 2 Device Overview 2.1 Device Comparison Table 2-1 shows a comparison between devices, highlighting the differences. Table 2-1. Device Comparison DEVICE FEATURE Noise Filtering Engine 2.2 DM385 DM388 NO YES Device Characteristics Table 2-2 provides an overview of the DM385 and DM388 DaVinci™ Digital Media Processors,, which includes significant features of the device, including the capacity of on-chip RAM, peripherals, and the package type with pin count. Table 2-2. Characteristics of the Processor HARDWARE FEATURES DM385/DM388 HD Video Processing Subsystem (HDVPSS) 1 16-/24-bit HD Capture Port or 2 8-bit SD Capture Ports and 1 8/16/24-bit HD Input Port and 1 8-bit SD Input Port and 1 16-/24-/30-bit HD Display Port or 1 HDMI 1.3 Transmitter and 1 16-/24-bit HD Display Port and 1 SD Video DAC and 3 HD Video DACs 1 Parallel Camera Input for Raw (up to 16bit) and BT.656/BT.1120 (8/16-bit) and 1 CSI2 Serial Input Imaging Subsystem (ISS) DDR2/3 Memory Controller Asynchronous (8-/16-bit bus width) RAM, NOR, NAND GPMC + ELM 64 Independent Channels 8 QDMA Channels EDMA 10/100/1000 Ethernet MAC Switch with Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) Peripherals 1 (with 2 MII/RMII/GMII/RGMII) 2 (Supports High- and Full-Speed as a Device and High-, Full-, and Low-Speed as a Host) USB 2.0 PCI Express 2.0 1 Port (5.0 GT/s lane) Not all peripherals pins are available at the same time (for Timers more details, see the Device Configurations section). 8 (32-bit General purpose) and 1 (System Watchdog) 3 (with SIR, MIR, FIR, CIR support and RTS/CTS flow control) (UART0 Supports Modem Interface) UART SPI 8 16-/32-bit Bus Width 4 (Each supporting up to 4 slave devices) Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 2-2. Characteristics of the Processor (continued) HARDWARE FEATURES DM385/DM388 1 (1-bit or 4-bit or 8-bit modes) and 1 (8-bit mode) or 2 (1-bit or 4-bit modes) MMC/SD/SDIO I2C 4 Master or Slave Media Controller Controls HDVPSS, HDVICP2, and ISS 2 (6/2 Serializers, each with Transmit/Receive and DIT capability) McASP RTC 1 GPIO Up to 125 pins Spinlock Module 1 (up to 128 H/W Semaphores) Mailbox Module On-Chip Memory 1 (with 12 Mailboxes) Size (Bytes) 640KB RAM, 48KB ROM Organization ARM 32KB I-cache 32KB D-cache 256KB L2 Cache with ECC 64KB RAM 48KB Boot ROM ADDITIONAL SHARED MEMORY 256KB On-chip RAM JTAG BSDL ID DEVICE_ID Register (address location: 0x4814 0600) CPU Frequency MHz Cycle Time ns Voltage Core Logic (V) ARM® Cortex™-A8 up to 1000 MHz ARM® Cortex™ -A8 1.0 ns DEEP SLEEP, OPP100, OPP120, Turbo, Nitro I/O (V) Package 16 x 16 mm Process Technology μm Product Status Product Preview (PP), Advance Information (AI), or Production Data (PD) see Section 8.5.3.1, JTAG ID (JTAGID) Register Description 0.83 V – 1.35 V 1.35 V, 1.5 V, 1.8 V, 3.3 V 609-Pin BGA (AAR) [with Via Channel™ Technology] 0.045 μm PD Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 9 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 2.3 Device Compatibility 2.4 ARM® Cortex™-A8 Microprocessor Unit (Processor) Subsystem Overview The ARM® Cortex™-A8 Subsystem is designed to allow the ARM Cortex-A8 master control of the device. In general, the ARM Cortex-A8 is responsible for configuration and control of the various subsystems, peripherals, and external memories. The ARM Cortex-A8 Subsystem includes the following features: • ARM Cortex-A8 RISC processor: – ARMv7 ISA plus Thumb2™, JazelleX™, and Media Extensions – NEON™ Floating-Point Unit – Enhanced Memory Management Unit (MMU) – Little Endian – 32KB L1 Instruction Cache – 32KB L1 Data Cache – 256KB L2 Cache with Error Correction Code (ECC) • CoreSight Embedded Trace Module (ETM) • ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) • Embedded PLL Controller (PLL_ARM) • 64KB Internal RAM • 48KB Internal Public ROM Figure 2-1 shows the ARM Cortex-A8 Subsystem for the device. DEVOSC L3 PLL_ARM 128 System Events DMM 128 128 128 128 32 128 32 ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) 64 48KB ROM 64 64KB RAM ARM Cortex-A8 128 Trace 32KB L1I$ 32KB L1D$ 256KB L2$ ETM NEON Arbiter Debug ICECrusher Figure 2-1. ARM Cortex-A8 Subsystem 2.4.1 ARM Cortex-A8 RISC Processor The ARM Cortex-A8 processor is a member of ARM Cortex family of general-purpose microprocessors. This processor is targeted at multi-tasking applications where full memory management, high performance, low die size, and low power are all important. The ARM Cortex-A8 processor supports the ARM debug architecture and includes logic to assist in both hardware and software debug. The ARM Cortex-A8 processor has a Harvard architecture and provides a complete high-performance subsystem, including: • ARM Cortex-A8 Integer Core • Superscalar ARMv7 Instruction Set • Thumb-2 Instruction Set • Jazelle RCT Acceleration • CP14 Debug Coprocessor 10 Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com • • • • • • • • 2.4.2 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 CP15 System Control Coprocessor NEON 64-/128-bit Hybrid SIMD Engine for Multimedia Enhanced VFPv3 Floating-Point Coprocessor Enhanced Memory Management Unit (MMU) Separate Level-1 Instruction and Data Caches Integrated Level-2 Cache with ECC Support 128-bit Interconnect with Level 3 Fast (L3) System Memories and Peripherals Embedded Trace Module (ETM). Embedded Trace Module (ETM) To support real-time trace, the ARM Cortex-A8 processor provides an interface to enable connection of an embedded trace module (ETM). The ETM consists of two parts: • The Trace port which provides real-time trace capability for the ARM Cortex-A8. • Triggering facilities that provide trigger resources, which include address and data comparators, counter, and sequencers. The ARM Cortex-A8 trace port is not pinned out and is, instead, only connected to the system-level Embedded Trace Buffer (ETB). The ETB has a 32KB buffer memory. ETB enabled debug tools are required to read/interpret the captured trace data. 2.4.3 ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) The ARM Cortex-A8 subsystem contains an interrupt controller (AINTC) that prioritizes all service requests from the system peripherals and generates either IRQ or FIQ to the ARM Cortex-A8 processor. 2.4.4 ARM Cortex-A8 PLL (PLL_ARM) The ARM Cortex-A8 subsystem contains an embedded PLL Controller (PLL_ARM) for generating the subsystem’s clocks from the device Clock input. 2.4.5 ARM Processor Interconnect The ARM Cortex-A8 processor is connected through the arbiter to the L3 interconnect port. The L3 interconnect port is 128-bits wide and provides access to the other device modules. Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 11 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2.5 www.ti.com Media Controller Overview The Media Controller has the responsibility of managing the HDVPSS, HDVICP2, and ISS modules. 2.6 HDVICP2 Overview The HDVICP2 is a Video Encoder/Decoder hardware accelerator supporting a range of encode, decode, and transcode operations for most major video codec standards. The main video Codec standards supported in hardware are MPEG1/2/4 ASP/SP, H.264 BL/MP/HP, VC-1 SP/MP/AP, RV9/10, AVS-1.0, and ON2 VP6.2/VP7. Supports up to 4K x 2K @ 15fps, 12Mpixels @ 10fps, 20Mpixels @ 6fps, and so on. The HDVICP2 hardware accelerator is composed of the following elements: • Motion estimation acceleration engine • Loop filter acceleration engine • Sequencer, including its memories and an interrupt controller • Intra-prediction estimation engine • Calculation engine • Motion compensation engine • Entropy coder/decoder • Video Direct Memory Access (DMA) • Synchronization boxes • Shared L2 controller • Local interconnect 2.7 Face Detect (FD) Overview The device Face Detection (FD) module performs face detection and tracking within a picture stored in memory. This module is typically used for video encoding, face-based priority auto-focusing, or red-eye removal. The FD module supports QVGA resolution inputs stored in DRR memory in 8-bit Luma format. In addition, it uses 51.25KB of DDR for its working memory. The FD module supports the following features: • Input image: – QVGA Input Image Size (H x V = 320 x 240) – 8-bit Gray Scale Data (0x00 = Black and 0xFF = White) 12 Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com • 2.8 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Detection Capabilities: – Face Inclination of ±45° – Face Direction: • Up/Down: ±30° • Left/Right: ±60° – Supported Detection Directions: • 0° Faces are Vertical • +90° Faces are Rotated Right by 90° • -90° Faces are Rotated Left by 90° • Supported Minimum Face Sizes of 20, 25, 32 or 40 Pixels – Supported Detection Start Positions: • X = 0 to 160 • Y = 0 to 120 – Supported Detection Area Sizes: • X = 160 to 320 • Y = 120 to 240 – Provides Size, Position, Angle, and Confidence Level for Each Face Spinlock Module Overview The Spinlock module provides hardware assistance for synchronizing the processes running on multiple processors in the device: • ARM Cortex-A8 processor • Media Controller The Spinlock module implements 128 spinlocks (or hardware semaphores) that provide an efficient way to perform a lock operation of a device resource using a single read-access, avoiding the need for a readmodify-write bus transfer of which the programmable cores are not capable. Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 13 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2.9 www.ti.com Mailbox Module Overview The device Mailbox module facilitates communication between the ARM Cortex-A8 and the Media Controller. It consists of twelve mailboxes, each supporting a 1-way communication between two of the above processors. The sender sends information to the receiver by writing a message to the mailbox registers. Interrupt signaling is used to notify the receiver that a message has been queued or to notify the sender about an overflow situation. The Mailbox module supports the following features (see Figure 2-2): • 12 mailboxes • Flexible mailbox-to-processor assignment scheme • Four-message FIFO depth for each message queue • 32-bit message width • Message reception and queue-not-full notification using interrupts • Three interrupts (one to ARM Cortex-A8 and two to Media Controller) Mailbox Module Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox Mailbox L4 Interconnect Interrupt ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Interrupt Media Controller Figure 2-2. Mailbox Module Block Diagram 14 Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2.10 Memory Map Summary The device has multiple on-chip memories associated with its processor and subsystems. To help simplify software development a unified memory map is used where possible to maintain a consistent view of device resources across all bus masters. 2.10.1 L3 Memory Map Table 2-3 shows the L3 memory map for all system masters (including Cortex-A8). For more details on the interconnect topology and connectivity across the L3 and L4 interconnects, see Section 5. Table 2-3. L3 Memory Map START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE DESCRIPTION 0x0000_0000 0x00FF_FFFF 16MB Reserved (BOOTROM) 0x1000_0000 0x1FFF_FFFF 496MB General Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) External Memory Space 0x2000_0000 0x2FFF_FFFF 256MB PCIe 0x3000_0000 0x3FFF_FFFF 256MB Reserved 0x4000_0000 0x4001_FFFF 128KB Reserved 0x4002_0000 0x4002_BFFF 48KB ARM Cortex-A8 ROM (Accessible by ARM Cortex-A8 only) 0x4002_C000 0x402E_FFFF 2832KB Reserved 0x402F_0000 0x402F_03FF 1KB Reserved 0x402F_0400 0x402F_FFFF 64KB - 1KB ARM Cortex-A8 RAM (Accessible by ARM Cortex-A8 only) 0x4030_0000 0x4033_FFFF 256KB OCMC SRAM 0x4034_0000 0x407F_FFFF 4864KB Reserved 0x4080_0000 0x4083_FFFF 256KB Reserved 0x4084_0000 0x40DF_FFFF 5888KB Reserved 0x40E0_0000 0x40E0_7FFF 32KB Reserved 0x40E0_8000 0x40EF_FFFF 992KB Reserved 0x40F0_0000 0x40F0_7FFF 32KB Reserved 0x40F0_8000 0x40FF_FFFF 992KB Reserved 0x4100_0000 0x41FF_FFFF 16MB Reserved 0x4200_0000 0x43FF_FFFF 32MB Reserved 0x4400_0000 0x443F_FFFF 4MB L3 Fast configuration registers 0x4440_0000 0x447F_FFFF 4MB L3 Mid configuration registers 0x4480_0000 0x44BF_FFFF 4MB L3 Slow configuration registers 0x44C0_0000 0x45FF_FFFF 20MB Reserved 0x4600_0000 0x463F_FFFF 4MB McASP0 Data Peripheral Registers 0x4640_0000 0x467F_FFFF 4MB McASP1 Data Peripheral Registers 0x4680_0000 0x46BF_FFFF 4MB Reserved 0x46C0_0000 0x46FF_FFFF 4MB HDMI 0x4700_0000 0x473F_FFFF 4MB Reserved 0x4740_0000 0x477F_FFFF 4MB USB 0x4780_0000 0x4780_FFFF 64KB Reserved 0x4781_0000 0x4781_1FFF 8KB MMC/SD/SDIO2 Peripheral Registers 0x4781_2000 0x47BF_FFFF 4MB - 72KB Reserved 0x47C0_0000 0x47FF FFFF 4MB Reserved 0x47C0_0000 0x47C0_BFFF 48KB Reserved Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 15 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 2-3. L3 Memory Map (continued) 16 START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE 0x47C0_C000 0x47C0_C3FF 1KB Reserved 0x47C0_C400 0x47C0_C7FF 1KB DDR PHY Registers 0x47C0_C800 0x47C0_CBFF 1KB Reserved 0x47C0_CC00 0x47C0_CFFF 1KB Reserved 0x47C0_D000 0x47FF FFFF 4052KB Reserved 0x4800_0000 0x48FF_FFFF 16MB L4 Slow Peripheral Domain (see Table 2-5) 0x4900_0000 0x490F_FFFF 1MB EDMA TPCC Registers 0x4910_0000 0x497F_FFFF 7MB Reserved 0x4980_0000 0x498F_FFFF 1MB EDMA TPTC0 Registers DESCRIPTION 0x4990_0000 0x499F_FFFF 1MB EDMA TPTC1 Registers 0x49A0_0000 0x49AF_FFFF 1MB EDMA TPTC2 Registers 0x49B0_0000 0x49BF_FFFF 1MB EDMA TPTC3 Registers 0x49C0_0000 0x49FF_FFFF 4MB Reserved 0x4A00_0000 0x4AFF_FFFF 16MB L4 Fast Peripheral Domain (see Table 2-4) 0x4B00_0000 0x4BFF_FFFF 16MB Emulation Subsystem 0x4C00_0000 0x4CFF_FFFF 16MB DDR Registers 0x4D00_0000 0x4DFF_FFFF 16MB Reserved 0x4E00_0000 0x4FFF_FFFF 32MB DDR DMM Registers 0x5000_0000 0x50FF_FFFF 16MB GPMC Registers 0x5100_0000 0x51FF_FFFF 16MB PCIE Registers 0x5200_0000 0x54FF_FFFF 48MB Reserved 0x5500_0000 0x55FF_FFFF 16MB Media Controller 0x5600_0000 0x56FF_FFFF 16MB Reserved 0x5700_0000 0x57FF_FFFF 16MB Reserved 0x5800_0000 0x58FF_FFFF 16MB HDVICP2 Configuration 0x5900_0000 0x59FF_FFFF 16MB HDVICP2 SL2 0x5A00_0000 0x5BFF_FFFF 32MB Reserved 0x5C00_0000 0x5DFF_FFFF 32MB ISS 0x5E00_0000 0x5FFF_FFFF 32MB Reserved 0x6000_0000 0x7FFF_FFFF 512MB DDR DMM Tiler Window (see Table 2-6) 0x8000_0000 0xFFFF_FFFF 2GB DDR 0x1 0000 0000 0x1 FFFF FFFF 4GB DDR DMM Tiler Extended Address Map (ISS and HDVPSS only) [see Table 2-6] Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2.10.2 L4 Memory Map The L4 Fast Peripheral Domain and L4 Slow Peripheral Domain regions of the memory maps above are broken out into Table 2-4 and Table 2-5. For more details on the interconnect topology and connectivity across the L3 and L4 interconnects, see , System Interconnect. 2.10.2.1 L4 Fast Peripheral Memory Map Table 2-4. L4 Fast Peripheral Memory Map Cortex-A8 and L3 Masters END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE 0x4A00_0000 0x4A00_07FF 2KB L4 Fast Configuration - Address/Protection (AP) 0x4A00_0800 0x4A00_0FFF 2KB L4 Fast Configuration - Link Agent (LA) 0x4A00_1000 0x4A00_13FF 1KB L4 Fast Configuration - Initiator Port (IP0) 0x4A00_1400 0x4A00_17FF 1KB L4 Fast Configuration - Initiator Port (IP1) 0x4A00_1800 0x4A00_1FFF 2KB Reserved 0x4A00_2000 0x4A07_FFFF 504KB Reserved 0x4A08_0000 0x4A09_FFFF 128KB Reserved 0x4A0A_0000 0x4A0A_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A0A_E000 0x4A0F_FFFF 380KB Reserved 0x4A10_0000 0x4A10_7FFF 32KB EMAC SW Peripheral Registers 0x4A10_8000 0x4A10_8FFF 4KB EMAC SW Interconnect Registers 0x4A14_0000 0x4A14_FFFF 64KB Reserved START ADDRESS (HEX) DEVICE NAME 0x4A15_0000 0x4A15_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A15_1000 0x4A17_FFFF 188KB Reserved 0x4A18_0000 0x4A1A_1FFF 136KB Reserved 0x4A1A_2000 0x4A1A_3FFF 8KB Reserved 0x4A1A_4000 0x4A1A_4FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_5000 0x4A1A_5FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_6000 0x4A1A_6FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_7000 0x4A1A_7FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_8000 0x4A1A_9FFF 8KB Reserved 0x4A1A_A000 0x4A1A_AFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_B000 0x4A1A_BFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_C000 0x4A1A_CFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_D000 0x4A1A_DFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1A_E000 0x4A1A_FFFF 8KB Reserved 0x4A1B_0000 0x4A1B_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1B_1000 0x4A1B_1FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1B_2000 0x4A1B_2FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1B_3000 0x4A1B_5FFF 12KB Reserved 0x4A1B_6000 0x4A1B_6FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4A1B_4000 0x4AFF_FFFF 14632KB Reserved Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 17 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 2.10.2.2 L4 Slow Peripheral Memory Map Table 2-5. L4 Slow Peripheral Memory Map Cortex-A8 and L3 Masters 18 START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE DEVICE NAME 0x4800_0000 0x4800_07FF 2KB L4 Slow Configuration – Address/Protection (AP) 0x4800_0800 0x4800_0FFF 2KB L4 Slow Configuration – Link Agent (LA) 0x4800_1000 0x4800_13FF 1KB L4 Slow Configuration – Initiator Port (IP0) 0x4800_1400 0x4800_17FF 1KB L4 Slow Configuration – Initiator Port (IP1) 0x4800_1800 0x4800_1FFF 2KB Reserved 0x4800_2000 0x4800_7FFF 24KB Reserved 0x4800_8000 0x4800_8FFF 32KB Reserved 0x4801_0000 0x4801_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4801_1000 0x4801_1FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4801_2000 0x4801_FFFF 56KB Reserved 0x4802_0000 0x4802_0FFF 4KB UART0 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_1000 0x4802_1FFF 4KB UART0 Interconnect Registers 0x4802_2000 0x4802_2FFF 4KB UART1 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_3000 0x4802_3FFF 4KB UART1 Interconnect Registers 0x4802_4000 0x4802_4FFF 4KB UART2 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_5000 0x4802_5FFF 4KB UART2 Interconnect Registers 0x4802_6000 0x4802_7FFF 8KB Reserved 0x4802_8000 0x4802_8FFF 4KB I2C0 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_9000 0x4802_9FFF 4KB I2C0 Interconnect Registers 0x4802_A000 0x4802_AFFF 4KB I2C1 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_B000 0x4802_BFFF 4KB I2C1 Interconnect Registers 0x4802_C000 0x4802_DFFF 8KB Reserved 0x4802_E000 0x4802_EFFF 4KB TIMER1 Peripheral Registers 0x4802_F000 0x4802_FFFF 4KB TIMER1 Interconnect Registers 0x4803_0000 0x4803_0FFF 4KB SPI0 Peripheral Registers 0x4803_1000 0x4803_1FFF 4KB SPI0 Interconnect Registers 0x4803_2000 0x4803_2FFF 4KB GPIO0 Peripheral Registers 0x4803_3000 0x4803_3FFF 4KB GPIO0 Interconnect Registers 0x4803_4000 0x4803_7FFF 16KB Reserved 0x4803_8000 0x4803_9FFF 8KB McASP0 CFG Peripheral Registers 0x4803_A000 0x4803_AFFF 4KB McASP0 CFG Interconnect Registers 0x4803_B000 0x4803_BFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4803_C000 0x4803_DFFF 8KB McASP1 CFG Peripheral Registers 0x4803_E000 0x4803_EFFF 4KB McASP1 CFG Interconnect Registers 0x4803_F000 0x4803_FFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4804_0000 0x4804_0FFF 4KB TIMER2 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_1000 0x4804_1FFF 4KB TIMER2 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_2000 0x4804_2FFF 4KB TIMER3 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_3000 0x4804_3FFF 4KB TIMER3 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_4000 0x4804_4FFF 4KB TIMER4 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_5000 0x4804_5FFF 4KB TIMER4 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_6000 0x4804_6FFF 4KB TIMER5 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_7000 0x4804_7FFF 4KB TIMER5 Interconnect Registers Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 2-5. L4 Slow Peripheral Memory Map (continued) Cortex-A8 and L3 Masters START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE DEVICE NAME 0x4804_8000 0x4804_8FFF 4KB TIMER6 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_9000 0x4804_9FFF 4KB TIMER6 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_A000 0x4804_AFFF 4KB TIMER7 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_B000 0x4804_BFFF 4KB TIMER7 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_C000 0x4804_CFFF 4KB GPIO1 Peripheral Registers 0x4804_D000 0x4804_DFFF 4KB GPIO1 Interconnect Registers 0x4804_E000 0x4804_FFFF 8KB Reserved 0x4805_0000 0x4805_1FFF 8KB Reserved 0x4805_2000 0x4805_2FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4805_3000 0x4805_FFFF 52KB Reserved 0x4806_0000 0x4806_FFFF 64KB MMC/SD/SDIO0 Peripheral Registers 0x4807_0000 0x4807_0FFF 4KB MMC/SD/SDIO0 Interconnect Registers 0x4807_1000 0x4807_FFFF 60KB Reserved 0x4808_0000 0x4808_FFFF 64KB ELM Peripheral Registers 0x4809_0000 0x4809_0FFF 4KB ELM Interconnect Registers 0x4809_1000 0x4809_FFFF 60KB Reserved 0x480A_0000 0x480A_FFFF 64KB Reserved 0x480B_0000 0x480B_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x480B_1000 0x480B_FFFF 60KB Reserved 0x480C_0000 0x480C_0FFF 4KB RTC Peripheral Registers 0x480C_1000 0x480C_1FFF 4KB RTC Interconnect Registers 0x480C_2000 0x480C_3FFF 8KB Reserved 0x480C_4000 0x480C_7FFF 16KB Reserved 0x480C_8000 0x480C_8FFF 4KB Mailbox Peripheral Registers 0x480C_9000 0x480C_9FFF 4KB Mailbox Interconnect Registers 0x480C_A000 0x480C_AFFF 4KB Spinlock Peripheral Registers 0x480C_B000 0x480C_BFFF 4KB Spinlock Interconnect Registers 0x480C_C000 0x480F_FFFF 208KB Reserved 0x4810_0000 0x4811_FFFF 128KB HDVPSS Peripheral Registers 0x4812_0000 0x4812_0FFF 4KB HDVPSS Interconnect Registers 0x4812_1000 0x4812_1FFF 4KB Reserved 0x4812_2000 0x4812_2FFF 4KB HDMI Peripheral Registers HDMI Interconnect Registers 0x4812_3000 0x4812_3FFF 4KB 0x4812_4000 0x4813_FFFF 112KB Reserved 0x4814_0000 0x4815_FFFF 128KB Control Module Peripheral Registers 0x4816_0000 0x4816_0FFF 4KB 0x4816_1000 0x4817_FFFF 124KB Control Module Interconnect Registers Reserved 0x4818_0000 0x4818_2FFF 12KB PRCM Peripheral Registers 0x4818_3000 0x4818_3FFF 4KB PRCM Interconnect Registers 0x4818_4000 0x4818_7FFF 16KB Reserved 0x4818_8000 0x4818_8FFF 4KB SmartReflex0 Peripheral Registers 0x4818_9000 0x4818_9FFF 4KB SmartReflex0 Interconnect Registers 0x4818_A000 0x4818_AFFF 4KB SmartReflex1 Peripheral Registers 0x4818_B000 0x4818_BFFF 4KB SmartReflex1 Interconnect Registers 0x4818_C000 0x4818_CFFF 4KB OCP Watchpoint Peripheral Registers 0x4818_D000 0x4818_DFFF 4KB OCP Watchpoint Interconnect Registers Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 19 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 2-5. L4 Slow Peripheral Memory Map (continued) Cortex-A8 and L3 Masters 20 START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE DEVICE NAME 0x4818_E000 0x4818_EFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4818_F000 0x4818_FFFF 4KB Reserved 0x4819_0000 0x4819_3FFF 16KB Reserved 0x4819_4000 0x4819_BFFF 32KB Reserved 0x4819_C000 0x481F_FFFF 400KB Reserved 0x4819_C000 0x4819_CFFF 4KB I2C2 Peripheral Registers 0x4819_D000 0x4819_DFFF 4KB I2C2 Interconnect Registers 0x4819_E000 0x4819_EFFF 4KB I2C3 Peripheral Registers 0x4819_F000 0x4819_FFFF 4KB I2C3 Interconnect Registers 0x481A_0000 0x481A_0FFF 4KB SPI1 Peripheral Registers 0x481A_1000 0x481A_1FFF 4KB SPI1 Interconnect Registers 0x481A_2000 0x481A_2FFF 4KB SPI2 Peripheral Registers 0x481A_3000 0x481A_3FFF 4KB SPI2 Interconnect Registers 0x481A_4000 0x481A_4FFF 4KB SPI3 Peripheral Registers 0x481A_5000 0x481A_5FFF 4KB SPI3 Interconnect Registers 0x481A_6000 0x481A_6FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_7000 0x481A_7FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_8000 0x481A_8FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_9000 0x481A_9FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_A000 0x481A_AFFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_B000 0x481A_BFFF 4KB Reserved 0x481A_C000 0x481A_CFFF 4KB GPIO2 Peripheral Registers 0x481A_D000 0x481A_DFFF 4KB GPIO2 Interconnect Registers 0x481A_E000 0x481A_EFFF 4KB GPIO3 Peripheral Registers 0x481A_F000 0x481A_FFFF 4KB GPIO3 Interconnect Registers 0x481B_0000 0x481B_FFFF 64KB Reserved 0x481C_0000 0x481C_0FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481C_1000 0x481C_1FFF 4KB TIMER8 Peripheral Registers 0x481C_2000 0x481C_2FFF 4KB TIMER8 Interconnect Registers 0x481C_3000 0x481C_3FFF 4KB SYNCTIMER32K Peripheral Registers 0x481C_4000 0x481C_4FFF 4KB SYNCTIMER32K Interconnect Registers 0x481C_5000 0x481C_5FFF 4KB PLLSS Peripheral Registers 0x481C_6000 0x481C_6FFF 4KB PLLSS Interconnect Registers 0x481C_7000 0x481C_7FFF 4KB WDT0 Peripheral Registers 0x481C_8000 0x481C_8FFF 4KB WDT0 Interconnect Registers 0x481C_9000 0x481C_9FFF 8KB Reserved 0x481C_A000 0x481C_BFFF 8KB Reserved 0x481C_C000 0x481C_DFFF 8KB Reserved 0x481C_E000 0x481C_FFFF 8KB Reserved 0x481D_0000 0x481D_1FFF 8KB Reserved 0x481D_2000 0x481D_3FFF 8KB Reserved 0x481D_4000 0x481D_5FFF 8KB Reserved 0x481D_6000 0x481D_6FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481D_7000 0x481D_7FFF 4KB Reserved 0x481D_8000 0x481E_7FFF 64KB MMC/SD/SDIO1 Peripheral Registers 0x481E_8000 0x481E_8FFF 4KB MMC/SD/SDIO1 Interconnect Registers Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 2-5. L4 Slow Peripheral Memory Map (continued) Cortex-A8 and L3 Masters (1) START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE DEVICE NAME 0x481E_9000 0x481F_FFFF 52KB Reserved 0x4820_0000 0x4820_0FFF 4KB Interrupt controller (1) 0x4820_1000 0x4823_FFFF 252KB 0x4824_0000 0x4824_0FFF 4KB 0x4824_1000 0x4827_FFFF 252KB 0x4828_0000 0x4828_0FFF 4KB 0x4828_1000 0x482F_FFFF 508KB Reserved (1) 0x4830_0000 0x48FF_FFFF 13MB Reserved Reserved (1) MPUSS config register (1) Reserved (1) SSM (1) These regions decoded internally by the Cortex™-A8 Subsystem and are not physically part of the L4 Slow. They are included here only for reference when considering the Cortex™-A8 Memory Map. For Masters other than the Cortex-A8 these regions are reserved. 2.10.3 DDR DMM TILER Extended Addressing Map The Tiler includes an additional 4-GBytes of addressing range, enabled by a 33rd address bit, to access the frame buffer in rotated and mirrored views. shows the details of the Tiler Extended Address Mapping. This entirety of this additional range is only accessible to the HDVPSS and ISS subsystems. However, other masters can access any one single view through the 512-MB Tiler region in the base 4GByte address memory map. Table 2-6. DDR DMM TILER Extended Address Mapping BLOCK NAME START ADDRESS (HEX) END ADDRESS (HEX) SIZE Tiler View 0 0x1 0000_0000 0x1 1FFF_FFFF 512MB Natural 0° View Tiler View 1 0x1 2000_0000 0x1 3FFF_FFFF 512MB 0° with Vertical Mirror View Tiler View 2 0x1 4000_0000 0x1 5FFF_FFFF 512MB 0° with Horizontal Mirror View Tiler View 3 0x1 6000_0000 0x1 7FFF_FFFF 512MB 180° View Tiler View 4 0x1 8000_0000 0x1 9FFF_FFFF 512MB 90° with Vertical Mirror View DESCRIPTION Tiler View 5 0x1 A000_0000 0x1 BFFF_FFFF 512MB 270° View Tiler View 6 0x1 C000_0000 0x1 DFFF_FFFF 512MB 90° View Tiler View 7 0x1 E000_0000 0x1 FFFF_FFFF 512MB 90° with Horizontal Mirror View Device Overview Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 21 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3 Device Pins 3.1 Pin Maps The following tables show the top view of the package pin assignments in eight pin maps. 22 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-1. AAR Ball Map [Section Top_Left - Top View] A B VSS VOUT[0]_R_CR[9] VOUT[0]_R_CR[8] VOUT[0]_R_CR[7] VOUT[0]_R_CR[5] VOUT[0]_R_CR[4] C D E UART0_RTS UART0_DCD UART0_CTS UART0_DTR F 31 30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[6] DEVOSC_MXI 29 UART0_DSR 28 VOUT[0]_R_CR[3] VOUT[0]_R_CR[2] UART0_TXD VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[4] 27 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[9] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[8] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[6] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[5] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[3] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[7] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[2] VSS VSS VSS USB1_ID USB1_VBUSIN VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[9] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[8] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[7] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[2] USB1_DP USB1_DM 26 25 24 23 22 USB0_VBUSIN 21 USB0_DP USB0_DM USB1_CE VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[3] VSS VOUT[0]_HSYNC USB0_ID USB0_CE VOUT[0]_AVID VSSA_USB VOUT[0]_VSYNC VSS 20 19 EMU1 18 EMU0 VIN[0]A_D[0] VIN[0]A_D[1] VIN[0]A_D[2] VIN[0]A_D[3] VIN[0]A_D[4] DVDD VIN[0]A_D[5] VIN[0]A_D[8]_BD[0] VIN[0]A_D[9]_BD[1] DVDD VIN[0]A_D[10]_BD[2] DVDD 17 16 Ball Map Position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 23 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-2. AAR Ball Map [Section Top_Left_Middle - Top View] G H J K L PCIE_TXN0 PCIE_TXP0 PCIE_RXP0 RSV27 M DEVOSC_MXO SERDES_CLKN VSSA_DEVOSC SERDES_CLKP PCIE_RXN0 SPI[0]_SCS[0] RSV40 SPI[1]_SCS[0] SPI[1]_SCLK SPI[0]_SCS[1] RSV3 SPI[0]_D[0] RSV54 VSS RSV1 SPI[0]_D[1] SPI[1]_D[1] VSS VSS UART0_RXD VDDA_PCIE_1P8 VSS RSV39 RSV0 VDDA_1P8 VSS RSV2 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[6] LDOCAP_SERDESCLK VSS VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[5] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[4] 31 30 RSV28 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 USB0_DRVVBUS 22 VOUT[0]_CLK UART2_RXD 21 UART2_TXD 20 VSS VIN[0]A_D[7] LDOCAP_ARMRAM VIN[0]A_D[6] VDDA_USB_3P3 VDDA_USB0_1P8 VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8 VDDA_USB_3P3 19 LDOCAP_ARM 18 CVDD_ARM 17 RSV4 VIN[0]A_D[11]_BD[3] VDDA_USB1_1P8 CVDD_ARM CVDD_ARM CVDD_ARM RSV5 VIN[0]A_D[13]_BD[5] VIN[0]A_D[12]_BD[4] VDDA_HDDAC_1P1 VSS VSS 16 Ball Map Position 24 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-3. AAR Ball Map [Section Top_Middle_Middle - Top View] N P RSV30 RSV31 RSV29 RSV43 R T U TMS AUXOSC_MXO RSV33 VSSA_AUXOSC RTCK TCLK SD1_DAT[2]_SDRW TDI DVDD DEVOSC_WAKE RSV55 I2C[0]_SCL DVDD UART0_RIN DVDD TDO VDDA_1P8 DVDD_SD DVDD_SD SPI[0]_SCLK I2C[0]_SDA TRST VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8 VSS V 31 30 RSV32 AUXOSC_MXI 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 SPI[1]_D[0] VDDA_1P8 22 VDDA_1P8 LDOCAP_RAM1 21 VDDS_OSC0_1P8 VSS VSS CVDD_HDVICP CVDD_HDVICP VDDS_OSC1_1P8 VSS VSS CVDD_HDVICP CVDD_HDVICP 20 VSSA_USB 19 VSSA_USB VSS 18 VSS VSS CVDD VSS VSS CVDD CVDD CVDD CVDD CVDD 17 VSS 16 VSS VSS Ball Map Position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 25 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-4. AAR Ball Map [Section Top_Right_Middle - Top View] W Y AA AB AC SD0_DAT[6] MCA[0]_AXR[3] SD0_CLK SD0_DAT[7] AD SD1_DAT[0] SD0_DAT[2]_SDRW SD1_CLK SD0_DAT[3] SD1_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD1_CMD SD0_CMD MCA[1]_ACLKR VSS SD0_DAT[0] MCA[0]_ACLKX SD1_DAT[3] VSS MCA[0]_AXR[5] VSS SD0_DAT[1]_SDIRQ MCA[0]_AXR[4] 31 30 MCA[0]_ACLKR 29 28 27 26 25 VSS VSS VSS LDOCAP_HDVICPRAM MCA[1]_AFSR VSS MCA[1]_ACLKX DDR[0]_A[10] 24 23 LDOCAP_HDVICP 22 CVDD_HDVICP MCA[1]_AXR[0] MCA[1]_AFSX MCA[1]_AXR[1] DDR[0]_CS[0] DDR[0]_A[1] 21 20 CVDD CVDD DDR[0]_RST CVDD CVDD VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8 DDR[0]_CKE 19 DDR[0]_D[29] DDR[0]_D[28] 18 VSS DVDD_DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] 17 VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS 16 DDR[0]_D[23] DDR[0]_D[22] Ball Map Position 26 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-5. AAR Ball Map [Section Top_Right - Top View] AE AF MCA[0]_AXR[1] AUD_CLKIN0 MCA[0]_AXR[2] MCA[0]_AFSR MCA[0]_AFSX MCA[0]_AXR[0] AG AH AJ NMI CLKIN32 POR RSTOUT_WD_OUT AK AL 31 VSS 30 AUD_CLKIN2 DDR[0]_A[6] DDR[0]_VTP DDR[0]_A[9] DDR[0]_A[8] 29 RESET 28 VSS DDR[0]_A[4] 27 VSS AUD_CLKIN1 DDR[0]_A[5] DDR[0]_A[3] DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_BA[0] DDR[0]_WE 26 VSS 25 VSS VSS VSS DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0]_CAS VSS VSS VSS RSV34 RSV35 DDR[0]_A[11] DDR[0]_A[0] VSS DDR[0]_BA[1] DDR[0]_A[7] DDR[0]_A[12] DDR[0]_A[2] DDR[0]_A[13] DDR[0]_A[14] 24 23 22 DDR[0]_A[15] 21 RSV42 DDR[0]_ODT[0] DDR[0]_DQS[3] 20 VSS VSS DDR[0]_D[31] VSS DDR[0]_D[30] DDR[0]_DQS[3] VSS DDR[0]_D[27] VSS DDR[0]_D[26] DDR[0]_D[25] DDR[0]_D[24] 19 18 DDR[0]_DQM[3] VREFSSTL_DDR[0] DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] 17 16 DVDD_DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] DDR[0]_D[21] DVDD_DDR[0] DDR[0]_D[20] DDR[0]_D[19] Ball Map Position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 27 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-6. AAR Ball Map [Section Bottom_Left - Top View] A B C D E F HDMI_CLKP HDMI_CLKN HDMI_DN0 HDMI_DP0 HDMI_DN1 VIN[0]A_VSYNC VIN[0]A_HSYNC DVDD_C VIN[0]A_D[14]_BD[6] HDMI_DN2 HDMI_DP1 VIN[0]A_DE DVDD_C VIN[0]A_D[17] DVDD_C HDMI_DP2 TV_RSET 15 14 13 12 11 10 TV_VFB0 9 HDDAC_A TV_OUT0 VIN[0]A_CLK HDDAC_VSYNC HDDAC_HSYNC VIN[0]A_D[20] HDDAC_B HDDAC_C VSSA_VDAC VSS VSS VSS HDDAC_VREF VIN[0]A_D[21] VIN[0]A_D[19] VSS VSS VIN[0]B_DE VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[1] VOUT[1]_VSYNC VOUT[1]_CLK VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[4] 8 7 6 VIN[0]A_D[22] HDDAC_IREF VIN[0]A_D[23] VIN[0]A_DE 5 4 VIN[0]A_FLD 3 VIN[0]B_FLD VOUT[0]_FLD VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[1] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[0] 2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[0] I2C[1]_SCL VOUT[1]_R_CR[1] I2C[1]_SDA VOUT[1]_HSYNC VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[3] 1 VSS VOUT[1]_AVID Ball Map Position 28 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-7. AAR Ball Map [Section Bottom_Left_Middle - Top View] G H J K L M 15 VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8 14 VDDA_VDAC_1P8 VDDA_HDMI_1P8 VDDA_HDDAC_1P8 CVDD_ARM VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8 CVDD_ARM 13 DVDD_C VIN[0]A_D[15]_BD[7] DVDD_C VIN[0]B_CLK VIN[0]A_FLD 12 VOUT[1]_R_CR[6] 11 VIN[0]A_D[16] VOUT[1]_R_CR[5] VIN[0]A_D[18] VOUT[1]_R_CR[7] 10 VOUT[1]_FLD 9 VSSA_HDMI VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[0] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[7] VSS VSSA_HDMI VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[4] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[2] VSS VSS VSS DVDD VSS VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[3] VOUT[1]_R_CR[2] DVDD VSS VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[9] DVDD GPMC_A[19] VSS VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[6] VOUT[1]_R_CR[3] DVDD VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[8] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[7] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[8] GPMC_A[18] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[6] VOUT[1]_R_CR[4] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[2] GPMC_A[17] 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[8] VOUT[1]_R_CR[9] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[5] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[9] 1 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[5] GPMC_A[16] Ball Map Position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 29 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-8. AAR Ball Map [Section Bottom_Middle_Middle - Top View] N P R T U V CVDD CVDD VSS CVDD CVDD VSS VSS VSS VSS VSSA_CSI2 15 14 VSS 13 VSS CVDD 12 VSS VSS VSS CVDD CVDD VSS VSS VSS CVDD CVDD LDOCAP_RAM0 VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8 GPMC_D[3] CSI2_DY[4] 11 DVDD 10 DVDD VDDA_1P8 9 GPMC_A[20] VDDA_1P8 VDDA_1P8 GPMC_A[23] GPMC_D[9] DVDD_GPMC DVDD_GPMC GPMC_D[10] DVDD_GPMC DVDD_GPMC GPMC_D[5] GPMC_D[11] DVDD_GPMC GPMC_D[12] GPMC_D[6] GPMC_D[13] GPMC_D[7] GPMC_D[14] GPMC_D[8] 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 GPMC_A[22] GPMC_D[15] 1 GPMC_A[21] CSI2_DX[4] Ball Map Position 30 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-9. AAR Ball Map [Section Bottom_Right_Middle - Top View] W Y AA AB AC AD VSS DVDD_DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] DDR[0]_D[18] DVDD_DDR[0] 15 14 CVDD CVDD VSS CVDD CVDD VSS 13 DDR[0]_D[13] 12 GPMC_CS[1] DDR[0]_D[11] GPMC_ ADV _ALE LDOCAP_RAM2 DDR[0]_D[10] 11 VDDA_L3L4_1P8 GPMC_BE[1] 10 VDDA_CSI2_1P8 9 GPMC_D[4] GPMC_CLK GPMC_CS[0] DDR[0]_D[5] 8 GPMC_WAIT[0] GPMC_OE_RE SD2_DAT[2]_SDRW RSV41 DVDD_RGMII DVDD_RGMII VSSA_CSI2 VSS GPMC_D[0] DVDD_RGMII SD2_SCLK VSS DVDD_RGMII GPMC_WE SD2_DAT[1]_SDIRQ VSS GPMC_D[1] DVDD_RGMII SD2_DAT[0] VSS GPMC_D[2] GPMC_ BE[0] _CLE GPMC_CS[2] VSS CSI2_DX[3] CSI2_DY[2] CSI2_DY[0] SD2_DAT[4] 7 6 5 4 3 2 CSI2_DX[2] CSI2_DX[0] CSI2_DX[1] CSI2_DY[1] 1 CSI2_DY[3] SD2_DAT[3] Ball Map Position 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 31 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-10. AAR Ball Map [Section Bottom_Right - Top View] AE AF AG AH AJ AK AL DVDD_DDR[0] DDR[0]_D[17] DVDD_DDR[0] DDR[0]_D[16] DDR[0]_DQM[2] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_D[15] DDR[0]_D[14] 15 14 13 DDR[0]_D[12] 12 VSS VSS DDR[0]_D[9] VSS DDR[0]_D[8] DDR[0]_DQM[1] DDR[0]_D[7] DDR[0]_D[6] VSS DDR[0]_D[4] DDR[0]_D[3] DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] 11 10 DDR[0]_D[2] 9 VSS 8 DDR[0]_D[0] DDR[0]_DQM[0] VSS EMAC[0]_MTXEN/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[2] EMAC[0]_MTXD[7]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[3] EMAC[0]_MTXD[6]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MTXD[5]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXC EMAC[0]_MTXD[4]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[2] VSS VSS VSS VSS EMAC[0]_MTXD[1]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[1] EMAC[0]_MTXD[2]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXCTL EMAC[0]_MRXDV/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[1] EMAC[0]_MTXD[0]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[3] EMAC[0]_GMTCLK/ EMAC[1]_RGRXC EMAC[0]_MRXD[7]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[1] EMAC[0]_MRXD[6]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[2] 7 6 VSS GPMC_CS[4] 5 VSS 4 DDR[0]_D[1] EMAC[0]_MTXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[0] EMAC[0]_MTCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGRXC SD2_DAT[7] MDIO EMAC[0]_MRXD[5]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[3] 3 2 SD2_DAT[6] GPMC_CS[3] MDCLK EMAC[0]_MCRS/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[2] EMAC_RMREFCLK EMAC[0]_MCOL/ EMAC[0]_RGRXCTL 1 SD2_DAT[5] EMAC[0]_MRXER/ EMAC[0]_RGTXCTL EMAC[0]_MRXD[4]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[3] EMAC[0]_MRXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXCTL EMAC[0]_MRXD[2]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[1] EMAC[0]_MRXD[0]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRXD[1]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGTXC VSS Ball Map Position 32 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 3.2 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Pin Assignments The following table provides a summary of the device signal ball assignments and characteristics. 1. BALL NUMBER: Package ball number(s) associated with each signal(s). 2. BALL NAME: The name of the package ball or terminal. Note: The table does not take into account subsystem terminal multiplexing options. 3. SIGNAL NAME: The signal name for that ball in the mode being used. 4. PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS: The name and address of the register that controls the pin’s internal pull-up/down resistors and multiplexing options. 5. PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE: The default value of the PINCNTL after reset. 6. MODE: The setting of the MUXMODE[10:0] bits in the associated PINCNTL register that selects this multiplexed signal option. 7. TYPE: Signal direction – I = Input – O = Output – I/O = Input/Output – D = Open drain – DS = Differential – A = Analog – PWR = Power – GND = Ground 8. DSIS: The deselected input state (DSIS) indicates the state driven on the peripheral input (logic "0", logic "1", or "PIN" level) when the peripheral pin function is not selected by any of the PINCNTLx registers. – 0: Logic 0 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – 1: Logic 1 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – PIN: The value on the pin is driven to the peripheral's input signal port. 9. BALL RESET STATE: The state of the ball during device reset. – 0: The buffer drives VOL (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 0(PD): The buffer drives VOL with an active pulldown resistor – 1: The buffer drives VOH (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 1(PU): The buffer drives VOH with an active pullup resistor – Z: High-impedance. – L: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – H : High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 10. BALL RESET REL. STATE: The state of the ball following the device coming out of reset. – 0: The buffer drives VOL (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 0(PD): The buffer drives VOL with an active pulldown resistor – 1: The buffer drives VOH (pulldown/pullup resistor not activated) 1(PU): The buffer drives VOH with an active pullup resistor – Z: High-impedance. – L: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – H : High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 11. POWER: The voltage supply that powers the terminal’s I/O buffers. 12. HYS: Indicates if the input buffer is with hysteresis. 13. BUFFER TYPE: Drive strength of the associated output buffer. Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 33 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) BALL NUMBER [1] AF31 BALL NAME [2] AUD_CLKIN0 SIGNAL NAME [3] AUD_CLKIN0 AUD_CLKIN1 PIN I/O PIN ATL_CLKOUT1 0x10 O PIN ATL_CLKOUT0 0x20 O PIN USB1_DRVVBUS 0x80 O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x04 I/O PIN ATL_CLKOUT2 0x10 O PIN EDMA_EVT3 0x20 I PIN TIM2_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP0[8] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x10 O PIN EDMA_EVT2 0x20 I PIN TIM3_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP0[9] 0x80 I/O PIN MCA[1]_AHCLKX AG30 AUD_CLKIN2 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I AUD_CLKIN2 ATL_CLKOUT3 PINCNTL15 / 0x4814 0838 PINCNTL16 / 0x4814 083C 0x000C 0000 MODE [6] 0x04 AUD_CLKIN1 PINCNTL14 / 0x4814 0834 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 MCA[0]_AHCLKX AF27 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x000C 0000 0x000C 0000 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD V30 AUXOSC_MXI AUXOSC_MXI NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDS_OSC1_1P8 U31 AUXOSC_MXO AUXOSC_MXO NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDS_OSC1_1P8 AJ31 CLKIN32 CLKIN32 PINCNTL259 / 0x4814 0C08 0x0004 0000 0x01 I PIN L L DVDD 0x04 O PIN TIM3_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP3[31] 0x80 I/O PIN CLKOUT0 AB2 CSI2_DX[0] CSI2_DX[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 AA1 CSI2_DX[1] CSI2_DX[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 AA2 CSI2_DX[2] CSI2_DX[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 W2 CSI2_DX[3] CSI2_DX[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 V1 CSI2_DX[4] CSI2_DX[4] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 AC2 CSI2_DY[0] CSI2_DY[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 AB1 CSI2_DY[1] CSI2_DY[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 Y2 CSI2_DY[2] CSI2_DY[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 34 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] W1 CSI2_DY[3] CSI2_DY[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 V2 CSI2_DY[4] CSI2_DY[4] NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_CSI2_1P8 P15, P17, R15, R17, T13, T17, T18, U11, U12, U15, U17, V11, V12, V15, V17, W13, W14, W19, W20, Y13, Y14, Y19, Y20 CVDD CVDD NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA K17, L17, L18, M13, M14, M17 CVDD_ARM CVDD_ARM NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA U20, U21, V20, V21, W22 CVDD_HDVICP CVDD_HDVICP NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA AL24 DDR[0]_A[0] DDR[0]_A[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AC22 DDR[0]_A[1] DDR[0]_A[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AJ23 DDR[0]_A[2] DDR[0]_A[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AJ27 DDR[0]_A[3] DDR[0]_A[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK28 DDR[0]_A[4] DDR[0]_A[4] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AH27 DDR[0]_A[5] DDR[0]_A[5] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK30 DDR[0]_A[6] DDR[0]_A[6] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AG23 DDR[0]_A[7] DDR[0]_A[7] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL29 DDR[0]_A[8] DDR[0]_A[8] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK29 DDR[0]_A[9] DDR[0]_A[9] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AD23 DDR[0]_A[10] DDR[0]_A[10] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK24 DDR[0]_A[11] DDR[0]_A[11] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AH23 DDR[0]_A[12] DDR[0]_A[12] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK23 DDR[0]_A[13] DDR[0]_A[13] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL23 DDR[0]_A[14] DDR[0]_A[14] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK22 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0]_A[15] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 35 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] AK26 DDR[0]_BA[0] DDR[0]_BA[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AF23 DDR[0]_BA[1] DDR[0]_BA[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AH25 DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_BA[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK25 DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0]_CAS NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AD20 DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0]_CKE NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AL27 DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_CLK NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AK27 DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_CLK NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AB21 DDR[0]_CS[0] DDR[0]_CS[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL9 DDR[0]_D[0] DDR[0]_D[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AK9 DDR[0]_D[1] DDR[0]_D[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AK10 DDR[0]_D[2] DDR[0]_D[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AJ11 DDR[0]_D[3] DDR[0]_D[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AH11 DDR[0]_D[4] DDR[0]_D[4] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AD9 DDR[0]_D[5] DDR[0]_D[5] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AF11 DDR[0]_D[6] DDR[0]_D[6] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AL12 DDR[0]_D[7] DDR[0]_D[7] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AJ12 DDR[0]_D[8] DDR[0]_D[8] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AG12 DDR[0]_D[9] DDR[0]_D[9] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AD12 DDR[0]_D[10] DDR[0]_D[10] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AB12 DDR[0]_D[11] DDR[0]_D[11] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AK13 DDR[0]_D[12] DDR[0]_D[12] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AC13 DDR[0]_D[13] DDR[0]_D[13] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AL14 DDR[0]_D[14] DDR[0]_D[14] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] 36 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] AK14 DDR[0]_D[15] DDR[0]_D[15] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AH15 DDR[0]_D[16] DDR[0]_D[16] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AF15 DDR[0]_D[17] DDR[0]_D[17] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AD15 DDR[0]_D[18] DDR[0]_D[18] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AK16 DDR[0]_D[19] DDR[0]_D[19] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AJ16 DDR[0]_D[20] DDR[0]_D[20] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AG16 DDR[0]_D[21] DDR[0]_D[21] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AD16 DDR[0]_D[22] DDR[0]_D[22] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AC16 DDR[0]_D[23] DDR[0]_D[23] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AK19 DDR[0]_D[24] DDR[0]_D[24] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AJ19 DDR[0]_D[25] DDR[0]_D[25] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AH19 DDR[0]_D[26] DDR[0]_D[26] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AF19 DDR[0]_D[27] DDR[0]_D[27] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AD19 DDR[0]_D[28] DDR[0]_D[28] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AC19 DDR[0]_D[29] DDR[0]_D[29] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AJ20 DDR[0]_D[30] DDR[0]_D[30] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AG20 DDR[0]_D[31] DDR[0]_D[31] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L L DVDD_DDR[0] AL8 DDR[0]_DQM[0] DDR[0]_DQM[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK12 DDR[0]_DQM[1] DDR[0]_DQM[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AJ15 DDR[0]_DQM[2] DDR[0]_DQM[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK18 DDR[0]_DQM[3] DDR[0]_DQM[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL11 DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AK11 DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 37 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] AK15 DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL15 DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AL17 DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AK17 DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AK20 DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AL20 DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AL21 DDR[0]_ODT[0] DDR[0]_ODT[0] NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AJ25 DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0]_RAS NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] AA20 DDR[0]_RST DDR[0]_RST NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L 0 DVDD_DDR[0] AL30 DDR[0]_VTP DDR[0]_VTP NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA DVDD_DDR[0] AL26 DDR[0]_WE DDR[0]_WE NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H 1 DVDD_DDR[0] F30 DEVOSC_MXI DEV_CLKIN NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDS_OSC0_1P8 0x01 I NA DEVOSC_MXI G31 DEVOSC_MXO DEVOSC_MXO NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDS_OSC0_1P8 U28 DEVOSC_WAKE DEVOSC_WAKE PINCNTL7 / 0x4814 0818 0x000E 0000 0x01 I 1 H H DVDD_SD 0x02 I/O 1 TIM5_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[7] 0x80 I/O PIN SPI[1]_SCS[1] D16, E17, F16, L5, DVDD M4, M6, M7, N10, N11, T26, T28, U27 DVDD NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA D12, E13, F12, G12, G13 DVDD_C NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA AB14, AB15, AB17, DVDD_DDR[0] AB18, AC15, AC17, AC18, AE15, AE16, AF16, AG15, AH16 DVDD_DDR[0] NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA R5, R7, T4, T6, T7 DVDD_GPMC DVDD_GPMC NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA W5, W7, Y4, Y6, Y7 DVDD_RGMII DVDD_RGMII NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA T25, U25 DVDD_SD NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA 38 DVDD_C DVDD_SD Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AL6 AH1 AH2 AK1 AJ6 AK2 AL2 AL3 BALL NAME [2] EMAC[0]_GMTCLK/ EMAC[1]_RGRXC EMAC[0]_MCOL/ EMAC[0]_RGRXCTL EMAC[0]_MCRS/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[2] EMAC[0]_MRCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGTXC EMAC[0]_MRXDV/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[1] EMAC[0]_MRXD[0]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRXD[1]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRXD[2]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[1] SIGNAL NAME [3] EMAC[0]_GMTCLK/ EMAC[1]_RGRXC PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I/O PIN GPMC_A[6] 0x10 O PIN SPI[2]_D[1] 0x20 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 VIN[1]B_D[1] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMRXD[0] 0x04 I PIN GP3[24] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 VIN[1]B_D[2] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMRXD[1] 0x04 I PIN GP3[25] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O 0 VIN[1]B_D[4] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMCRSDV 0x04 I 0 SPI[3]_SCS[2] 0x20 I/O 1 GP3[27] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O 0 GPMC_A[5] 0x10 O PIN SPI[2]_SCLK 0x20 I/O 1 0x01 I/O PIN VIN[1]B_D[5] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMTXD[0] 0x04 O PIN GP3[28] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN VIN[1]B_D[6] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMTXD[1] 0x04 O PIN GP3[29] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN VIN[1]B_D[7] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMTXEN 0x04 O PIN GP3[30] 0x80 I/O PIN EMAC[0]_MCRS/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[2] EMAC[0]_MRCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGTXC EMAC[0]_MRXDV/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[1] EMAC[0]_MRXD[0]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRXD[1]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MRXD[2]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[1] PINCNTL236 / 0x4814 0BAC PINCNTL237 / 0x4814 0BB0 PINCNTL239 / 0x4814 0BB8 PINCNTL248 / 0x4814 0BDC PINCNTL240 / 0x4814 0BBC PINCNTL241 / 0x4814 0BC0 PINCNTL242 / 0x4814 0BC4 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x01 EMAC[0]_MCOL/ EMAC[0]_RGRXCTL PINCNTL249 / 0x4814 0BE0 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x000C 0000 0x000C 0000 0x000C 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 39 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AK3 BALL NAME [2] EMAC[0]_MRXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXCTL AK4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[4]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[3] AJ4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[5]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[3] AL5 EMAC[0]_MRXD[6]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[2] AK5 EMAC[0]_MRXD[7]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[1] SIGNAL NAME [3] EMAC[0]_MRXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXCTL PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x0004 0000 PIN GPMC_A[27] 0x04 O PIN GPMC_A[26] 0x08 O PIN GPMC_A[0] 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN GPMC_A[4] 0x10 O PIN SPI[2]_SCS[3] 0x20 I/O 1 0x01 I/O 0 VIN[1]B_D[3] 0x02 I PIN EMAC[0]_RMRXER 0x04 I 0 GP3[26] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O 0 VIN[1]B_D[0] 0x02 I PIN SPI[3]_SCS[3] 0x20 I/O 1 I2C[2]_SDA 0x40 I/O 1 GP3[23] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN GPMC_A[7] 0x10 O PIN SPI[2]_D[0] 0x20 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXD[0] 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[9] 0x10 O PIN PINCNTL244 / 0x4814 0BCC 0x0004 0000 EMAC[0]_MRXD[5]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[3] PINCNTL245 / 0x4814 0BD0 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL246 / 0x4814 0BD4 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL247 / 0x4814 0BD8 0x0004 0000 GPMC_A[2] EMAC[0]_MRXD[6]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[2] GPMC_A[3] AG4 AK6 EMAC[0]_MRXER/ EMAC[0]_RGTXCTL EMAC[0]_MTCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGRXC EMAC[0]_MTXD[0]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[3] AJ7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[1]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[1] AK7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[2]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXCTL EMAC[0]_MRXD[7]/ EMAC[0]_RGTXD[1] EMAC[0]_MRXER/ EMAC[0]_RGTXCTL EMAC[0]_MTCLK/ EMAC[0]_RGRXC EMAC[0]_MTXD[0]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[3] EMAC[0]_MTXD[1]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[1] PINCNTL238 / 0x4814 0BB4 PINCNTL235 / 0x4814 0BA8 PINCNTL250 / 0x4814 0BE4 0x000C 0000 0x000C 0000 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL251 / 0x4814 0BE8 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL252 / 0x4814 0BEC 0x0004 0000 GPMC_A[8] 40 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I/O GPMC_A[1] AJ2 MODE [6] 0x01 EMAC[0]_MRXD[4]/ EMAC[0]_RGRXD[3] PINCNTL243 / 0x4814 0BC8 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] EMAC[0]_MTXD[2]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXCTL Device Pins BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AE4 AK8 AJ8 AH8 AG8 AF8 AG1 BALL NAME [2] EMAC[0]_MTXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[0] EMAC[0]_MTXD[4]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[2] EMAC[0]_MTXD[5]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXC EMAC[0]_MTXD[6]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MTXD[7]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[3] EMAC[0]_MTXEN/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[2] EMAC_RMREFCLK SIGNAL NAME [3] EMAC[0]_MTXD[3]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[0] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXD[1] 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[10] 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXER 0x02 I 0 GPMC_A[11] 0x10 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMCRSDV 0x02 I 0 GPMC_A[12] 0x10 O PIN UART1_RXD 0x20 I 1 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXD[0] 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[13] 0x10 O PIN UART1_TXD 0x20 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXD[1] 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[14] 0x10 O PIN UART1_CTS 0x20 I/O 1 0x01 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXEN 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[15] 0x10 O PIN UART1_RTS 0x20 O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x40 I/O PIN EMAC[0]_MTXD[5]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXC EMAC[0]_MTXD[6]/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[0] EMAC[0]_MTXD[7]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[3] EMAC[0]_MTXEN/ EMAC[1]_RGRXD[2] EMAC_RMREFCLK TIM2_IO PINCNTL254 / 0x4814 0BF4 PINCNTL255 / 0x4814 0BF8 PINCNTL256 / 0x4814 0BFC PINCNTL257 / 0x4814 0C00 PINCNTL258 / 0x4814 0C04 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x01 EMAC[0]_MTXD[4]/ EMAC[1]_RGTXD[2] PINCNTL253 / 0x4814 0BF0 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL232 / 0x4814 0B9C 0x0004 0000 GP1[10] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII L L DVDD_RGMII 0x80 I/O PIN A18 EMU0 EMU0 NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H H DVDD B19 EMU1 EMU1 NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA H H DVDD M1 GPMC_A[16] GPMC_A[16] PINCNTL105 / 0x4814 09A0 0x0004 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD_GPMC 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL106 / 0x4814 09A4 0x0004 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD_GPMC 0x80 I/O PIN GP2[5] M2 GPMC_A[17] GPMC_A[17] GP2[6] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 41 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] M3 BALL NAME [2] GPMC_A[18] SIGNAL NAME [3] GPMC_A[18] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x0004 0000 O PIN 0x40 I/O PIN PINCNTL108 / 0x4814 09AC 0x0004 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x40 I/O PIN PINCNTL109 / 0x4814 09B0 0x0006 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x04 I/O 1 PINCNTL110 / 0x4814 09B4 0x0004 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x04 I/O PIN PINCNTL111 / 0x4814 09B8 0x0006 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x04 I/O PIN HDMI_CEC 0x10 I/O 1 TIM4_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[17] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x04 I/O 1 HDMI_HPDET 0x10 I 0 TIM5_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[18] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN TIM5_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[28] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN EDMA_EVT1 0x20 I PIN TIM7_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[30] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN EDMA_EVT2 0x20 I PIN TIM6_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[29] 0x80 I/O PIN GP1[13] M5 GPMC_A[19] GPMC_A[19] TIM3_IO GP1[14] N9 GPMC_A[20] GPMC_A[20] SPI[2]_SCS[1] GP1[15] N1 GPMC_A[21] GPMC_A[21] SPI[2]_D[0] GP1[16] N2 GPMC_A[22] GPMC_A[22] SPI[2]_D[1] R8 GPMC_A[23] GPMC_A[23] SPI[2]_SCLK AA10 GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC_CS[6] Y11 GPMC_BE[1] GPMC_BE[1] GPMC_A[24] Y3 GPMC_BE[0]_CLE GPMC_BE[0]_CLE GPMC_A[25] 42 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 TIM2_IO PINCNTL107 / 0x4814 09A8 MODE [6] PINCNTL112 / 0x4814 09BC PINCNTL128 / 0x4814 09FC PINCNTL132 / 0x4814 0A0C PINCNTL131 / 0x4814 0A08 0x0004 0000 0x0006 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 Device Pins BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_GPMC L L DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_GPMC L L DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_GPMC L L DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_GPMC L L DVDD_GPMC L L DVDD_GPMC HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AB9 BALL NAME [2] GPMC_CLK SIGNAL NAME [3] GPMC_CLK GPMC_CS[0] AA12 GPMC_CS[1] 0 O PIN GPMC_WAIT[1] 0x08 I 1 CLKOUT1 0x10 O PIN EDMA_EVT3 0x20 I PIN TIM4_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[27] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I 0 SPI[2]_SCS[0] 0x04 I/O 1 GP1[26] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O 1 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN GPMC_CS[1] GPMC_A[25] PINCNTL122 / 0x4814 09E4 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL123 / 0x4814 09E8 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL124 / 0x4814 09EC 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL125 / 0x4814 09F0 0x0006 0000 GP1[24] AC3 GPMC_CS[2] GPMC_CS[2] GPMC_A[24] GP1[25] AF2 GPMC_CS[3] GPMC_CS[3] VIN[1]B_CLK AG6 GPMC_CS[4] GPMC_CS[4] SD2_CMD PINCNTL126 / 0x4814 09F4 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL89 / 0x4814 0960 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL90 / 0x4814 0964 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL91 / 0x4814 0968 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL92 / 0x4814 096C 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL93 / 0x4814 0970 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL94 / 0x4814 0974 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL95 / 0x4814 0978 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL96 / 0x4814 097C 0x0005 0000 GP1[8] W6 GPMC_D[0] GPMC_D[0] BTMODE[0] W4 GPMC_D[1] GPMC_D[1] BTMODE[1] W3 GPMC_D[2] GPMC_D[2] BTMODE[2] U2 GPMC_D[3] GPMC_D[3] BTMODE[3] W9 GPMC_D[4] GPMC_D[4] BTMODE[4] T5 GPMC_D[5] GPMC_D[5] BTMODE[5] T3 GPMC_D[6] GPMC_D[6] BTMODE[6] T2 GPMC_D[7] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] O GP1[23] 0x0006 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 GPMC_CS[0] PINCNTL127 / 0x4814 09F8 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 GPMC_CS[5] AC9 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] GPMC_D[7] BTMODE[7] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H H DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_GPMC H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 43 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] T1 BALL NAME [2] GPMC_D[8] SIGNAL NAME [3] GPMC_D[8] BTMODE[8] T8 GPMC_D[9] GPMC_D[9] BTMODE[9] R6 GPMC_D[10] GPMC_D[10] BTMODE[10] R4 GPMC_D[11] GPMC_D[11] BTMODE[11] R3 GPMC_D[12] GPMC_D[12] BTMODE[12] R2 GPMC_D[13] GPMC_D[13] BTMODE[13] R1 GPMC_D[14] GPMC_D[14] BTMODE[14] P2 GPMC_D[15] GPMC_D[15] BTMODE[15] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] PINCNTL97 / 0x4814 0980 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL98 / 0x4814 0984 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL99 / 0x4814 0988 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL100 / 0x4814 098C 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL101 / 0x4814 0990 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL102 / 0x4814 0994 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL103 / 0x4814 0998 0x0005 0000 PINCNTL104 / 0x4814 099C 0x0005 0000 MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x80 I PIN BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Z Z DVDD_GPMC Y8 GPMC_OE_RE GPMC_OE_RE PINCNTL129 / 0x4814 0A00 0x0006 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_GPMC W8 GPMC_WAIT[0] GPMC_WAIT[0] PINCNTL133 / 0x4814 0A10 0x0006 0000 0x01 I 1 H H DVDD_GPMC 0x02 O PIN EDMA_EVT0 0x20 I PIN GP1[31] 0x80 I/O PIN GPMC_A[26] Y5 GPMC_WE GPMC_WE PINCNTL130 / 0x4814 0A04 0x0006 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_GPMC A9 HDDAC_A HDDAC_A NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 A8 HDDAC_B HDDAC_B NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 B8 HDDAC_C HDDAC_C NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 E9 HDDAC_HSYNC HDDAC_HSYNC NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L L DVDD B6 HDDAC_IREF HDDAC_IREF NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 B7 HDDAC_VREF HDDAC_VREF NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 D9 HDDAC_VSYNC HDDAC_VSYNC NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L L DVDD B15 HDMI_CLKN HDMI_CLKN NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 A15 HDMI_CLKP HDMI_CLKP NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 44 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] A14 HDMI_DN0 HDMI_DN0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 B13 HDMI_DN1 HDMI_DN1 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 A12 HDMI_DN2 HDMI_DN2 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 B14 HDMI_DP0 HDMI_DP0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 B12 HDMI_DP1 HDMI_DP1 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 A11 HDMI_DP2 HDMI_DP2 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_HDMI_1P8 T27 I2C[0]_SCL I2C[0]_SCL PINCNTL263 / 0x4814 0C18 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD T24 I2C[0]_SDA I2C[0]_SDA PINCNTL264 / 0x4814 0C1C 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD D2 I2C[1]_SCL I2C[1]_SCL PINCNTL78 / 0x4814 0934 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O 1 H H DVDD 0x02 I/O 1 PINCNTL79 / 0x4814 0938 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O 1 H H DVDD 0x02 I/O 1 HDMI_SCL D1 I2C[1]_SDA I2C[1]_SDA HDMI_SDA J19 LDOCAP_ARM LDOCAP_ARM NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA K20 LDOCAP_ARMRAM LDOCAP_ARMRAM NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA W23 LDOCAP_HDVICP LDOCAP_HDVICP NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA Y24 LDOCAP_HDVICPRAM LDOCAP_HDVICPRAM NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA U9 LDOCAP_RAM0 LDOCAP_RAM0 NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA T22 LDOCAP_RAM1 LDOCAP_RAM1 NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA AB10 LDOCAP_RAM2 LDOCAP_RAM2 NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA M24 LDOCAP_SERDESCLK LDOCAP_SERDESCLK NA / NA NA NA A NA NA NA NA AD30 MCA[0]_ACLKR MCA[0]_ACLKR PINCNTL19 / 0x4814 0848 0x0004 0000 0x01 I/O 0 L L DVDD AD28 MCA[0]_ACLKX MCA[0]_ACLKX PINCNTL17 / 0x4814 0840 0x0004 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AF30 MCA[0]_AFSR MCA[0]_AFSR PINCNTL20 / 0x4814 084C 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O 0 L L DVDD AE29 MCA[0]_AFSX MCA[0]_AFSX PINCNTL18 / 0x4814 0844 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AF29 MCA[0]_AXR[0] MCA[0]_AXR[0] PINCNTL21 / 0x4814 0850 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 45 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AE31 BALL NAME [2] MCA[0]_AXR[1] SIGNAL NAME [3] MCA[0]_AXR[1] I2C[3]_SCL AE30 MCA[0]_AXR[2] MCA[0]_AXR[2] I2C[3]_SDA PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] PINCNTL22 / 0x4814 0854 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL23 / 0x4814 0858 0x000E 0000 MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 I/O PIN 0x20 I/O 1 0x01 I/O PIN 0x20 I/O 1 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H H DVDD H H DVDD AC31 MCA[0]_AXR[3] MCA[0]_AXR[3] PINCNTL24 / 0x4814 085C 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AD26 MCA[0]_AXR[4] MCA[0]_AXR[4] PINCNTL25 / 0x4814 0860 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AD27 MCA[0]_AXR[5] MCA[0]_AXR[5] PINCNTL26 / 0x4814 0864 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AD29 MCA[1]_ACLKR MCA[1]_ACLKR PINCNTL33 / 0x4814 0880 0x0004 0000 0x01 I/O 0 L L DVDD AC23 MCA[1]_ACLKX MCA[1]_ACLKX PINCNTL31 / 0x4814 0878 0x0004 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD AC24 MCA[1]_AFSR MCA[1]_AFSR PINCNTL34 / 0x4814 0884 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O 0 L L DVDD AB22 MCA[1]_AFSX MCA[1]_AFSX PINCNTL32 / 0x4814 087C 0x000C 0000 0x01 I/O PIN L L DVDD Y22 MCA[1]_AXR[0] MCA[1]_AXR[0] PINCNTL35 / 0x4814 0888 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x02 I/O PIN PINCNTL36 / 0x4814 088C 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x02 I/O PIN PINCNTL233 / 0x4814 0BA0 0x000E 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_RGMII 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL234 / 0x4814 0BA4 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O 1 H H DVDD_RGMII 0x80 I/O PIN SD0_DAT[4] Y21 MCA[1]_AXR[1] MCA[1]_AXR[1] SD0_DAT[5] AG2 MDCLK MDCLK GP1[11] AG3 MDIO MDIO GP1[12] AH31 NMI NMI PINCNTL261 / 0x4814 0C10 0x000E 0000 0x01 I PIN H H DVDD J30 PCIE_RXN0 PCIE_RXN0 NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_PCIE_1P8 K30 PCIE_RXP0 PCIE_RXP0 NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_PCIE_1P8 K31 PCIE_TXN0 PCIE_TXN0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_PCIE_1P8 L31 PCIE_TXP0 PCIE_TXP0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_PCIE_1P8 AH30 POR POR NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA DVDD AH29 RESET RESET PINCNTL260 / 0x4814 0C0C 0x000E 0000 0x01 I PIN H H DVDD AJ30 RSTOUT_WD_OUT RSTOUT_WD_OUT PINCNTL262 / 0x4814 0C14 0x0005 0001 0x01 O PIN L Z DVDD J25 RSV0 RSV0 NA NA NA NA NA NA 46 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H27 RSV1 RSV1 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA H24 RSV2 RSV2 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA L30 RSV27 RSV27 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA M30 RSV28 RSV28 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA N30 RSV29 RSV29 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA H28 RSV3 RSV3 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA N31 RSV30 RSV30 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA P31 RSV31 RSV31 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA R30 RSV32 RSV32 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA T30 RSV33 RSV33 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA AH24 RSV34 RSV34 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA AJ24 RSV35 RSV35 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA H25 RSV39 RSV39 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA G17 RSV4 RSV4 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA H29 RSV40 RSV40 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA AD8 RSV41 RSV41 NA NA NA NA NA NA AK21 RSV42 RSV42 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA L 0 NA P30 RSV43 RSV43 NA / NA NA NA NA NA NA NA NA G16 RSV5 RSV5 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA M28 RSV54 RSV54 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA N27 RSV55 RSV55 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA N29 RTCK RTCK NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H Z DVDD AB30 SD0_CLK SD0_CLK PINCNTL8 / 0x4814 081C 0x0006 0000 0x01 O 1 H H DVDD_SD 0x80 I/O PIN GP0[1] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 47 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AA29 BALL NAME [2] SD0_CMD SIGNAL NAME [3] SD0_CMD SD1_CMD PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] PINCNTL9 / 0x4814 0820 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL10 / 0x4814 0824 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL13 / 0x4814 0830 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL41 / 0x4814 08A0 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL42 / 0x4814 08A4 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL11 / 0x4814 0828 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL12 / 0x4814 082C 0x000E 0000 GP0[2] AA28 SD0_DAT[0] SD0_DAT[0] SD1_DAT[4] GP0[3] Y30 SD0_DAT[3] SD0_DAT[3] SD1_DAT[7] GP0[6] AB31 SD0_DAT[6] SD0_DAT[6] GP0[12] AC30 SD0_DAT[7] SD0_DAT[7] GP0[13] AA26 SD0_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD0_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD1_DAT[5] GP0[4] Y31 SD0_DAT[2]_SDRW SD0_DAT[2]_SDRW SD1_DAT[6] GP0[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 O 1 0x02 O 1 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 I/O PIN BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD H H DVDD_SD 0x80 I/O PIN W30 SD1_CLK SD1_CLK PINCNTL1 / 0x4814 0800 0x0006 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_SD Y29 SD1_CMD SD1_CMD PINCNTL2 / 0x4814 0804 0x000E 0000 0x01 O 1 H H DVDD_SD 0x80 I/O PIN GP0[0] W31 SD1_DAT[0] SD1_DAT[0] PINCNTL3 / 0x4814 0808 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD_SD Y27 SD1_DAT[3] SD1_DAT[3] PINCNTL6 / 0x4814 0814 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD_SD AA30 SD1_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD1_DAT[1]_SDIRQ PINCNTL4 / 0x4814 080C 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD_SD U29 SD1_DAT[2]_SDRW SD1_DAT[2]_SDRW PINCNTL5 / 0x4814 0810 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD_SD AC4 SD2_DAT[0] SD2_DAT[0] PINCNTL120 / 0x4814 09DC 0x0006 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_RGMII 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL117 / 0x4814 09D0 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD_RGMII 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN GPMC_A[4] GP1[14] AD1 SD2_DAT[3] SD2_DAT[3] GPMC_A[1] GP2[5] 48 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AD2 BALL NAME [2] SD2_DAT[4] SIGNAL NAME [3] SD2_DAT[4] SD2_DAT[5] PIN O PIN GPMC_A[23] 0x04 O PIN GPMC_CS[7] 0x08 O PIN EDMA_EVT0 0x20 I PIN TIM7_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[22] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[22] 0x04 O PIN TIM6_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[21] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[21] 0x04 O PIN UART2_TXD 0x20 O PIN GP1[20] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 O PIN GPMC_A[20] 0x04 O PIN UART2_RXD 0x20 I 1 GP1[19] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN 0x02 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O 1 0x80 I/O PIN GPMC_A[26] AE2 SD2_DAT[6] SD2_DAT[6] GPMC_A[25] AE3 SD2_DAT[7] SD2_DAT[7] GPMC_A[24] AC5 SD2_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD2_DAT[1]_SDIRQ GPMC_A[3] PINCNTL114 / 0x4814 09C4 PINCNTL113 / 0x4814 09C0 0x0006 0000 0x0006 0000 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL119 / 0x4814 09D8 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL118 / 0x4814 09D4 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL121 / 0x4814 09E0 0x0006 0000 GP1[13] AC8 SD2_DAT[2]_SDRW SD2_DAT[2]_SDRW GPMC_A[2] GP2[6] AC6 SD2_SCLK TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I/O PINCNTL115 / 0x4814 09C8 0x0006 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 SD2_DAT[5] PINCNTL116 / 0x4814 09CC PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 GPMC_A[27] AE1 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] SD2_SCLK GP1[15] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H H DVDD_RGMII H31 SERDES_CLKN SERDES_CLKN NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_SATA0_1P8 H30 SERDES_CLKP SERDES_CLKP NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_SATA0_1P8 J28 SPI[0]_D[0] SPI[0]_D[0] PINCNTL84 / 0x4814 094C 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD J27 SPI[0]_D[1] SPI[0]_D[1] PINCNTL83 / 0x4814 0948 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD N24 SPI[0]_SCLK SPI[0]_SCLK PINCNTL82 / 0x4814 0944 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 49 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] G29 SPI[0]_SCS[0] SPI[0]_SCS[0] PINCNTL81 / 0x4814 0940 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD G28 SPI[0]_SCS[1] SPI[0]_SCS[1] PINCNTL80 / 0x4814 093C 0x0006 0000 0x01 I/O 1 H H DVDD 0x02 I 1 EDMA_EVT1 0x20 I PIN TIM4_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP1[6] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I/O PIN H H DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN SD1_SDCD N23 SPI[1]_D[0] SPI[1]_D[0] GP1[26] M27 SPI[1]_D[1] SPI[1]_D[1] GP1[18] M29 SPI[1]_SCLK SPI[1]_SCLK GP1[17] J29 SPI[1]_SCS[0] SPI[1]_SCS[0] GP1[16] PINCNTL88 / 0x4814 095C 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL87 / 0x4814 0958 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL86 / 0x4814 0954 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL85 / 0x4814 0950 0x0006 0000 T29 TCLK TCLK NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA H H DVDD N28 TDI TDI NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA H H DVDD U26 TDO TDO NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA H H DVDD T31 TMS TMS NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA H H DVDD U24 TRST TRST NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA L L DVDD B9 TV_OUT0 TV_OUT0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 B11 TV_RSET TV_RSET NA / NA NA 0x01 A NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 B10 TV_VFB0 TV_VFB0 NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_VDAC_1P8 D30 UART0_CTS UART0_CTS PINCNTL72 / 0x4814 091C 0x000E 0000 0x01 I/O 1 H H DVDD 0x10 I/O 1 0x40 I 1 PINCNTL74 / 0x4814 0924 0x000E 0000 0x01 I 1 H H DVDD 0x10 I/O 1 I2C[2]_SCL 0x20 I/O 1 SD1_POW 0x40 O PIN GP1[2] 0x80 I/O PIN SPI[1]_SCS[3] SD0_SDCD E31 UART0_DCD UART0_DCD SPI[0]_SCS[3] 50 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] E29 BALL NAME [2] UART0_DSR SIGNAL NAME [3] UART0_DSR UART0_DTR 1 I/O 1 I2C[2]_SDA 0x20 I/O 1 SD1_SDWP 0x40 I 0 GP1[3] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x04 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 1 0x04 I 1 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x10 I/O 1 PINCNTL76 / 0x4814 092C 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL77 / 0x4814 0930 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL73 / 0x4814 0920 0x000E 0000 GP1[4] N26 UART0_RIN UART0_RIN UART1_RXD GP1[5] D31 UART0_RTS TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I UART1_TXD 0x000E 0000 MODE [6] 0x10 UART0_DTR PINCNTL75 / 0x4814 0928 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 SPI[0]_SCS[2] E30 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] UART0_RTS SPI[1]_SCS[2] SD2_SDCD BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] H H DVDD H H DVDD H H DVDD H H DVDD 0x40 I 1 J26 UART0_RXD UART0_RXD PINCNTL70 / 0x4814 0914 0x000E 0000 0x01 I PIN H H DVDD E28 UART0_TXD UART0_TXD PINCNTL71 / 0x4814 0918 0x000E 0000 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD L22 UART2_RXD UART2_RXD PINCNTL69 / 0x4814 0910 0x000E 0000 0x02 I 1 H H DVDD 0x20 I/O 1 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL68 / 0x4814 090C 0x000E 0000 0x02 O PIN H H DVDD 0x20 I/O 1 I2C[3]_SCL GP1[1] M21 UART2_TXD UART2_TXD I2C[3]_SDA 0x80 I/O PIN B20 USB0_CE GP1[0] USB0_CE NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 B21 USB0_DM USB0_DM NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 A21 USB0_DP USB0_DP NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 K23 USB0_DRVVBUS USB0_DRVVBUS PINCNTL270 / 0x4814 0C34 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD 0x02 I/O PIN GP0[7] A20 USB0_ID USB0_ID NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 B22 USB0_VBUSIN USB0_VBUSIN NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 C21 USB1_CE USB1_CE NA / NA NA 0x01 O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 B23 USB1_DM USB1_DM NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 51 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] A23 USB1_DP USB1_DP NA / NA NA 0x01 I/O NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 A24 USB1_ID USB1_ID NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 B24 USB1_VBUSIN USB1_VBUSIN NA / NA NA 0x01 I NA NA NA VDDA_USB_3P3 M25, N22, N25, P23, R9, T10, T9 VDDA_1P8 VDDA_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA L19 VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8 VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA V9 VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8 VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA W10 VDDA_CSI2_1P8 VDDA_CSI2_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA AA19 VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8 VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA L15 VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8 VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA K16 VDDA_HDDAC_1P1 VDDA_HDDAC_1P1 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA L14 VDDA_HDDAC_1P8 VDDA_HDDAC_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA K14 VDDA_HDMI_1P8 VDDA_HDMI_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA T23 VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8 VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA W11 VDDA_L3L4_1P8 VDDA_L3L4PLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA M26 VDDA_PCIE_1P8 VDDA_PCIE_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA K19 VDDA_USB0_1P8 VDDA_USB0_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA J17 VDDA_USB1_1P8 VDDA_USB1_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA M19, M20 VDDA_USB_3P3 VDDA_USB_3P3 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA J14 VDDA_VDAC_1P8 VDDA_VDAC_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA L13 VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8 VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA P21 VDDS_OSC0_1P8 VDDS_OSC0_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA P20 VDDS_OSC1_1P8 VDDS_OSC1_1P8 NA / NA NA NA PWR NA NA NA NA C9 VIN[0]A_CLK VIN[0]A_CLK PINCNTL137 / 0x4814 0A20 0x000C 0000 0x01 I 0 L L DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN GP2[2] 52 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B18 BALL NAME [2] VIN[0]A_D[0] SIGNAL NAME [3] VIN[0]A_D[0] VIN[0]A_D[1] VIN[0]A_D[2] PIN I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN I2C[2]_SCL 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[10] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXER 0x08 I 0 GP0[11] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXD[1] 0x08 I PIN I2C[3]_SCL 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[12] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMRXD[0] 0x08 I PIN I2C[3]_SDA 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[13] 0x80 I/O PIN VIN[0]A_D[2] GP2[7] C17 VIN[0]A_D[3] VIN[0]A_D[3] GP2[8] D17 VIN[0]A_D[4] VIN[0]A_D[4] GP2[9] F17 VIN[0]A_D[5] VIN[0]A_D[5] GP2[10] L20 VIN[0]A_D[6] VIN[0]A_D[6] GP2[11] H20 VIN[0]A_D[7] VIN[0]A_D[7] GP2[12] K11 VIN[0]A_D[16] VIN[0]A_D[16] CAM_D[8] E12 VIN[0]A_D[17] VIN[0]A_D[17] CAM_D[9] K10 VIN[0]A_D[18] VIN[0]A_D[18] CAM_D[10] D7 VIN[0]A_D[19] VIN[0]A_D[19] CAM_D[11] 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL141 / 0x4814 0A30 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL142 / 0x4814 0A34 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL143 / 0x4814 0A38 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL144 / 0x4814 0A3C 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL145 / 0x4814 0A40 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL146 / 0x4814 0A44 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL147 / 0x4814 0A48 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL156 / 0x4814 0A6C 0x000E 0000 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I VIN[0]A_D[1] PINCNTL140 / 0x4814 0A2C MODE [6] 0x80 GP1[12] B17 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 GP1[11] A17 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL157 / 0x4814 0A70 PINCNTL158 / 0x4814 0A74 PINCNTL159 / 0x4814 0A78 0x000C 0000 0x000E 0000 0x000E 0000 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD H H DVDD_C L L DVDD_C H H DVDD_C H H DVDD_C HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 53 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F9 BALL NAME [2] VIN[0]A_D[20] SIGNAL NAME [3] VIN[0]A_D[20] VIN[0]A_D[21] PIN I PIN EMAC[1]_RMCRSDV 0x08 I 0 SPI[3]_SCS[0] 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[14] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXD[0] 0x08 O PIN SPI[3]_SCLK 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[15] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXD[1] 0x08 O PIN SPI[3]_D[1] 0x20 I/O PIN GP0[16] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x02 I PIN EMAC[1]_RMTXEN 0x08 O PIN SPI[3]_D[0] 0x20 I/O PIN GP0[17] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x10 I 0 I2C[2]_SDA 0x40 I/O 1 GP2[0] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x02 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x20 I 0 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x20 I/O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x20 I/O 0 0x80 I/O PIN CAM_D[13] A6 VIN[0]A_D[22] VIN[0]A_D[22] CAM_D[14] A5 VIN[0]A_D[23] VIN[0]A_D[23] CAM_D[15] C12 VIN[0]A_DE VIN[0]A_DE VIN[0]B_HSYNC B5 VIN[0]A_DE VIN[0]A_DE CAM_D[7] PINCNTL162 / 0x4814 0A84 PINCNTL163 / 0x4814 0A88 PINCNTL135 / 0x4814 0A18 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL164 / 0x4814 0A8C 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL150 / 0x4814 0A54 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL151 / 0x4814 0A58 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL152 / 0x4814 0A5C 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL153 / 0x4814 0A60 0x000C 0000 GP0[18] E16 VIN[0]A_D[10]_BD[2] VIN[0]A_D[10]_BD[2] GP2[15] H17 VIN[0]A_D[11]_BD[3] VIN[0]A_D[11]_BD[3] CAM_WE GP2[16] J16 VIN[0]A_D[12]_BD[4] VIN[0]A_D[12]_BD[4] CLKOUT1 GP2[17] H16 VIN[0]A_D[13]_BD[5] VIN[0]A_D[13]_BD[5] CAM_RESET GP2[18] 54 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] I PINCNTL161 / 0x4814 0A80 0x000C 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 VIN[0]A_D[21] PINCNTL160 / 0x4814 0A7C PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 CAM_D[12] C7 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] Device Pins BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_C L L DVDD_C L L DVDD_C L L DVDD_C H H DVDD H H DVDD_C L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F13 BALL NAME [2] VIN[0]A_D[14]_BD[6] SIGNAL NAME [3] VIN[0]A_D[14]_BD[6] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x000C 0000 I PIN 0x20 O PIN PINCNTL155 / 0x4814 0A68 0x000C 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x20 O PIN PINCNTL148 / 0x4814 0A4C 0x000C 0000 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL149 / 0x4814 0A50 0x000C 0000 0x01 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN PINCNTL136 / 0x4814 0A1C 0x000E 0000 0x01 I 0 0x10 I 0 I2C[2]_SCL 0x40 I/O 1 GP2[1] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x02 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x20 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x02 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 I 0 0x02 I PIN 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN SPI[3]_SCLK 0x10 I/O 1 TIM7_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP2[21] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I/O 1 0x80 I/O PIN GP2[19] H13 VIN[0]A_D[15]_BD[7] VIN[0]A_D[15]_BD[7] CAM_SHUTTER GP2[20] B16 VIN[0]A_D[8]_BD[0] VIN[0]A_D[8]_BD[0] GP2[13] C16 VIN[0]A_D[9]_BD[1] VIN[0]A_D[9]_BD[1] GP2[14] J13 VIN[0]A_FLD VIN[0]A_FLD VIN[0]B_VSYNC B4 VIN[0]A_FLD VIN[0]A_FLD CAM_D[5] PINCNTL166 / 0x4814 0A94 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL138 / 0x4814 0A24 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL139 / 0x4814 0A28 0x000E 0000 PINCNTL134 / 0x4814 0A14 0x0004 0000 PINCNTL165 / 0x4814 0A90 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL167 / 0x4814 0A98 0x0006 0000 PINCNTL179 / 0x4814 0AC8 0x000C 0000 GP0[20] D13 VIN[0]A_HSYNC VIN[0]A_HSYNC GP2[3] C13 VIN[0]A_VSYNC VIN[0]A_VSYNC GP2[4] H12 VIN[0]B_CLK VIN[0]B_CLK CLKOUT0 GP1[9] C5 VIN[0]B_DE VIN[0]B_DE CAM_D[6] GP0[19] A3 VIN[0]B_FLD VIN[0]B_FLD CAM_D[4] GP0[21] C20 VOUT[0]_AVID VOUT[0]_AVID VOUT[0]_FLD F24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[2] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 CAM_STROBE PINCNTL154 / 0x4814 0A64 MODE [6] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[2] EMU2 GP2[22] PINCNTL180 / 0x4814 0ACC 0x000C 0000 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD H H DVDD H H DVDD_C H H DVDD H H DVDD L L DVDD H H DVDD_C H H DVDD_C L L DVDD L L DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 55 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] D21 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[3] SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[3] GP2[23] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] PINCNTL181 / 0x4814 0AD0 0x000C 0000 MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD J23 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[4] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[4] PINCNTL182 / 0x4814 0AD4 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD H23 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[5] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[5] PINCNTL183 / 0x4814 0AD8 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD J24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[6] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[6] PINCNTL184 / 0x4814 0ADC 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD E24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[7] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[7] PINCNTL185 / 0x4814 0AE0 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD D24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[8] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[8] PINCNTL186 / 0x4814 0AE4 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD C24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[9] VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[9] PINCNTL187 / 0x4814 0AE8 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD K22 VOUT[0]_CLK VOUT[0]_CLK PINCNTL176 / 0x4814 0ABC 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B3 VOUT[0]_FLD VOUT[0]_FLD PINCNTL175 / 0x4814 0AB8 0x0004 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD_C 0x02 I 0 GPMC_A[12] 0x10 O PIN UART2_RTS 0x20 O PIN GP2[02] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD 0x02 I/O 1 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD 0x80 I/O PIN CAM_PCLK C25 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[2] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[2] EMU3 PINCNTL188 / 0x4814 0AEC 0x000C 0000 PINCNTL189 / 0x4814 0AF0 0x000C 0000 GP2[24] C26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[3] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[3] GP2[25] E26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[4] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[4] PINCNTL190 / 0x4814 0AF4 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[5] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[5] PINCNTL191 / 0x4814 0AF8 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD A26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[6] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[6] PINCNTL192 / 0x4814 0AFC 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B25 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[7] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[7] PINCNTL193 / 0x4814 0B00 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B27 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[8] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[8] PINCNTL194 / 0x4814 0B04 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD A27 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[9] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[9] PINCNTL195 / 0x4814 0B08 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD F21 VOUT[0]_HSYNC VOUT[0]_HSYNC PINCNTL177 / 0x4814 0AC0 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD C28 VOUT[0]_R_CR[2] VOUT[0]_R_CR[2] PINCNTL196 / 0x4814 0B0C 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD 0x02 I/O 1 0x80 I/O PIN EMU4 GP2[26] 56 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B28 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[0]_R_CR[3] SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[0]_R_CR[3] GP2[27] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] PINCNTL197 / 0x4814 0B10 0x000C 0000 MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] 0x01 O PIN 0x80 I/O PIN BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD B29 VOUT[0]_R_CR[4] VOUT[0]_R_CR[4] PINCNTL198 / 0x4814 0B14 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD A29 VOUT[0]_R_CR[5] VOUT[0]_R_CR[5] PINCNTL199 / 0x4814 0B18 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD C30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[6] VOUT[0]_R_CR[6] PINCNTL200 / 0x4814 0B1C 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[7] VOUT[0]_R_CR[7] PINCNTL201 / 0x4814 0B20 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD A30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[8] VOUT[0]_R_CR[8] PINCNTL202 / 0x4814 0B24 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD B31 VOUT[0]_R_CR[9] VOUT[0]_R_CR[9] PINCNTL203 / 0x4814 0B28 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD E20 VOUT[0]_VSYNC VOUT[0]_VSYNC PINCNTL178 / 0x4814 0AC4 0x000C 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD F1 VOUT[1]_AVID VOUT[1]_AVID PINCNTL207 / 0x4814 0B38 0x0004 0000 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD 0x02 I 0 VIN[1]A_CLK 0x04 I 0 TIM6_IO 0x40 I/O PIN GP2[31] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD_C 0x02 I/O 0 GPMC_A[10] 0x10 O PIN UART2_TXD 0x20 O PIN GP0[27] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN L L DVDD_C 0x02 I/O 0 GPMC_A[9] 0x10 O PIN UART2_RXD 0x20 I 1 GP0[26] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN H H DVDD 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[7] 0x04 I PIN HDMI_CEC 0x10 I/O 1 SPI[2]_D[0] 0x20 I/O PIN GP3[30] 0x80 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_MRXER H9 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[0] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[0] CAM_VS D5 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[1] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[1] CAM_HS M8 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[2] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[2] GPMC_A[0] PINCNTL173 / 0x4814 0AB0 PINCNTL172 / 0x4814 0AAC PINCNTL231 / 0x4814 0B98 0x0006 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0006 0000 HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 57 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F2 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[3] SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[3] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[4] PIN I 0 VIN[1]A_D[0] 0x04 I PIN GP3[0] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[1] 0x04 I PIN GP3[1] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[2] 0x04 I PIN GP3[2] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[3] 0x04 I PIN GP3[3] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[4] 0x04 I PIN GP3[4] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[5] 0x04 I PIN I2C[3]_SCL 0x20 I/O 1 GP3[5] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[6] 0x04 I PIN I2C[3]_SDA 0x20 I/O 1 GP3[6] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I 0 VIN[1]A_HSYNC 0x04 I 0 GP2[28] 0x80 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_MRXD[0] G1 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[5] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[5] EMAC[1]_MRXD[1] G2 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[6] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[6] EMAC[1]_MRXD[2] H3 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[7] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[7] EMAC[1]_MRXD[3] G3 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[8] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[8] EMAC[1]_MRXD[4] H5 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[9] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[9] EMAC[1]_MRXD[5] D3 VOUT[1]_CLK VOUT[1]_CLK EMAC[1]_MTCLK 58 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] O PINCNTL209 / 0x4814 0B40 PINCNTL210 / 0x4814 0B44 PINCNTL211 / 0x4814 0B48 PINCNTL212 / 0x4814 0B4C PINCNTL213 / 0x4814 0B50 PINCNTL214 / 0x4814 0B54 PINCNTL204 / 0x4814 0B2C 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[4] PINCNTL208 / 0x4814 0B3C PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 EMAC[1]_MRCLK F3 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 Device Pins BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] J10 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[1]_FLD SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[1]_FLD VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[0] PIN I/O 0 CAM_WE 0x04 I 0 GPMC_A[11] 0x10 O PIN UART2_CTS 0x20 I/O 1 GP0[28] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[6] 0x10 O PIN GP0[23] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[5] 0x10 O PIN GP0[22] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[21] 0x04 I PIN HDMI_SCL 0x10 I/O 1 SPI[2]_SCS[2] 0x20 I/O 1 I2C[2]_SCL 0x40 I/O 1 GP3[20] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[8] 0x04 I PIN GP3[7] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN VIN[1]A_D[9] 0x04 I PIN GP3[8] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I 0 VIN[1]A_D[10] 0x04 I PIN GP3[9] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[11] 0x04 I PIN GP3[10] 0x80 I/O PIN CAM_D[2] A2 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[1] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[1] CAM_D[3] L2 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[2] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[2] GPMC_A[13] H6 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[3] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[3] EMAC[1]_MRXD[6] J8 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[4] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[4] EMAC[1]_MRXD[7] J1 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[5] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[5] EMAC[1]_MRXDV H4 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] O VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[6] EMAC[1]_GMTCLK PINCNTL169 / 0x4814 0AA0 PINCNTL168 / 0x4814 0A9C PINCNTL228 / 0x4814 0B8C PINCNTL215 / 0x4814 0B58 PINCNTL216 / 0x4814 0B5C PINCNTL217 / 0x4814 0B60 PINCNTL218 / 0x4814 0B64 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[0] PINCNTL174 / 0x4814 0AB4 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 CAM_FLD B2 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x0004 0000 0x0006 0000 0x0006 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD_C L L DVDD_C H H DVDD_C H H DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 59 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] J9 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[7] SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[7] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[8] PIN O PIN VIN[1]A_D[12] 0x04 I PIN GP3[11] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[13] 0x04 I PIN GP3[12] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[14] 0x04 I PIN GP3[13] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I 0 VIN[1]A_VSYNC 0x04 I 0 SPI[3]_D[1] 0x10 I/O PIN GP2[29] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[8] 0x10 O PIN GP0[25] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I PIN GPMC_A[7] 0x10 O PIN GP0[24] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[23] 0x04 I PIN HDMI_HPDET 0x10 I 0 SPI[2]_D[1] 0x20 I/O PIN GP3[22] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[22] 0x04 I PIN HDMI_SDA 0x10 I/O 1 SPI[2]_SCLK 0x20 I/O 1 I2C[2]_SDA 0x40 I/O 1 GP3[21] 0x80 I/O PIN EMAC[1]_MTXD[1] K1 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[9] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[9] EMAC[1]_MTXD[2] E2 VOUT[1]_HSYNC VOUT[1]_HSYNC EMAC[1]_MCOL C2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[0] VOUT[1]_R_CR[0] CAM_D[0] C1 VOUT[1]_R_CR[1] VOUT[1]_R_CR[1] CAM_D[1] L6 VOUT[1]_R_CR[2] VOUT[1]_R_CR[2] GPMC_A[15] L4 VOUT[1]_R_CR[3] VOUT[1]_R_CR[3] GPMC_A[14] 60 TYPE [7] DSIS [8] O PINCNTL220 / 0x4814 0B6C PINCNTL221 / 0x4814 0B70 PINCNTL205 / 0x4814 0B30 PINCNTL171 / 0x4814 0AA8 PINCNTL170 / 0x4814 0AA4 PINCNTL230 / 0x4814 0B94 PINCNTL229 / 0x4814 0B90 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[8] PINCNTL219 / 0x4814 0B68 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 EMAC[1]_MTXD[0] L3 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0006 0000 Device Pins BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD_C L L DVDD_C L L DVDD H H DVDD HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] H2 BALL NAME [2] VOUT[1]_R_CR[4] SIGNAL NAME [3] VOUT[1]_R_CR[4] VOUT[1]_R_CR[5] PIN O PIN VIN[1]A_D[15] 0x04 I PIN SPI[3]_SCS[1] 0x20 I/O 1 GP3[14] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[16] 0x04 I PIN SPI[3]_SCLK 0x20 I/O 1 GP3[15] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[17] 0x04 I PIN SPI[3]_D[1] 0x20 I/O PIN GP3[16] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[18] 0x04 I PIN SPI[3]_D[0] 0x20 I/O PIN GP3[17] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[19] 0x04 I PIN GP3[18] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 O PIN VIN[1]A_D[20] 0x04 I PIN GP3[19] 0x80 I/O PIN 0x01 O PIN 0x02 I 0 VIN[1]A_FLD 0x04 I 0 VIN[1]A_DE 0x08 I 0 SPI[3]_D[0] 0x10 I/O PIN GP2[30] 0x80 I/O PIN NA PWR NA EMAC[1]_MTXD[4] L12 VOUT[1]_R_CR[6] VOUT[1]_R_CR[6] EMAC[1]_MTXD[5] M10 VOUT[1]_R_CR[7] VOUT[1]_R_CR[7] EMAC[1]_MTXD[6] J2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[8] VOUT[1]_R_CR[8] EMAC[1]_MTXD[7] K2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[9] VOUT[1]_R_CR[9] EMAC[1]_MTXEN F5 VOUT[1]_VSYNC VOUT[1]_VSYNC EMAC[1]_MCRS AL18 VREFSSTL_DDR[0] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] O VREFSSTL_DDR[0] PINCNTL223 / 0x4814 0B78 PINCNTL224 / 0x4814 0B7C PINCNTL225 / 0x4814 0B80 PINCNTL226 / 0x4814 0B84 PINCNTL227 / 0x4814 0B88 PINCNTL206 / 0x4814 0B34 NA / NA 0x0004 0000 MODE [6] 0x02 VOUT[1]_R_CR[5] PINCNTL222 / 0x4814 0B74 PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] 0x01 EMAC[1]_MTXD[3] M11 PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 0x0004 0000 NA BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD L L DVDD NA NA DVDD_DDR[0] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 61 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-11. Ball Characteristics (AAR Package) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] PINCNTL REGISTER NAME AND ADDRESS[4] PINCNTL DEFAULT VALUE[5] MODE [6] TYPE [7] DSIS [8] BALL RESET STATE [9] BALL RESET REL. STATE [10] POWER [11] A1, A31, AA13, VSS AA14, AA15, AA16, AA17, AA18, AA27, AC25, AD24, AD25, AD3, AD4, AD5, AD6, AD7, AE12, AE19, AE20, AE23, AE24, AE25, AE26, AE27, AE28, AE5, AE6, AE7, AE8, AE9, AF12, AF20, AF24, AF25, AF7, AG11, AG19, AG24, AG25, AG7, AH12, AH20, AH7, AL1, AL31, D25, D8, E21, E25, E7, E8, F20, F25, F7, F8, G20, G23, G24, G25, G26, G27, G4, G5, G6, G7, G8, H26, H7, J7, L16, M16, N13, N14, N16, N17, P11, P12, P14, P18, R11, R12, R14, R18, R20, R21, T11, T12, T14, T15, T16, T19, T20, T21, U14, U18, U23, V18, W16, W17, Y16, Y17, Y25, Y26, Y28 VSS NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA U30 VSSA_AUXOSC VSSA_AUXOSC NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA AC7, V14 VSSA_CSI2 VSSA_CSI2 NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA G30 VSSA_DEVOSC VSSA_DEVOSC NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA G9, H8 VSSA_HDMI VSSA_HDMI NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA D20, N19, N20 VSSA_USB VSSA_USB NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA C8 VSSA_VDAC VSSA_VDAC NA / NA NA NA GND NA NA NA NA 62 Device Pins HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 3.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Terminal Functions The terminal functions tables identify the external signal names, the associated pin (ball) numbers along with the mechanical package designator, the pin type, whether the pin has any internal pullup or pulldown resistors, and a functional pin description. For more detailed information on device configurations, peripheral selection, and multiplexed/shared pin see Device Configurations section. (1) SIGNAL NAME: The signal name (2) DESCRIPTION: Description of the signal (3) TYPE: Ball type for this specific function: – I = Input – O = Output – I/O = Input/Output – D = Open drain – DS = Differential – A = Analog (4) BALL: Package ball location 3.3.1 Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) Table 3-12. ATL Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] ATL_CLKOUT0 Audio Tracking Logic Clock 0 Output O AF31 ATL_CLKOUT1 Audio Tracking Logic Clock 1 Output O AF31 ATL_CLKOUT2 Audio Tracking Logic Clock 2 Output O AF27 ATL_CLKOUT3 Audio Tracking Logic Clock 3 Output O AG30 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 63 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.2 www.ti.com Boot Configuration Table 3-13. Boot Configuration Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] BTMODE[0] Boot Mode Selection 0. ARM Cortex-A8 Boot Mode I Configuration Bits. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and the General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, the boot mode inputs BTMODE[4:0] are sampled to determine the ARM boot configuration. For more details on the types of boot modes supported, see Section 4.2, Boot Modes, of this document, along with the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter of the device Technical Reference Manual. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 0 (GPMC_D[0]). W6 BTMODE[1] Boot Mode Selection 1. ARM Cortex-A8 Boot Mode I Configuration Bits. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and the General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, the boot mode inputs BTMODE[4:0] are sampled to determine the ARM boot configuration. For more details on the types of boot modes supported, see Section 4.2, Boot Modes, of this document, along with the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter of the device Technical Reference Manual. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 1 (GPMC_D[1]). W4 BTMODE[2] Boot Mode Selection 2. ARM Cortex-A8 Boot Mode I Configuration Bits. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and the General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, the boot mode inputs BTMODE[4:0] are sampled to determine the ARM boot configuration. For more details on the types of boot modes supported, see Section 4.2, Boot Modes, of this document, along with the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter of the device Technical Reference Manual. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 2 (GPMC_D[2]). W3 BTMODE[3] Boot Mode Selection 3. ARM Cortex-A8 Boot Mode I Configuration Bits. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and the General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, the boot mode inputs BTMODE[4:0] are sampled to determine the ARM boot configuration. For more details on the types of boot modes supported, see Section 4.2, Boot Modes, of this document, along with the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter of the device Technical Reference Manual. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 3 (GPMC_D[3]). U2 BTMODE[4] Boot Mode Selection 4. ARM Cortex-A8 Boot Mode I Configuration Bits. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and the General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, the boot mode inputs BTMODE[4:0] are sampled to determine the ARM boot configuration. For more details on the types of boot modes supported, see Section 4.2, Boot Modes, of this document, along with the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter of the device Technical Reference Manual. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 4 (GPMC_D[4]). W9 BTMODE[5] Boot Mode Selection 5. Reserved Boot Pin. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. For proper device operation at reset, this pin should be externally pulled low. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 5 (GPMC_D[5]). T5 64 Device Pins I Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-13. Boot Configuration Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] BTMODE[6] Boot Mode Selection 6. Reserved Boot Pin. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. For proper device operation at reset, this pin should be externally pulled low. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 6 (GPMC_D[6]). I T3 BTMODE[7] Boot Mode Selection 7. RGMII Internal Delay Selection. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[7] is sampled to determine the RGMII Internal Delay Selection: • 0 = Internal Delay Enabled • 1 = Internal Delay Disabled After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 7 (GPMC_D[7]). I T2 BTMODE[8] Boot Mode Selection 8. Ethernet PHY Configuration. This I pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, when EMAC bootmode is selected (see Table 4-1), BTMODE[9:8] pins are sampled to determine the function of the Ethernet PHY Mode selection: • 00 = MII (GMII) • 01 = RMII • 10 = RGMII • 11 = Reserved For more detailed information on the EMAC PHY boot modes and the EMAC pin functions selected, see Section 4.2.6, Ethernet PHY Mode Selection. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 8 (GPMC_D[8]). T1 BTMODE[9] Boot Mode Selection 9. Ethernet PHY Configuration. This I pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, when EMAC bootmode is selected (see Table 4-1), BTMODE[9:8] pins are sampled to determine the function of the Ethernet PHY Mode selection: • 00 = MII (GMII) • 01 = RMII • 10 = RGMII • 11 = Reserved For more detailed information on the EMAC PHY boot modes and the EMAC pin functions selected, see Section 4.2.6, Ethernet PHY Mode Selection. After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 9 (GPMC_D[9]). T8 BTMODE[10] Boot Mode Selection 10. XIP (NOR) on GPMC I Configuration. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, when the XIP (MUX0), XIP (MUX1), XIP w/ WAiT (MUX0) or XIP w/ WAiT (MUX1) bootmode is selected (see Table 41), BTMODE[10] is sampled to select between GPMC pin muxing options A or B shown in Table 4-2, XIP (on GPMC) Boot Options [Muxed or Non-Muxed]. • 0 = GPMC Option A • 1 = GPMC Option B After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 10 (GPMC_D[10]). R6 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 65 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-13. Boot Configuration Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] BTMODE[11] Boot Mode Selection 11. RSTOUT_WD_OUT Configuration. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[11] is sampled to determine the function of the RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin: • 0 = RSTOUT is asserted when a Watchdog Timer reset, POR, RESET, or Emulation/Software-Global Cold/Warm reset occurs • 1 = RSTOUT_WD_OUT is asserted only when a Watchdog Timer reset occurs After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 11 (GPMC_D[11]). I R4 BTMODE[12] Boot Mode Selection 12. GPMC CS0 default Data Bus I Width input. This pin is multiplexed between ARM CortexA8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[12] is sampled to determine the GPMC CS0 bus width: • 0 = 8-bit data bus • 1 = 16-bit data bus After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 12 (GPMC_D[12]). R3 BTMODE[13] Boot Mode Selection 13. GPMC CS0 default Address/Data multiplexing mode input. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[14:13] are sampled to determine the GPMC CS0 Address/Data multiplexing: • 00 = Not muxed • 01 = A/A/D muxed • 10 = A/D muxed • 11 = Reserved After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 13 (GPMC_D[13]). I R2 BTMODE[14] Boot Mode Selection 14. GPMC CS0 default Address/Data multiplexing mode input. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[14:13] are sampled to determine the GPMC CS0 Address/Data multiplexing: • 00 = Not muxed • 01 = A/A/D muxed • 10 = A/D muxed • 11 = Reserved After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 14 (GPMC_D[14]). I R1 BTMODE[15] Boot Mode Selection 15. GPMC CS0 default GPMC_Wait I enable input. This pin is multiplexed between ARM Cortex-A8 boot mode and General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) peripheral functions. At reset, BTMODE[15] is sampled to determine the GPMC CS0 Wait enable: • 0 = Wait disabled • 1 = Wait enabled After reset, this pin functions as GPMC multiplexed data/address pin 15 (GPMC_D[15]). P2 66 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 3.3.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 CSI2 Interface (I/F) Signals Table 3-14. CSI2 I/F Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] CSI2_DX[0] CSI2 Camera lane 0 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I AB2 CSI2_DX[1] CSI2 Camera lane 1 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I AA1 CSI2_DX[2] CSI2 Camera lane 2 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I AA2 CSI2_DX[3] CSI2 Camera lane 3 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I W2 CSI2_DX[4] CSI2 Camera lane 4 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I V1 CSI2_DY[0] CSI2 Camera lane 0 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I AC2 CSI2_DY[1] CSI2 Camera lane 1 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I AB1 CSI2_DY[2] CSI2 Camera lane 2 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I Y2 CSI2_DY[3] CSI2 Camera lane 3 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I W1 CSI2_DY[4] CSI2 Camera lane 4 differential pair input. When CSI2 is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I V2 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 67 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.4 www.ti.com Camera Interface (I/F) Table 3-15. Camera I/F Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] CAM_D[0] Camera data input I C2 CAM_D[1] Camera data input I C1 CAM_D[2] Camera data input I B2 CAM_D[3] Camera data input I A2 CAM_D[4] Camera data input I A3 CAM_D[5] Camera data input I B4 CAM_D[6] Camera data input I C5 CAM_D[7] Camera data input I B5 CAM_D[8] Camera data input I K11 CAM_D[9] Camera data input I E12 CAM_D[10] Camera data input I K10 CAM_D[11] Camera data input I D7 CAM_D[12] Camera data input I F9 CAM_D[13] Camera data input I C7 CAM_D[14] Camera data input I A6 CAM_D[15] Camera data input I A5 CAM_FLD Camera Field Identification input I/O J10 CAM_HS Camera Horizontal Synchronization I/O D5 CAM_PCLK Camera Pixel Clock I B3 CAM_RESET Camera Reset. Used for Strobe Synchronization I/O H16 CAM_SHUTTER Camera Mechanical Shutter Control Signal O H13 CAM_STROBE Camera Flash Strobe Control Signal O F13 CAM_VS Camera Vertical Synchronization I/O H9 CAM_WE Camera Write Enable I H17, J10 68 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 3.3.5 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller Table 3-16. DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller 0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] DDR[0]_A[0] DDR[0] Address Bus O AL24 DDR[0]_A[1] DDR[0] Address Bus O AC22 DDR[0]_A[2] DDR[0] Address Bus O AJ23 DDR[0]_A[3] DDR[0] Address Bus O AJ27 DDR[0]_A[4] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK28 DDR[0]_A[5] DDR[0] Address Bus O AH27 DDR[0]_A[6] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK30 DDR[0]_A[7] DDR[0] Address Bus O AG23 DDR[0]_A[8] DDR[0] Address Bus O AL29 DDR[0]_A[9] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK29 DDR[0]_A[10] DDR[0] Address Bus O AD23 DDR[0]_A[11] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK24 DDR[0]_A[12] DDR[0] Address Bus O AH23 DDR[0]_A[13] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK23 DDR[0]_A[14] DDR[0] Address Bus O AL23 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0] Address Bus O AK22 DDR[0]_BA[0] DDR[0] Bank Address outputs O AK26 DDR[0]_BA[1] DDR[0] Bank Address outputs O AF23 DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0] Bank Address outputs O AH25 DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0] Column Address Strobe output O AK25 DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0] Clock Enable O AD20 DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0] Negative Clock O AK27 DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0] Clock O AL27 DDR[0]_CS[0] DDR[0] Chip Select O AB21 DDR[0]_D[0] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AL9 DDR[0]_D[1] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK9 DDR[0]_D[2] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK10 DDR[0]_D[3] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AJ11 DDR[0]_D[4] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AH11 DDR[0]_D[5] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AD9 DDR[0]_D[6] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AF11 DDR[0]_D[7] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AL12 DDR[0]_D[8] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AJ12 DDR[0]_D[9] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AG12 DDR[0]_D[10] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AD12 DDR[0]_D[11] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AB12 DDR[0]_D[12] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK13 DDR[0]_D[13] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AC13 DDR[0]_D[14] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AL14 DDR[0]_D[15] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK14 DDR[0]_D[16] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AH15 DDR[0]_D[17] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AF15 DDR[0]_D[18] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AD15 DDR[0]_D[19] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK16 DDR[0]_D[20] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AJ16 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 69 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-16. DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller 0 Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] DDR[0]_D[21] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AG16 DDR[0]_D[22] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AD16 DDR[0]_D[23] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AC16 DDR[0]_D[24] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AK19 DDR[0]_D[25] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AJ19 DDR[0]_D[26] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AH19 DDR[0]_D[27] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AF19 DDR[0]_D[28] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AD19 DDR[0]_D[29] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AC19 DDR[0]_D[30] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AJ20 DDR[0]_D[31] DDR[0] Data Bus I/O AG20 DDR[0]_DQM[0] Data Mask for lower byte data bus DDR[0]_D[7:0] O AL8 DDR[0]_DQM[1] Data Mask for DDR[0]_D[15:8] O AK12 DDR[0]_DQM[2] Data Mask for DDR[0]_D[23:16] O AJ15 DDR[0]_DQM[3] Data Mask for upper byte data bus DDR[0]_D[31:24] O AK18 DDR[0]_DQS[0] Data Strobe for lower byte data bus DDR[0]_D[7:0] I/O AL11 DDR[0]_DQS[0] Complimentary data strobe for lower byte data bus DDR[0]_D[7:0] I/O AK11 DDR[0]_DQS[1] Complimentary data strobe for DDR[0]_D[15:8] I/O AK15 DDR[0]_DQS[1] Data Strobe for DDR[0]_D[15:8] I/O AL15 DDR[0]_DQS[2] Data Strobe for DDR[0]_D[23:16] I/O AL17 DDR[0]_DQS[2] Complimentary data strobe for DDR[0]_D[23:16] I/O AK17 DDR[0]_DQS[3] Complimentary data strobe for upper byte data bus DDR[0]_D[31:24] I/O AK20 DDR[0]_DQS[3] Data Strobe for upper byte data bus DDR[0]_D[31:24] I/O AL20 DDR[0]_ODT[0] DDR[0] On-Die Termination for Chip Select 0 O AL21 DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0] Row Address Strobe output O AJ25 DDR[0]_RST DDR[0] Reset output O AA20 DDR[0]_VTP DDR VTP Compensation Resistor Connection I AL30 DDR[0]_WE DDR[0] Write Enable O AL26 70 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 3.3.6 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 EDMA Table 3-17. EDMA Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] EDMA_EVT0 External EDMA Event 0 I AD2, W8 EDMA_EVT1 External EDMA Event 1 I G28, Y11 EDMA_EVT2 External EDMA Event 2 I AG30, Y3 EDMA_EVT3 External EDMA Event 3 I AB9, AF27 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 71 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.7 www.ti.com EMAC [(R)(G)MII Modes] and MDIO 3.3.7.1 EMAC Table 3-18. EMAC Terminal Functions [(R)(G)MII] SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] EMAC[0]_GMTCLK/EMAC[1]_RGRXC GMII Source Asynchronous Transmit Clock / RGMII Receive Clock I/O AL6 EMAC[0]_MCOL/EMAC[0]_RGRXCTL [G]MII Collision Detect (Sense) input / RGMII Receive Control I AH1 EMAC[0]_MCRS/EMAC[0]_RGRXD[2] [G]MII Carrier Sense input / RGMII Receive Data I AH2 EMAC[0]_MRCLK/EMAC[0]_RGTXC [G]MII Receive Clock / RGMII Transmit Clock I/O AK1 EMAC[0]_MRXDV/EMAC[1]_RGRXD[1] [G]MII Receive Data Valid input / RGMII Receive Data I/O AJ6 EMAC[0]_MRXD[0]/EMAC[0]_RGTXD[0] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AK2 EMAC[0]_MRXD[1]/EMAC[0]_RGRXD[0] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Receive Data I/O AL2 EMAC[0]_MRXD[2]/EMAC[0]_RGRXD[1] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Receive Data I/O AL3 EMAC[0]_MRXD[3]/EMAC[1]_RGRXCTL [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Receive Control I/O AK3 EMAC[0]_MRXD[4]/EMAC[0]_RGRXD[3] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Receive Data I/O AK4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[5]/EMAC[0]_RGTXD[3] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AJ4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[6]/EMAC[0]_RGTXD[2] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AL5 EMAC[0]_MRXD[7]/EMAC[0]_RGTXD[1] [G]MII Receive Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AK5 EMAC[0]_MRXER/EMAC[0]_RGTXCTL [G]MII Receive Data Error input / RGMII Transmit Enable I/O AJ2 EMAC[0]_MTCLK/EMAC[0]_RGRXC [G]MII Transmit Clock input / RGMII Receive Clock I/O AG4 EMAC[0]_MTXD[0]/EMAC[1]_RGRXD[3] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Receive Data I/O AK6 EMAC[0]_MTXD[1]/EMAC[1]_RGTXD[1] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AJ7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[2]/EMAC[1]_RGTXCTL [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Trasmit Enable I/O AK7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[3]/EMAC[1]_RGTXD[0] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AE4 EMAC[0]_MTXD[4]/EMAC[1]_RGTXD[2] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AK8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[5]/EMAC[1]_RGTXC [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Transmit Clock I/O AJ8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[6]/EMAC[1]_RGRXD[0] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Receive Data I/O AH8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[7]/EMAC[1]_RGTXD[3] [G]MII Transmit Data / RGMII Transmit Data I/O AG8 EMAC[0]_MTXEN/EMAC[1]_RGRXD[2] [G]MII Transmit Data Enable output / RGMII Receive Data I/O AF8 EMAC[0]_RMCRSDV RMII Carrier Sense input I AK1 EMAC[0]_RMRXD[0] RMII Receive Data I AH1 EMAC[0]_RMRXD[1] RMII Receive Data I AH2 EMAC[0]_RMRXER RMII Receive Data Error input I AJ2 EMAC[0]_RMTXD[0] RMII Transmit Data O AK2 EMAC[0]_RMTXD[1] RMII Transmit Data O AL2 EMAC[0]_RMTXEN RMII Transmit Data Enable output O AL3 EMAC[1]_GMTCLK GMII Source Asynchronous Transmit Clock O H4 EMAC[1]_MCOL [G]MII Collision Detect (Sense) input I E2 EMAC[1]_MCRS [G]MII Carrier Sense input I F5 EMAC[1]_MRCLK [G]MII Receive Clock I F2 EMAC[1]_MRXD[0] [G]MII Receive Data I F3 EMAC[1]_MRXD[1] [G]MII Receive Data I G1 EMAC[1]_MRXD[2] [G]MII Receive Data I G2 EMAC[1]_MRXD[3] [G]MII Receive Data I H3 EMAC[1]_MRXD[4] [G]MII Receive Data I G3 EMAC[1]_MRXD[5] [G]MII Receive Data I H5 EMAC[1]_MRXD[6] [G]MII Receive Data I H6 72 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-18. EMAC Terminal Functions [(R)(G)MII] (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] EMAC[1]_MRXD[7] [G]MII Receive Data I J8 EMAC[1]_MRXDV [G]MII Receive Data Valid input I J1 EMAC[1]_MRXER [G]MII Receive Data Error input I F1 EMAC[1]_MTCLK [G]MII Transmit Clock input I D3 EMAC[1]_MTXD[0] [G]MII Transmit Data O J9 EMAC[1]_MTXD[1] [G]MII Transmit Data O L3 EMAC[1]_MTXD[2] [G]MII Transmit Data O K1 EMAC[1]_MTXD[3] [G]MII Transmit Data O H2 EMAC[1]_MTXD[4] [G]MII Transmit Data O M11 EMAC[1]_MTXD[5] [G]MII Transmit Data O L12 EMAC[1]_MTXD[6] [G]MII Transmit Data O M10 EMAC[1]_MTXD[7] [G]MII Transmit Data O J2 EMAC[1]_MTXEN [G]MII Transmit Data Enable output O K2 EMAC[1]_RMCRSDV RMII Carrier Sense input I AJ8, F9 EMAC[1]_RMRXD[0] RMII Receive Data I AK7, D7 EMAC[1]_RMRXD[1] RMII Receive Data I AE4, K10 EMAC[1]_RMRXER RMII Receive Data Error input I AK8, E12 EMAC[1]_RMTXD[0] RMII Transmit Data O AH8, C7 EMAC[1]_RMTXD[1] RMII Transmit Data O A6, AG8 EMAC[1]_RMTXEN RMII Transmit Data Enable output O A5, AF8 EMAC_RMREFCLK RMII Reference Clock I/O AG1 3.3.7.2 MDIO Table 3-19. MDIO Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] MDCLK Management Data Serial Clock output O AG2 MDIO Management Data I/O I/O AG3 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 73 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.8 www.ti.com GPMC Table 3-20. GPMC Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GPMC_A[0] GPMC Address 0 O AK3, M8 GPMC_A[1] GPMC Address 1 O AD1, AK4 GPMC_A[2] GPMC Address 2 O AC8, AJ4 GPMC_A[3] GPMC Address 3 O AC5, AL5 GPMC_A[4] GPMC Address 4 O AC4, AK5 GPMC_A[5] GPMC Address 5 O A2, AJ6 GPMC_A[6] GPMC Address 6 O AL6, B2 GPMC_A[7] GPMC Address 7 O AK6, C1 GPMC_A[8] GPMC Address 8 O AJ7, C2 GPMC_A[9] GPMC Address 9 O AK7, D5 GPMC_A[10] GPMC Address 10 O AE4, H9 GPMC_A[11] GPMC Address 11 O AK8, J10 GPMC_A[12] GPMC Address 12 O AJ8, B3 GPMC_A[13] GPMC Address 13 O AH8, L2 GPMC_A[14] GPMC Address 14 O AG8, L4 GPMC_A[15] GPMC Address 15 O AF8, L6 GPMC_A[16] GPMC Address 16 O M1 GPMC_A[17] GPMC Address 17 O M2 GPMC_A[18] GPMC Address 18 O M3 GPMC_A[19] GPMC Address 19 O M5 GPMC_A[20] GPMC Address 20 O AE3, N9 GPMC_A[21] GPMC Address 21 O AE2, N1 GPMC_A[22] GPMC Address 22 O AE1, N2 GPMC_A[23] GPMC Address 23 O AD2, R8 GPMC_A[24] GPMC Address 24 O AC3, AE3, Y11 GPMC_A[25] GPMC Address 25 O AA12, AE2, Y3 GPMC_A[26] GPMC Address 26 O AE1, AK3, W8 GPMC_A[27] GPMC Address 27 O AD2, AK3 GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC Address Valid output or Address Latch Enable output O AA10 GPMC_BE[1] GPMC Upper Byte Enable output O Y11 GPMC_BE[0]_CLE GPMC Lower Byte Enable output or Command Latch Enable output O Y3 GPMC_CLK GPMC Clock output O AB9 GPMC_CS[0] GPMC Chip Select 0 O AC9 GPMC_CS[1] GPMC Chip Select 1 O AA12 GPMC_CS[2] GPMC Chip Select 2 O AC3 GPMC_CS[3] GPMC Chip Select 3 O AF2 GPMC_CS[4] GPMC Chip Select 4 O AG6 GPMC_CS[5] GPMC Chip Select 5 O AB9 GPMC_CS[6] GPMC Chip Select 6 O AA10 GPMC_CS[7] GPMC Chip Select 7 O AD2 GPMC_D[0] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O W6 GPMC_D[1] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O W4 GPMC_D[2] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O W3 GPMC_D[3] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O U2 74 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-20. GPMC Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GPMC_D[4] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O W9 GPMC_D[5] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O T5 GPMC_D[6] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O T3 GPMC_D[7] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O T2 GPMC_D[8] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O T1 GPMC_D[9] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O T8 GPMC_D[10] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O R6 GPMC_D[11] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O R4 GPMC_D[12] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O R3 GPMC_D[13] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O R2 GPMC_D[14] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O R1 GPMC_D[15] GPMC Multiplexed Data/Address I/O I/O P2 GPMC_OE_RE GPMC Output Enable output O Y8 GPMC_WAIT[0] GPMC Wait input 0 I W8 GPMC_WAIT[1] GPMC Wait input 1 I AB9 GPMC_WE GPMC Write Enable output O Y5 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 75 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.9 www.ti.com General-Purpose Input/Outputs (GPIOs) 3.3.9.1 GP0 Table 3-21. GP0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP0[0] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y29 GP0[1] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB30 GP0[2] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA29 GP0[3] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA28 GP0[4] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA26 GP0[5] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y31 GP0[6] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y30 GP0[7] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K23 GP0[8] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AF27 GP0[9] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AG30 GP0[10] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K11 GP0[11] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E12 GP0[12] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB31, K10 GP0[13] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC30, D7 GP0[14] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F9 GP0[15] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C7 GP0[16] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A6 GP0[17] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A5 GP0[18] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B5 GP0[19] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C5 GP0[20] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B4 GP0[21] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A3 GP0[22] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A2 GP0[23] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B2 GP0[24] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C1 GP0[25] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C2 GP0[26] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D5 GP0[27] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H9 GP0[28] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J10 3.3.9.2 GP1 Table 3-22. GP1 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP1[0] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M21 GP1[1] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L22 GP1[2] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E31 GP1[3] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E29 GP1[4] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E30 GP1[5] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N26 GP1[6] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G28 GP1[7] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U28 GP1[8] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AG6 GP1[9] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H12 76 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-22. GP1 Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP1[10] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AG1 GP1[11] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AG2, B18 GP1[12] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A17, AG3 GP1[13] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC5, M3 GP1[14] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC4, M5 GP1[15] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC6, N9 GP1[16] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J29, N1 GP1[17] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M29, N2 GP1[18] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M27, R8 GP1[19] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AE3 GP1[20] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AE2 GP1[21] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AE1 GP1[22] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AD2 GP1[23] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC9 GP1[24] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA12 GP1[25] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC3 GP1[26] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AF2, N23 GP1[27] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB9 GP1[28] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA10 GP1[29] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y3 GP1[30] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y11 GP1[31] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O W8 3.3.9.3 GP2 Table 3-23. GP2 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP2[0] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C12 GP2[1] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J13 GP2[2] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C9 GP2[02] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B3 GP2[3] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D13 GP2[4] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C13 GP2[5] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AD1, M1 GP2[6] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC8, M2 GP2[7] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B17 GP2[8] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C17 GP2[9] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D17 GP2[10] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F17 GP2[11] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L20 GP2[12] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H20 GP2[13] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B16 GP2[14] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C16 GP2[15] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E16 GP2[16] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H17 GP2[17] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J16 GP2[18] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H16 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 77 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-23. GP2 Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP2[19] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F13 GP2[20] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H13 GP2[21] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C20 GP2[22] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F24 GP2[23] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D21 GP2[24] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C25 GP2[25] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C26 GP2[26] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C28 GP2[27] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B28 GP2[28] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D3 GP2[29] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E2 GP2[30] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F5 GP2[31] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F1 3.3.9.4 GP3 Table 3-24. GP3 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP3[0] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F2 GP3[1] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F3 GP3[2] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G1 GP3[3] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G2 GP3[4] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H3 GP3[5] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G3 GP3[6] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H5 GP3[7] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H6 GP3[8] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J8 GP3[9] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J1 GP3[10] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H4 GP3[11] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J9 GP3[12] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L3 GP3[13] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K1 GP3[14] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H2 GP3[15] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M11 GP3[16] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L12 GP3[17] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M10 GP3[18] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J2 GP3[19] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K2 GP3[20] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L2 GP3[21] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L4 GP3[22] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L6 GP3[23] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AG4 GP3[24] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AH1 GP3[25] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AH2 GP3[26] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AJ2 GP3[27] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AK1 GP3[28] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AK2 78 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-24. GP3 Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] GP3[29] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AL2 GP3[30] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AL3, M8 GP3[31] Interrupt-Capable General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AJ31 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 79 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.10 Ground Pins (VSS) Table 3-25. Ground Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] VSS Ground (GND) VSSA_AUXOSC Supply Ground for Auxiliary Oscillator. If internal oscillator GND is bypassed, this pin should be connected to ground. U30 VSSA_CSI2 Analog GND for CSI2. Connect to ground even if the CSI2 is not being used. AC7, V14 VSSA_DEVOSC Supply Ground for DEV Oscillator. If the internal oscillator GND is bypassed, this pin should be connected to ground. G30 VSSA_HDMI Analog GND for HDMI. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to ground, even if HDMI is not being used. GND G9, H8 VSSA_USB Analog GND for USB0 and USB1. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to ground, even if USB is not being used. GND D20, N19, N20 VSSA_VDAC Analog GND for VDAC. For proper device operation, this GND pin must always be connected to ground, even if VDAC is not being used. 80 Device Pins GND AAR BALL [4] GND A1, A31, AA13, AA14, AA15, AA16, AA17, AA18, AA27, AC25, AD24, AD25, AD3, AD4, AD5, AD6, AD7, AE12, AE19, AE20, AE23, AE24, AE25, AE26, AE27, AE28, AE5, AE6, AE7, AE8, AE9, AF12, AF20, AF24, AF25, AF7, AG11, AG19, AG24, AG25, AG7, AH12, AH20, AH7, AL1, AL31, D25, D8, E21, E25, E7, E8, F20, F25, F7, F8, G20, G23, G24, G25, G26, G27, G4, G5, G6, G7, G8, H26, H7, J7, L16, M16, N13, N14, N16, N17, P11, P12, P14, P18, R11, R12, R14, R18, R20, R21, T11, T12, T14, T15, T16, T19, T20, T21, U14, U18, U23, V18, W16, W17, Y16, Y17, Y25, Y26, Y28 C8 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.11 HDMI Table 3-26. HDMI Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] HDMI_CEC HDMI Consumer Electronics Control I/O I/O M8, N2 HDMI_CLKN HDMI Clock Output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B15 HDMI_CLKP HDMI Clock Output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O A15 HDMI_DN0 HDMI Data 0 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O A14 HDMI_DN1 HDMI Data 1 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B13 HDMI_DN2 HDMI Data 2 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O A12 HDMI_DP0 HDMI Data 0 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B14 HDMI_DP1 HDMI Data 1 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B12 HDMI_DP2 HDMI Data 2 output. When the HDMI PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O A11 HDMI_HPDET HDMI Hot Plug Detect Input I L6, R8 HDMI_SCL HDMI I2C Serial Clock Output I/O D2, L2 HDMI_SDA HDMI I2C Serial Data I/O I/O D1, L4 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 81 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.12 I2C Table 3-27. I2C Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] I2C[0]_SCL I2C[0] Clock I/O. For proper device operation, this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. I/O T27 I2C[0]_SDA I2C[0] Data I/O. For proper device operation, this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. I/O T24 I2C[1]_SCL I2C[1] Clock I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. I/O D2 I2C[1]_SDA I2C[1] Data I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, I/O this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. D1 I2C[2]_SCL I2C[2] Clock I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. E31, J13, K11, L2 I2C[2]_SDA I2C[2] Data I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, I/O this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. AG4, C12, E29, L4 I2C[3]_SCL I2C[3] Clock I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. I/O AE31, G3, K10, L22 I2C[3]_SDA I2C[3] Data I/O. For proper device operation in I2C mode, I/O this pin must be pulled up via external resistor. AE30, D7, H5, M21 82 Device Pins I/O Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.13 McASP 3.3.13.1 McASP0 Table 3-28. McASP0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] MCA[0]_ACLKR McASP0 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O AD30 MCA[0]_ACLKX McASP0 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O AD28 MCA[0]_AFSR McASP0 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O AF30 MCA[0]_AFSX McASP0 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O AE29 MCA[0]_AHCLKX McASP0 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O I/O AF31 MCA[0]_AXR[0] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AF29 MCA[0]_AXR[1] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AE31 MCA[0]_AXR[2] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AE30 MCA[0]_AXR[3] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AC31 MCA[0]_AXR[4] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AD26 MCA[0]_AXR[5] McASP0 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AD27 3.3.13.2 McASP1 Table 3-29. McASP1 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] MCA[1]_ACLKR McASP1 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O AD29 MCA[1]_ACLKX McASP1 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O AC23 MCA[1]_AFSR McASP1 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O AC24 MCA[1]_AFSX McASP1 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O AB22 MCA[1]_AHCLKX McASP1 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O I/O AF27 MCA[1]_AXR[0] McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O Y22 MCA[1]_AXR[1] McASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O Y21 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 83 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.14 Oscillator/PLL, Audio Reference Clocks, and Clock Generator 3.3.14.1 Audio Reference Clocks Table 3-30. Audio Reference Clocks Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] AUD_CLKIN0 Audio Reference Clock 0 for Audio Peripherals I AF31 AUD_CLKIN1 Audio Reference Clock 1 for Audio Peripherals I AF27 AUD_CLKIN2 Audio Reference Clock 2 for Audio Peripherals I AG30 3.3.14.2 CLOCK GENERATOR Table 3-31. Clock Generator Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] CLKOUT0 Device Clock output 0. Can be used as a system clock for other devices. O AJ31, H12 CLKOUT1 Device Clock output 1. Can be used as a system clock for other devices. O AB9, J16 3.3.14.3 OSCILLATOR/PLL Table 3-32. Oscillator/PLL Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] AUXOSC_MXI Auxiliary Crystal input [Optional Audio/Video Reference Crystal Input]. Crystal connection to internal oscillator for auxiliary clock. Functions as AUX_CLKIN clock input when an external oscillator is used. If neither a crystal or external clock is used, this pin should be connected to ground. I V30 AUXOSC_MXO Auxiliary Crystal output [Optional Audio/Video Reference Crystal Output]. When auxiliary oscillator is BYPASSED, leave this pin unconnected. O U31 CLKIN32 RTC Clock input. Optional 32.768 KHz clock for RTC reference. I AJ31 DEVOSC_MXI Device Crystal input. Crystal connection to internal oscillator for system clock. Functions as DEV_CLKIN clock input when an external oscillator is used. I F30 DEVOSC_MXO Device Crystal output. Crystal connection to internal oscillator for system clock. When device oscillator is BYPASSED, leave this pin unconnected. O G31 DEVOSC_WAKE Oscillator Wake-up input I U28 DEV_CLKIN Clock input when an external oscillator is used I F30 84 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.15 PCI Express (PCIe) Table 3-33. PCI Express (PCIe) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] PCIE_RXN0 PCIE Receive Data Lane 0. When the PCIe SERDES are I powered down, these pins should be left unconnected. J30 PCIE_RXP0 PCIE Receive Data Lane 0. When the PCIe SERDES are I powered down, these pins should be left unconnected. K30 PCIE_TXN0 PCIE Transmit Data Lane 0. When the PCIe SERDES are powered down, these pins should be left unconnected. O K31 PCIE_TXP0 PCIE Transmit Data Lane 0. When the PCIe SERDES are powered down, these pins should be left unconnected. O L31 SERDES_CLKN PCIE Serdes Reference Clock Inputs. When PCIe is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I H31 SERDES_CLKP PCIE Serdes Reference Clock Inputs. When PCIe is not used these pins can be left unconnected. I H30 NOTE PCIe is supported on all DM385 devices and also on DM388 devices with PCIe enabled. For DM388 devices with PCIe disabled, the pins in Table 3-33 should be left unconnected. Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 85 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.16 Reserved Pins Table 3-34. Reserved Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] RSV0 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. J25 RSV1 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. H27 RSV2 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. H24 RSV27 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. L30 RSV28 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. M30 RSV29 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. N30 RSV3 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. H28 RSV30 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. N31 RSV31 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. P31 RSV32 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. R30 RSV33 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. T30 RSV34 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. AH24 RSV35 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. AJ24 RSV39 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. H25 RSV4 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. RSV40 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. H29 RSV41 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. AD8 RSV42 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. RSV43 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. RSV5 Reserved. Leave unconnected, do not connect to power or ground. PWR G16 RSV54 For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply. PWR M28 RSV55 For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply. PWR N27 86 Device Pins PWR O G17 AK21 P30 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.17 Reset, Interrupts, and JTAG Interface 3.3.17.1 Interupts Table 3-35. Interrupts Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] NMI DESCRIPTION [2] Non-Maskable Interrupt input TYPE [3] I AAR BALL [4] AH31 3.3.17.2 JTAG Table 3-36. JTAG Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] EMU0 Emulator pin 0 I/O A18 EMU1 Emulator pin 1 I/O B19 EMU2 Emulator pin 2 I/O F24 EMU3 Emulator pin 3 I/O C25 EMU4 Emulator pin 4 I/O C28 RTCK JTAG return clock output. The internal pullup (IPU) is enabled for this pin when the device is in reset and the IPU is disabled (DIS) when reset is released. O N29 TCLK JTAG test clock input I T29 TDI JTAG test data input I N28 TDO JTAG test port data output O U26 TMS JTAG test port mode select input. For proper operation, do not oppose the IPU on this pin. I T31 TRST JTAG test port reset input I U24 3.3.17.3 Reset Table 3-37. Reset Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] POR Power-On Reset input I AH30 RESET Device Reset input I AH29 RSTOUT_WD_OUT Reset output (RSTOUT) or watchdog out (WD_OUT). If this pin is unused, it can be left unconnected. O AJ30 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 87 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.18 SD Signals (MMC/SD/SDIO) 3.3.18.1 SD0 Table 3-38. SD0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SD0_CLK SD0 Clock output O AB30 SD0_CMD SD0 Command output O AA29 SD0_DAT[0] SD0 Data0 I/O. Functions as data bit 0 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and single data bit for 1-bit SD mode. I/O AA28 SD0_DAT[3] SD0 Data3 I/O. Functions as data bit 3 for 4-/8-bit SD mode. I/O Y30 SD0_DAT[4] SD0 Data4 I/O. Functions as data bit 4 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O Y22 SD0_DAT[5] SD0 Data5 I/O. Functions as data bit 5 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O Y21 SD0_DAT[6] SD0 Data6 I/O. Functions as data bit 6 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AB31 SD0_DAT[7] SD0 Data7 I/O. Functions as data bit 7 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AC30 SD0_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD0 Data1 I/O. Functions as data bit 1 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as an IRQ input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O AA26 SD0_DAT[2]_SDRW SD0 Data2 I/O. Functions as data bit 2 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as a Read Wait input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O Y31 SD0_SDCD SD0 Card Detect input I D30 3.3.18.2 SD1 Table 3-39. SD1Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SD1_CLK SD1 Clock output O W30 SD1_CMD SD1 Command output O AA29, Y29 SD1_DAT[0] SD1 Data0 I/O. Functions as data bit 0 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and single data bit for 1-bit SD mode. I/O W31 SD1_DAT[3] SD1 Data3 I/O. Functions as data bit 3 for 4-/8-bit SD mode. I/O Y27 SD1_DAT[4] SD1 Data4 I/O. Functions as data bit 4 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AA28 SD1_DAT[5] SD1 Data5 I/O. Functions as data bit 5 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AA26 SD1_DAT[6] SD1 Data6 I/O. Functions as data bit 6 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O Y31 SD1_DAT[7] SD1 Data7 I/O. Functions as data bit 7 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O Y30 SD1_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD1 Data1 I/O. Functions as data bit 1 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as an IRQ input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O AA30 SD1_DAT[2]_SDRW SD1 Data2 I/O. Functions as data bit 2 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as a Read Wait input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O U29 SD1_POW SD1 Card Power Enable output O E31 SD1_SDCD SD1 Card Detect input I G28 SD1_SDWP SD1 Card Write Protect input I E29 88 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.18.3 SD2 Table 3-40. SD2Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SD2_CMD SD2 Command output O AG6 SD2_DAT[0] SD2 Data0 I/O. Functions as data bit 0 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and single data bit for 1-bit SD mode. O AC4 SD2_DAT[3] SD2 Data3 I/O. Functions as data bit 3 for 4-/8-bit SD mode. I/O AD1 SD2_DAT[4] SD2 Data4 I/O. Functions as data bit 4 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AD2 SD2_DAT[5] SD2 Data5 I/O. Functions as data bit 5 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AE1 SD2_DAT[6] SD2 Data6 I/O. Functions as data bit 6 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AE2 SD2_DAT[7] SD2 Data7 I/O. Functions as data bit 7 for 8-bit SD mode. I/O AE3 SD2_DAT[1]_SDIRQ SD2 Data1 I/O. Functions as data bit 1 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as an IRQ input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O AC5 SD2_DAT[2]_SDRW SD2 Data2 I/O. Functions as data bit 2 for 4-/8-bit SD mode and as a Read Wait input for 1-bit SD mode. I/O AC8 SD2_SCLK SD2 Clock output I/O AC6 SD2_SDCD SD2 Card Detect input I D31 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 89 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.19 SPI 3.3.19.1 SPI 0 Table 3-41. SPI 0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SPI[0]_D[0] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O J28 SPI[0]_D[1] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O J27 SPI[0]_SCLK SPI Clock I/O I/O N24 SPI[0]_SCS[0] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O G29 SPI[0]_SCS[1] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O G28 SPI[0]_SCS[2] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O E29 SPI[0]_SCS[3] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O E31 3.3.19.2 SPI 1 Table 3-42. SPI 1 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SPI[1]_D[0] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O N23 SPI[1]_D[1] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O M27 SPI[1]_SCLK SPI Clock I/O I/O M29 SPI[1]_SCS[0] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O J29 SPI[1]_SCS[1] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O U28 SPI[1]_SCS[2] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O D31 SPI[1]_SCS[3] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O D30 3.3.19.3 SPI 2 Table 3-43. SPI 2 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SPI[2]_D[0] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O AK6, M8, N1 SPI[2]_D[1] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O AL6, L6, N2 SPI[2]_SCLK SPI Clock I/O I/O AJ6, L4, R8 SPI[2]_SCS[0] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O AF2 SPI[2]_SCS[1] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O N9 SPI[2]_SCS[2] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O L2 SPI[2]_SCS[3] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O AK5 3.3.19.4 SPI 3 Table 3-44. SPI 3 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SPI[3]_D[0] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O A5, F5, M10 SPI[3]_D[1] SPI Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O A6, E2, L12 90 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-44. SPI 3 Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] SPI[3]_SCLK SPI Clock I/O I/O C20, C7, M11 SPI[3]_SCS[0] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O F9 SPI[3]_SCS[1] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O H2 SPI[3]_SCS[2] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O AK1 SPI[3]_SCS[3] SPI Chip Select I/O I/O AG4 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 91 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.20 Supply Voltages Table 3-45. Supply Voltages Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] CVDD Variable Voltage Supply for the CORE_L Core Logic Voltage Domain PWR P15, P17, R15, R17, T13, T17, T18, U11, U12, U15, U17, V11, V12, V15, V17, W13, W14, W19, W20, Y13, Y14, Y19, Y20 CVDD_ARM Variable Voltage Supply for the ARM_L Core Logic Voltage Domain. For actual voltage supply ranges, see Recommended Operating Conditions. PWR K17, L17, L18, M13, M14, M17 CVDD_HDVICP Variable Voltage Supply for the HDVICP_L Core Logic Voltage Domain. For actual voltage supply ranges, see Recommended Operating Conditions. PWR U20, U21, V20, V21, W22 DVDD 3.3 V/1.8 V Power Supply for General I/Os PWR D16, E17, F16, L5, M4, M6, M7, N10, N11, T26, T28, U27 DVDD_C 3.3 V/1.8 V Power Supply for Camera I/F I/Os. For proper PWR device operation, this pin must always be connected to a DVDD Power Supply, even if the Camera I/F is not being used. D12, E13, F12, G12, G13 DVDD_DDR[0] 1.35 V/1.5 V/1.8 V Power Supply for DDR[0] I/Os PWR AB14, AB15, AB17, AB18, AC15, AC17, AC18, AE15, AE16, AF16, AG15, AH16 DVDD_GPMC 3.3 V/1.8 V Power Supply for GPMC I/Os. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a DVDD Power Supply, even if the GPMC is not being used. PWR R5, R7, T4, T6, T7 DVDD_RGMII 3.3 V/1.8 V Power Supply for RGMII I/Os. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a DVDD Power Supply, even if the RGMII is not being used. PWR W5, W7, Y4, Y6, Y7 DVDD_SD 3.3 V/1.8 V Power Supply for MMC/SD/SDIO I/Os. For PWR proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a DVDD Power Supply, even if the interface is not being used. T25, U25 LDOCAP_ARM ARM Cortex-A8 VBB LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A J19 LDOCAP_ARMRAM ARM Cortex-A8 RAM LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A K20 LDOCAP_HDVICP HDVICP2 VBB LDO output.This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A W23 LDOCAP_HDVICPRAM HDVICP2 RAM LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A Y24 LDOCAP_RAM0 CORE RAM0 LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A U9 LDOCAP_RAM1 CORE RAM1 LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A T22 LDOCAP_RAM2 CORE RAM2 LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A AB10 LDOCAP_SERDESCLK SERDES_CLKP/N Pins LDO output. This pin must always be connected via a 1-uF capacitor to VSS. A M24 VDDA_1P8 1.8 V Power Supply for on-chip LDOs and I/O biasing PWR M25, N22, N25, P23, R9, T10, T9 VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_ARM PWR L19 VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_AUDIO and PWR PLL_HDVPSS. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply. 92 Device Pins V9 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-45. Supply Voltages Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VDDA_CSI2_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for CSI2. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the CSI2 is not being used. PWR W10 VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_DDR PWR AA19 VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8 1.8 V Reference Power Supply for HDDAC. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the HDDAC is not being used. PWR L15 VDDA_HDDAC_1P1 1.1 V Power Supply for HD-DAC Digital Logic. For proper PWR device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.1-V Power Supply, or if the HD-DAC is not being used it can be connected to a power supply in the range of 0.9–1.35 V (same level as other core voltages). K16 VDDA_HDDAC_1P8 1.8 V Power Supply for HDDAC Analog Circuit. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the HDDAC is not being used. PWR L14 VDDA_HDMI_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for HDMI. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the HDMI is not being used. PWR K14 VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_HDVICP. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the HDVICP2 is not being used. PWR T23 VDDA_L3L4PLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_L3L4 PWR W11 VDDA_PCIE_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PCIe. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the PCIe is not being used. PWR M26 VDDA_USB0_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for USB0. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the USB0 is not being used. PWR K19 VDDA_USB1_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for USB1 .For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the USB1 is not being used. PWR J17 VDDA_USB_3P3 3.3 V Analog Power Supply for USB0 and USB1. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 3.3-V Power Supply, even if USB0 and USB1 are not being used. PWR M19, M20 VDDA_VDAC_1P8 1.8 V Reference Power Supply for VDAC. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply, even if the VDAC is not being used. PWR J14 VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8 1.8 V Analog Power Supply for PLL_VIDEO0 and PLL_VIDEO1. For proper device operation, this pin must always be connected to a 1.8-V Power Supply. PWR L13 VDDS_OSC0_1P8 Oscillator0 IO secondary supply and LJCB LDO supply PWR P21 VDDS_OSC1_1P8 Oscillator1 IO secondary power supply PWR P20 VREFSSTL_DDR[0] Reference Power Supply DDR[0] PWR AL18 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 93 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.21 Timer Table 3-46. Timer Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] TIM2_IO Timer 2 capture event input or PWM output I/O AF27, AG1, M3 TIM3_IO Timer 3 capture event input or PWM output I/O AG30, AJ31, M5 TIM4_IO Timer 4 capture event input or PWM output I/O AB9, G28, N2 TIM5_IO Timer 5 capture event input or PWM output I/O AA10, R8, U28 TIM6_IO Timer 6 capture event input or PWM output I/O AE1, F1, Y3 TIM7_IO Timer 7 capture event input or PWM output I/O AD2, C20, Y11 94 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.22 UART 3.3.22.1 UART0 Table 3-47. UART0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] UART0_CTS UART0 Clear to Send Input. Functions as SD transceiver control output in IrDA and CIR modes. I/O D30 UART0_DCD UART0 Data Carrier Detect Input I E31 UART0_DSR UART0 Data Set Ready Input I E29 UART0_DTR UART0 Data Terminal Ready Output O E30 UART0_RIN UART0 Ring Indicator Input I N26 UART0_RTS UART0 Request to Send Output. Indicates module is ready to receive data. Functions as transmit data output in IrDA modes. O D31 UART0_RXD UART0 Receive Data Input. Functions as IrDA receive input in IrDA modes and CIR receive input in CIR mode. I J26 UART0_TXD UART0 Transmit Data Output. Functions as CIR transmit output in CIR mode. O E28 3.3.22.2 UART1 Table 3-48. UART1 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] UART1_CTS UART1 Clear to Send Input. Functions as SD transceiver control output in IrDA and CIR modes. I/O AG8 UART1_RTS UART1 Request to Send Output. Indicates module is ready to receive data. Functions as transmit data output in IrDA modes. O AF8 UART1_RXD UART1 Receive Data Input. Functions as IrDA receive input in IrDA modes and CIR receive input in CIR mode. (N26:MUX0, AJ8:MUX1) I AJ8, N26 UART1_TXD UART1 Transmit Data Output. Functions as CIR transmit output in CIR mode. (E30:MUX0, AH8:MUX1) O AH8, E30 3.3.22.3 UART2 Table 3-49. UART2 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] UART2_CTS UART2 Clear to Send Input. Functions as SD transceiver control output in IrDA and CIR modes. I/O J10 UART2_RTS UART2 Request to Send Output. Indicates module is ready to receive data. Functions as transmit data output in IrDA modes. O B3 UART2_RXD UART2 Receive Data Input. Functions as IrDA receive input in IrDA modes and CIR receive input in CIR mode. (D5:MUX0, L22:MUX1, AE3:MUX3) I AE3, D5, L22 UART2_TXD UART2 Transmit Data Output. Functions as CIR transmit output in CIR mode. (H9:MUX0, M21:MUX1, AE2:MUX3) O AE2, H9, M21 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 95 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.23 USB 3.3.23.1 USB0 Table 3-50. USB0 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] USB0_CE USB0 charger enable. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B20 USB0_DM USB0 bidirectional data differential signal pair [plus/minus]. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I/O B21 USB0_DP USB0 bidirectional data differential signal pair [plus/minus]. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I/O A21 USB0_DRVVBUS USB0 Contoller VBUS Control ouput. When this pin is used as USB0_DRVVBUS and the USB0 Controller is operating as a Host, this signal is used by the USB0 Controller to enable the external VBUS charge pump. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O K23 USB0_ID USB0 identification input. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I A20 USB0_VBUSIN 5-V USB0 VBUS comparator input. This analog input pin senses the level of the USB VBUS voltage and should connect directly to the USB VBUS voltage. When the USB0 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I B22 3.3.23.2 USB1 Table 3-51. USB1 Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] USB1_CE USB1 charger enable. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O C21 USB1_DM USB1 bidirectional data differential signal pair [plus/minus]. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I/O B23 USB1_DP USB1 bidirectional data differential signal pair [plus/minus]. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I/O A23 USB1_DRVVBUS USB1 Contoller VBUS Control ouput. When this pin is used as USB1_DRVVBUS and the USB1 Controller is operating as a Host, this signal is used by the USB1 Controller to enable the external VBUS charge pump. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. O AF31 USB1_ID USB1 identification input. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I A24 USB1_VBUSIN 5-V USB1 VBUS comparator input. This analog input pin senses the level of the USB VBUS voltage and should connect directly to the USB VBUS voltage. When the USB1 PHY is powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I B24 96 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.24 Video Input (Digital) 3.3.24.1 Video Input 0 (Digital) Table 3-52. Video Input 0 (Digital) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VIN[0]A_CLK Video Input 0 Port A Clock input. Input clock for 8-bit, 16bit, or 24-bit Port A video capture. I C9 VIN[0]A_D[0] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I B18 VIN[0]A_D[1] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I A17 VIN[0]A_D[2] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I B17 VIN[0]A_D[3] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I C17 VIN[0]A_D[4] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I D17 VIN[0]A_D[5] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I F17 VIN[0]A_D[6] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I L20 VIN[0]A_D[7] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B data inputs. I H20 VIN[0]A_D[16] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. K11 VIN[0]A_D[17] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. E12 VIN[0]A_D[18] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. K10 VIN[0]A_D[19] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. D7 VIN[0]A_D[20] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. F9 VIN[0]A_D[21] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. C7 VIN[0]A_D[22] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. A6 VIN[0]A_D[23] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R data inputs. A5 VIN[0]A_DE Video Input 0 Port A Data Enable input. Discrete data valid signal for Port A RGB capture mode or YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). B5, C12 I Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 97 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-52. Video Input 0 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VIN[0]A_D[10]_BD[2] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I E16 VIN[0]A_D[11]_BD[3] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I H17 VIN[0]A_D[12]_BD[4] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I J16 VIN[0]A_D[13]_BD[5] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I H16 VIN[0]A_D[14]_BD[6] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I F13 VIN[0]A_D[15]_BD[7] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I H13 VIN[0]A_D[8]_BD[0] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I B16 VIN[0]A_D[9]_BD[1] Video Input 0 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[15:8] are Y Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[15:8] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G data inputs. I C16 VIN[0]A_FLD Video Input 0 Port A Field ID input. Discrete field identification signal for Port A RGB capture mode or YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I B4, J13 VIN[0]A_HSYNC Video Input 0 Port A Horizontal Sync0 input. Discrete horizontal synchronization signal for Port A RGB capture mode or YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I D13 VIN[0]A_VSYNC Video Input 0 Port A Vertical Sync0 input. Discrete vertical synchronization signal for Port A RGB capture mode or YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I C13 VIN[0]B_CLK Video Input 0 Port B Clock input. Input clock for 8-bit Port I B video capture. This signal is not used in 16-bit and 24bit capture modes. H12 VIN[0]B_DE Video Input 0 Port B Data Enable input. Discrete data valid signal for Port B RGB capture mode or YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I C5 VIN[0]B_FLD Video Input 0 Port B Field ID input. Discrete field I identification signal for Port B 8-bit YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). Not used in RGB or 16-bit YCbCr capture modes. A3 VIN[0]B_HSYNC Video Input 0 Port B Horizontal Sync input. Discrete horizontal synchronization signal for Port B 8-bit YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). Not used in RGB or 16-bit YCbCr capture modes. I C12 VIN[0]B_VSYNC Video Input 0 Port B Vertical Sync1 input. Discrete vertical synchronization signal for Port B 8-bit YCbCr capture without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). Not used in RGB or 16-bit YCbCr capture modes. I J13 98 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.24.2 Video Input 1 (Digital) Table 3-53. Video Input 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VIN[1]A_CLK Video Input 1 Port A Clock input. Input clock for 8-bit, 16bit, or 24-bit Port A video capture. Input data is sampled on the CLK0 edge. I F1 VIN[1]A_D[0] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I F2 VIN[1]A_D[1] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I F3 VIN[1]A_D[2] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I G1 VIN[1]A_D[3] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I G2 VIN[1]A_D[4] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I H3 VIN[1]A_D[5] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I G3 VIN[1]A_D[6] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I H5 VIN[1]A_D[7] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, D[7:0] are Cb/Cr Port A inputs. For 8-bit capture, D[7:0] are Port A YCbCr data inputs. For RGB capture, D[7:0] are B Port A data inputs. I M8 VIN[1]A_D[8] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. H6 VIN[1]A_D[9] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. J8 VIN[1]A_D[10] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. J1 VIN[1]A_D[11] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. H4 VIN[1]A_D[12] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. J9 VIN[1]A_D[13] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. L3 VIN[1]A_D[14] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. K1 VIN[1]A_D[15] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For 16-bit capture, [15:8] are Y I Port A inputs. For RGB capture, D[15:8] are G Port A data inputs. H2 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 99 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-53. Video Input 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VIN[1]A_D[16] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. M11 VIN[1]A_D[17] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. L12 VIN[1]A_D[18] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. M10 VIN[1]A_D[19] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. J2 VIN[1]A_D[20] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. K2 VIN[1]A_D[21] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. L2 VIN[1]A_D[22] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. L4 VIN[1]A_D[23] Video Input 1 Data inputs. For RGB capture, D[23:16] are I R Port A data inputs. L6 VIN[1]A_DE Video Input 1 Port A Data Enable input. Discrete data valid signal for Port A YCbCr capture modes without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I F5 VIN[1]A_FLD Video Input 1 Port A Field ID input. Discrete field identification signal for Port A YCbCr capture modes without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I F5 VIN[1]A_HSYNC Video Input 1 Port A Horizontal Sync input. Discrete horizontal synchronization signal for Port A YCbCr capture modes without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I D3 VIN[1]A_VSYNC Video Input 1 Port A Vertical Sync input. Discrete vertical synchronization signal for Port A YCbCr capture modes without embedded syncs (BT.601 modes). I E2 VIN[1]B_CLK Video Input 1 Port B Clock input. Input clock for 8-bit Port I B video capture. Input data is sampled on the CLK1 edge. This signal is not used in 16-bit and 24-bit capture modes. AF2 VIN[1]B_D[0] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AG4 VIN[1]B_D[1] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AH1 VIN[1]B_D[2] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AH2 VIN[1]B_D[3] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AJ2 VIN[1]B_D[4] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AK1 VIN[1]B_D[5] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AK2 VIN[1]B_D[6] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AL2 VIN[1]B_D[7] Video Input Port B Data inputs. For 8-bit capture, B_D[7:0] are Port B YCbCr data inputs. I AL3 100 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 3.3.25 Video Output (Analog, TV) Table 3-54. Video Output (Analog, TV) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] HDDAC_A Analog HD Video DAC (G/Y). This pin should be connected to ground through a 165-ohm resistor. O A9 HDDAC_B Analog HD Video DAC (B/Pb). This pin should be connected to ground through a 165-ohm resistor. O A8 HDDAC_C Analog HD Video DAC (R/Pr). This pin should be connected to ground through a 165-ohm resistor. O B8 HDDAC_HSYNC Analog HD Video DAC Discrete HSYNC Output O E9 HDDAC_IREF Video DAC reference current. When the video DACs are used, this pin should be connected to ground through a 2.67K-ohm resistor. When the video DACs are powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I/O B6 HDDAC_VREF Video DAC reference voltage. When the video DACs are powered down, this pin should be left unconnected. I B7 HDDAC_VSYNC Analog HD Video DAC Discrete VSYNC Output O D9 TV_OUT0 Composite Amplifier Output. In Normal mode (internal amplifier used), this pin drives the 75-Ohm TV load. An external resistor (Rout) should be connected between this pin and the TV_VFB0 pin and be placed as close to the pins as possible. The nominal value of Rout is 2700 Ohm. In TVOUT Bypass mode (internal amplifier not used), this pin is not used. When this pin is not used or the TV output is powered-down, this pin should be left unconnected. O B9 TV_RSET TV Input Reference Current Setting. An external resistor A (Rset) should be connected between this pin and VSSA_VDAC to set the reference current of the video DAC. The value of the resistor depends on the mode of operation. In Normal mode (internal amplifier used), the nominal value for Rset is 4700 Ohm. In TVOUT Bypass mode (internal amplifier not used), the nominal value for Rset is 10000 Ohm. When the TV output is not used, this pin should be connected to ground (VSS). B11 TV_VFB0 Composite Feedback. In Normal mode (internal amplifier O used), this pin acts as the buffer feedback node. An external resistor (Rout) should be connected between this pin and the TV_OUT0 pin. In TVOUT Bypass mode (internal amplifier not used), this pin acts as the direct Video DAC output and should be connected to ground through a load resistor (Rload) and to an external video amplifier. The nominal value of Rload is 1500 Ohm. When this pin is not used or the TV output is powereddown, this pin should be left unconnected. B10 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 101 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 3.3.26 Video Output (Digital) 3.3.26.1 Video Output 0 (Digital) Table 3-55. Video Output 0 (Digital) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[0]_AVID Video Output Active Video output. This is the discrete active video indicator output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O C20 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O F24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O D21 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O J23 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O H23 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O J24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O E24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O D24 VOUT[0]_B_CB_C[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O C24 VOUT[0]_CLK Video Output Clock output O K22 VOUT[0]_FLD Video Output Field ID output. This is the discrete field O identification output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. B3, C20 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. C25 102 Device Pins O Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-55. Video Output 0 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O C26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O E26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O B26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O A26 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O B25 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O B27 VOUT[0]_G_Y_YC[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O A27 VOUT[0]_HSYNC Video Output Horizontal Sync output. This is the discrete horizontal synchronization output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O F21 VOUT[0]_R_CR[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. C28 VOUT[0]_R_CR[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. B28 VOUT[0]_R_CR[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. B29 VOUT[0]_R_CR[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. A29 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 103 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-55. Video Output 0 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[0]_R_CR[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. C30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. B30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. A30 VOUT[0]_R_CR[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. B31 VOUT[0]_VSYNC Video Output Vertical Sync output. This is the discrete O vertical synchronization output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. E20 3.3.26.2 Video Output 1 (Digital) Table 3-56. Video Output 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[1]_AVID Video Output Active Video output. This is the discrete active video indicator output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O F1 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[0] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs O of B/Cb/C video data for 10-bit, 20-bit, and 30-bit video modes (VOUT[1] only). For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. These signals are not used in 16/24-bit modes. H9 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[1] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs O of B/Cb/C video data for 10-bit, 20-bit, and 30-bit video modes (VOUT[1] only). For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. These signals are not used in 16/24-bit modes. D5 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O M8 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O F2 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O F3 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O G1 104 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-56. Video Output 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O G2 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O H3 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O G3 VOUT[1]_B_CB_C[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of B/Cb/C video data. For RGB mode they are blue data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cb (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode they are multiplexed Cb/Cr (Chroma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are unused. O H5 VOUT[1]_CLK Video Output Clock output O D3 VOUT[1]_FLD Video Output Field ID output. This is the discrete field O identification output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. J10 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[0] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs of G/Y/YC video data for 10-bit, 20-bit, and 30-bit video modes (VOUT[1] only). For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. These signals are not used in 8/16/24-bit modes. O B2 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[1] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs of G/Y/YC video data for 10-bit, 20-bit, and 30-bit video modes (VOUT[1] only). For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. These signals are not used in 8/16/24-bit modes. O A2 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O L2 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O H6 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O J8 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O J1 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 105 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 3-56. Video Output 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O H4 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O J9 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O L3 VOUT[1]_G_Y_YC[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs of G/Y/YC video data. For RGB mode they are green data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Y data bits, for Y/C mode they are Y (Luma) data bits and for BT.656 mode they are multiplexed Y/Cb/Cr (Luma and Chroma) data bits. O K1 VOUT[1]_HSYNC Video Output Horizontal Sync output. This is the discrete horizontal synchronization output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O E2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[0] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs of R/Cr video data for 30-bit video modes. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. These signals are not used in 24-bit mode. O C2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[1] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 2 LSBs of R/Cr video data for 30-bit video modes. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. These signals are not used in 24-bit mode. O C1 VOUT[1]_R_CR[2] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. L6 VOUT[1]_R_CR[3] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. L4 VOUT[1]_R_CR[4] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. H2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[5] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. M11 VOUT[1]_R_CR[6] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. L12 VOUT[1]_R_CR[7] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. M10 106 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 3-56. Video Output 1 (Digital) Terminal Functions (continued) SIGNAL NAME [1] DESCRIPTION [2] TYPE [3] AAR BALL [4] VOUT[1]_R_CR[8] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. J2 VOUT[1]_R_CR[9] Video Output Data. These signals represent the 8 MSBs O of R/Cr video data. For RGB mode they are red data bits, for YUV444 mode they are Cr (Chroma) data bits, for Y/C mode and BT.656 modes they are unused. K2 VOUT[1]_VSYNC Video Output Vertical Sync output. This is the discrete O vertical synchronization output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. F5 Device Pins Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 107 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 4 Device Configurations 4.1 Control Module Registers 4.2 Boot Modes The state of the device after boot is determined by sampling the input states of the BTMODE[15:0] pins when device reset (POR or RESET) is de-asserted. The sampled values are latched into the CONTROL_STATUS register, which is part of the Control Module. The BTMODE[15:11] values determine the following system boot settings: • RSTOUT_WD_OUT Control • GPMC CS0 Default Data Bus Width, Wait Enable, and Address/Data Multiplexing For additional details on BTMODE[15:11] pin functions, see Table 3-13, Boot Configuration Terminal Functions. The BTMODE[4:0] values determine the boot mode order according to Table 4-1, Boot Mode Order. The 1st boot mode listed for each BTMODE[4:0] configuration is executed as the primary boot mode. If the primary boot mode fails, the 2nd, 3rd, and 4th boot modes are executed in that order until a successful boot is completed. The BTMODE[6:5] pins are RESERVED and should be pulled down as indicated in Table 3-13, Boot Configuration Terminal Functions. When the EMAC bootmode is selected (see Table 4-1), the sampled value from BTMODE[9:8] pins are used to determine the Ethernet PHY Mode selection (see Table 4-7) and the BTMODE[7] pin is used for RGMII Internal Delay selection (see Table 4-8). When the XIP (MUX0), XIP (MUX1), XIP w/ WAiT (MUX0) or XIP w/ WAiT (MUX1) bootmode is selected (see Table 4-1), the sampled value from BTMODE[10] pin is used to select between GPMC pin muxing options shown in Table 4-2, XIP (on GPMC) Boot Options [Muxed or Non-Muxed]. For more detailed information on booting the device, including which pins are used for each boot mode, see the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 108 Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 4-1. Boot Mode Order BTMODE[4:0] 1st 2nd 3rd 4th 00000 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 00001 UART XIP w/WAIT (MUX0) (1) (2) MMC SPI 00010 UART SPI NAND NANDI2C 00011 UART SPI XIP (MUX0) (1) (2) MMC SPI NAND NANDI2C RESERVED 00100 00101 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 00110 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 00111 EMAC (3) MMC SPI XIP (MUX1) (1) (2) 01000 PCIE_32 (4) RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01001 PCIE_64 (4) RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01010 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01011 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01100 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01101 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01110 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 01111 Fast XIP (MUX0) (1) UART EMAC (3) PCIE_64 (4) (3) 10000 (2) (3) (4) XIP (MUX1) (1) (2) UART EMAC 10001 XIP w/WAIT (MUX1) (1) (2) UART EMAC (3) MMC 10010 NAND NANDI2C SPI UART 10011 NAND NANDI2C MMC UART 10100 NAND NANDI2C SPI EMAC (3) 10101 NANDI2C MMC EMAC (3) UART 10110 SPI MMC UART EMAC (3) 10111 MMC SPI UART MMC EMAC (3) (4) RESERVED 11000 SPI MMC PCIE_32 11001 SPI MMC PCIE_64 (4) RESERVED MMC 11010 (1) EMAC (3) XIP (MUX0) (1) (2) UART SPI 11011 XIP w/WAIT (MUX0) (1) (2) UART SPI MMC 11100 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 11101 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 11110 RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED 11111 Fast XIP (MUX0) (1) EMAC (3) UART PCIE_32 (4) GPMC CS0 eXecute In Place (XIP) boot for NOR/OneNAND/ROM. MUX0/1 refers to the multiplexing option for the GPMC_A[12:0] pins. For more detailed information on booting the device, including which pins are used for each boot mode, see the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. When the XIP (MUX0), XIP (MUX1), XIP w/ WAiT (MUX0) or XIP w/ WAiT (MUX1) bootmode is selected, the sampled value from BTMODE[10] pin is used to select between GPMC pin configuration options shown in Table 4-2, XIP (on GPMC) Boot Options. When the EMAC bootmode is selected, the sampled value from BTMODE[9:8] pins are used to determine the Ethernet PHY Mode Selection (see Table 4-7). When the PCIe bootmode is selected (PCIE_32 or PCI_64), the sampled value from BTMODE[15:12] pins are used to determine the addressing options. For more detailed information on the PCIe addressing options, see the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 4.2.1 XIP (NOR) Boot Options Table 4-2 shows the XIP (NOR) boot mode GPMC pin configuration options (Option A: BTMODE[10] = 0 and Option B: BTMODE[10] = 1). For Option B, the pull state on select pins is reconfigured to IPD and remains IPD after boot until the user software reconfigures it. In Table 4-2, GPMC_A[1:12] are configured only for Non-Muxed NOR flash. In the case of Muxed NOR Flash, GPMC_D[15:0] act as both address and data lines so configuration of GPMC_A[1:12] in XIP_Mux0 mode and XIP_Mux1 mode doesn't apply for a Muxed NOR flash and those pins are not configured by Boot ROM. Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 109 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 4-2. XIP (on GPMC) Boot Options CONTROLLED I/O FUNCTION DURING XIP (NOR) BOOT SIGNAL NAME PIN NO. OTHER CONDITIONS BTMODE[10] = 0 [OPTION A] PIN FUNCTION GPMC_CS[0]/* GPMC_ADV_ALE/* AC9 AA10 BTMODE[14:13] = 01b or 10b (Mux) BTMODE[10] = 1 [OPTION B] PULL STATE PIN FUNCTION PULL STATE GPMC_CS[0] IPU GPMC_CS[0] IPU GPMC_ADV_ALE IPU GPMC_ADV_ALE IPU BTMODE[14:13] = 00b (Non-Mux) Default GPMC_OE_RE Y8 GPMC_OE_RE IPU GPMC_OE_RE IPU GPMC_BE[0]_CLE/GPMC_A[25]/* Y3 GPMC_BE[0]_CLE IPD Default IPD GPMC_BE[1]/GPMC_A[24]/* Y11 Default IPD Default IPD GPMC_WE Y5 GPMC_WE IPU GPMC_WE IPU GPMC_WAIT[0] IPU GPMC_WAIT[0] W8 GPMC_WAIT[0]/GPMC_A[26]/* GPMC_CLK/* GPMC_D[15:0]/* */GPMC_A[27]/GPMC_A[26]/GPMC_A[0]/* BTMODE[15] = 1b (WAIT Used/Enabled) BTMODE[15] = 0b (WAIT Not Used/Disabled) AB9 P2, R1, R2, R3, R4, R6, T8, T1, T2, T3, T5, W9, U2, W3, W4, W6 AK3 BTMODE[12] = 0b (8-bit Mode) IPU Default IPD (1) GPMC_CLK IPU Default IPU GPMC_D[15:0] Off GPMC_D[15:0] Off GPMC_A[0] IPD GPMC_A[0] IPD BTMODE[12] = 1b (16-bit Mode) Default */GPMC_A[1:12]/* AK4, AJ4, AL5, AK5, AJ6, AL6, AK6, AJ7, AK7, AE4, AK8, AJ8 XIP_MUX0 Mode GPMC_A[1:12] IPD GPMC_A[1:12] XIP_MUX1 Mode Default IPD Default IPD */GPMC_A[1:12]/* (M1) AD1, AC8, AC5, AC4, A2, B2, C1, C2, D5, H9, J10, B3 XIP_MUX0 Mode Default Default Default Default XIP_MUX1 Mode GPMC_A[1:12] Default GPMC_A[1:12] Default */GPMC_A[13:15]/* (M0) AH8, AG8, AF8 */GPMC_A[0]/* (M1) */GPMC_A[13]/* (M1) */GPMC_A[14]/* (M1) */GPMC_A[15]/* (M1) M8 BTMODE[12] = 0b (8-bit Mode) IPD Default IPD Default IPD Default IPU Default IPU Default IPU Default BTMODE[12] = 1b (16-bit Mode) L2 BTMODE[14:13] = 01b or 10b (Mux) L4 BTMODE[14:13] = 01b or 10b (Mux) IPU IPD (1) BTMODE[14:13] = 00b (Non-Mux) Default IPU Default IPU IPD (1) BTMODE[14:13] = 00b (Non-Mux) L6 Default IPD Default GPMC_A[16:19]/* M1, M2, M3, M5 Default IPD Default IPD GPMC_A[20] (M0) N9 Default IPU Default IPD (1) GPMC_A[21] (M0) N1 Default IPD Default IPD GPMC_A[22] (M0) N2 Default IPU Default IPD (1) GPMC_A[23] (M0) R8 Default IPD Default IPD (1) 110 IPD After initial power-up the internal pullup (IPU) will be at its default configuration of IPU. During the boot ROM execution, the pull state is reconfigured to IPD and it remains IPD after boot until the user software reconfigures it. Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 4-2. XIP (on GPMC) Boot Options (continued) CONTROLLED I/O FUNCTION DURING XIP (NOR) BOOT SIGNAL NAME PIN NO. OTHER CONDITIONS BTMODE[10] = 0 [OPTION A] PIN FUNCTION BTMODE[10] = 1 [OPTION B] PULL STATE PIN FUNCTION PULL STATE */GPMC_A[24]/GPMC_A[20]/* AE3 Default IPU Default IPD (1) */GPMC_A[25]/GPMC_A[21]/* AE2 Default IPU Default IPD (1) */GPMC_A[26]/GPMC_A[22]/* AE1 Default IPU Default IPD (1) */GPMC_A[27]/GPMC_A[23]/* AD2 Default IPU Default IPU GPMC_A[24] (M1) AC3 Default IPU Default IPU GPMC_A[25] (M1) AA12 Default IPU Default IPU Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 111 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 4.2.2 www.ti.com NAND Flash Boot Table 4-3 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the NAND Flash boot mode. NOTE: Table 4-3 lists the configuration of the GPMC_CLK pin (pin mux and pull state) in NAND bootmodes. The NAND flash memory is not XIP and requires shadowing before the code can be executed. Table 4-3. Pins Used in NAND FLASH Bootmode (1) 4.2.3 SIGNAL NAME PIN NO. TYPE GPMC_CS[0]/* AC9 O GPMC_ADV_ALE/* AA10 O GPMC_OE_RE Y8 O GPMC_BE[0]_CLE/GPMC_A[25]/* Y3 O GPMC_BE[1]/GPMC_A[24]/* Y11 O GPMC_WE Y5 O GPMC_WAIT[0]/GPMC_A[26]/* (1) W8 I GPMC_CLK/* AB9 I/O GPMC_D[15:0]/* P2, R1, R2, R3, R4, R6, T8, T1, T2, T3, T5, W9, U2, W3, W4, W6 I/O OTHER CONDITIONS BTMODE[12] = 0b (8-bit Mode) BTMODE[12] = 1b (16-bit Mode) BTMODE[14:13] = 00b (GPMC CS0 not muxed) BTMODE[15] = 0b (wait disabled) GPMC_CLK/* is not configured in BTMODE[10] = 1 [OPTION B] NAND I2C Boot (I2C EEPROM) Table 4-4 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the NAND I2C boot mode. Table 4-4. Pins Used in NAND I2C Bootmode SIGNAL NAME 4.2.4 PIN NO. TYPE I2C[0]_SCL T27 I/O I2C[0]_SDA T24 I/O MMC/SD Cards Boot Table 4-5 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the MMC/SD boot mode. Table 4-5. Pins Used in MMC/SD Bootmode SIGNAL NAME 112 PIN NO. TYPE SD1_CLK W30 I/O SD1_CMD/GP0[0] [MUX0] Y29 I/O SD1_DAT[0] W31 I/O SD1_DAT[1]_SDIRQ AA30 I/O SD_DAT[2]_SDRW U29 I/O SD1_DAT[3] Y27 I/O Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 4.2.5 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 SPI Boot Table 4-6 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the SPI boot mode. Table 4-6. Pins Used in SPI Bootmode SIGNAL NAME 4.2.6 PIN NO. TYPE SPI[0]_SCS[0] G29 I/O SPI[0]_D[0] (MISO) J28 I/O SPI[0]_D[1] (MOSI) J27 I/O SPI[0]_SCLK N24 I/O Ethernet PHY Mode Selection When the EMAC bootmode is selected, via the BTMODE[4:0] pins (see Table 4-1), Table 4-7 shows the sampled value of BTMODE[9:8] pins and the Ethernet PHY Mode selection. Table 4-9 shows the signal names (pin functions) and the associated pin numbers selected in each particular EMAC mode. Table 4-7. EMAC PHY Mode Selection BTMODE[9:8] ETHERNET PHY MODE SELECTION 00b MII/GMII 01b RMII 10b RGMII 11b RESERVED Table 4-8. RGMII Internal Delay Selection BTMODE[7] RGMII INTERNAL DELAY SELECTION 0b Internal Delay Enabled 1b Internal Delay Disabled Table 4-9. Pins Used in EMAC[0] MII/GMII, RGMII, and RMII Boot Modes PIN NO. AG1 SIGNAL NAMES MII/GMII TYPE DEFAULT RGMII TYPE DEFAULT RMII TYPE EMAC_RMREFCLK Output only AH1 EMAC[0]_MCOL I EMAC[0]_RGRXCTL I EMAC[0]_RMRXD[0] I AH2 EMAC[0]_MCRS I EMAC[0]_RGRXD[2] I EMAC[0]_RMRXD[1] I AL6 EMAC[0]_GMTCLK O DEFAULT AK1 EMAC[0]_MRCLK I EMAC[0]_RGTXC O EMAC[0]_RMCRSDV I AK2 EMAC[0]_MRXD[0] I EMAC[0]_RGTXD[0] O EMAC[0]_RMTXD[0] O AL2 EMAC[0]_MRXD[1] I EMAC[0]_RGRXD[0] I EMAC[0]_RMTXD[1] O I EMAC[0]_RMTXEN O DEFAULT AL3 EMAC[0]_MRXD[2] I EMAC[0]_RGRXD[1] AK3 EMAC[0]_MRXD[3] I DEFAULT AK4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[4] I EMAC[0]_RGRXD[3] I DEFAULT AJ4 EMAC[0]_MRXD[5] I EMAC[0]_RGTXD[3] O DEFAULT AL5 EMAC[0]_MRXD[6] I EMAC[0]_RGTXD[2] O DEFAULT DEFAULT Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 113 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 4-9. Pins Used in EMAC[0] MII/GMII, RGMII, and RMII Boot Modes (continued) SIGNAL NAMES PIN NO. 4.2.7 MII/GMII TYPE RGMII TYPE RMII AK5 EMAC[0]_MRXD[7] I EMAC[0]_RGTXD[1] O DEFAULT AJ6 EMAC[0]_MRXDV I DEFAULT AJ2 EMAC[0]_MRXER I EMAC[0]_RGTXCTL O EMAC[0]_RMRXER I DEFAULT TYPE DEFAULT AG4 EMAC[0]_MTCLK I EMAC[0]_RGRXC AK6 EMAC[0]_MTXD[0] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AJ7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[1] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AK7 EMAC[0]_MTXD[2] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AE4 EMAC[0]_MTXD[3] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AK8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[4] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AJ8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[5] O DEFAULT DEFAULT I AH8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[6] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AG8 EMAC[0]_MTXD[7] O DEFAULT DEFAULT AF8 EMAC[0]_MTXEN O DEFAULT DEFAULT AG2 MDCLK O MDCLK O MDCLK O AG3 MDIO I/O MDIO I/O MDIO I/O PCIe Bootmode (PCIE_32 and PCIE_64) Table 4-10 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the PCIe boot mode. Table 4-10. Pins Used in PCIe Bootmode (1) PIN NO. TYPE PCIE_TXP0 SIGNAL NAME L31 O PCIE_TXN0 K31 O PCIE_RXP0 K30 I PCIE_RXN0 J30 I SERDES_CLKP H30 I SERDES_CLKN H31 I (1) 4.2.8 PCIe bootmode is supported on all DM385 devices and also on DM388 devices with PCIe enabled. PCIe bootmode is not supported on DM388 devices with PCIe disabled. UART Bootmode Table 4-11 lists the device pins that are configured by the ROM for the UART boot mode. Table 4-11. Pins Used in UART Bootmode SIGNAL NAME 114 PIN NO. TYPE UART0_RXD J26 I UART0_TXD E28 O Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 4.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Pin Multiplexing Control Device level pin multiplexing is controlled on a pin-by-pin basis by the MUXMODE bits of the PINCNTL1 – PINCNTL270 registers in the Control Module. Pin multiplexing selects which one of several peripheral pin functions controls the pin's I/O buffer output data values. Table 4-12 shows the peripheral pin functions associated with each MUXMODE setting for all multiplexed pins. The default pin multiplexing control for almost every pin is to select MUXMODE = 0x0, in which case the pin's I/O buffer is 3-stated. In most cases, the input from each pin is routed to all of the peripherals that share the pin, regardless of the MUXMODE setting. However, in some cases a constant "0" or "1" value is routed to the associated peripheral when its peripheral function is not selected to control any output pin. For more details on the De-Selected Input State (DSIS), see the columns of each Terminal Functions table (Section 3.3, Terminal Functions). Some peripheral pin functions can be routed to more than one device pin. These types of peripheral pin functions are called Multimuxed and may have different Switching Characteristics and Timing Requirements for each device pin option. For more detailed information on the Pin Control 1 through Pin Control 270 (PINCNTLx) registers breakout, see Figure 4-1 and Table 4-12. Figure 4-1. PINCNTL1 – PINCNTL270 (PINCNTLx) Registers Breakout 31 24 23 20 RESERVED RESERVED R - 0000 0000 R - 0000 15 8 19 18 17 16 RSV RSV PLLTY PESE L PLLU DEN R/W 7 0 RESERVED MUXMODE[7:0] R - 0000 0000 R/W - 0000 0000 LEGEND: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read only; -n = value after reset Table 4-12. PINCNTL1 – PINCNTL270 (PINCNTLx) Registers Bit Descriptions Bit 31:20 Field Description RESERVED Reserved. Read only, writes have no effect. 19 RSV Reserved. This bit must always be written with the reset (default) value. 18 RSV Reserved. This field must always be written as "1". 17 PLLTYPSEL 16 PLLUDEN 0 = PU/PD enabled 1 = PU/PD disabled 15:8 RESERVED Reserved. Read only, writes have no effect. 7:0 MUXMODE[7:0] Pullup/Pulldown Type Selection bit 0 = Pulldown (PD) selected 1 = Pullup (PU) selected Pullup/Pulldown Enable bit Comments For PINCNTLx register reset value examples, see Table 4-13, PNICNTLx Register Reset Value Examples. For the full register reset values of all PINCNTLx registers. MUXMODE Selection bits These bits select the multiplexed mode pin function settings. Values other than those are illegal. Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 115 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 4-13. PINCNTLx Register Reset Value Examples HEX ADDRESS RANGE PINCNTLx REGISTER NAME Bits 31:24 Bits 23:20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 Bits 15:8 Bits 7:0 REGISTER RESET VALUE RESERVED RESERVED RESERVED RXACTIVE PLLTYPESEL PLLUDEN RESERVED MUXMODE[7:0] 0x4814 0800 PINCNTL1 00h 0h 0 1 1 0 00h 00h 0x0006 0000 0x4814 0804 PINCNTL2 00h 0h 1 1 1 0 00h 00h 0x000E 0000 0x4814 0808 PINCNTL3 00h 0h 1 1 1 0 00h 00h 0x000E 0000 0x4814 0C34 PINCNTL270 00h 0h 1 1 0 0 00h 00h 0x000C 0000 … 116 Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 4.4 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Handling Unused Pins When device signal pins are unused in the system, they can be left unconnected unless otherwise noted in the Terminal Functions tables (see Section 3.3). For unused input pins, the internal pull resistor should be enabled, or an external pull resistor should be used, to prevent floating inputs. All supply pins must always be connected to the correct voltage, even when their associated signal pins are unused. 4.5 4.5.1 DeBugging Considerations Pullup/Pulldown Resistors Proper board design should ensure that input pins to the device always be at a valid logic level and not floating. This may be achieved via pullup/pulldown resistors. The device features internal pullup (IPU) and internal pulldown (IPD) resistors on most pins to eliminate the need, unless otherwise noted, for external pullup/pulldown resistors. An external pullup/pulldown resistor needs to be used in the following situations: • Boot Configuration Pins: If the pin is both routed out and 3-stated (not driven), an external pullup/pulldown resistor is strongly recommended, even if the IPU/IPD matches the desired value/state. • Other Input Pins: If the IPU/IPD does not match the desired value/state, use an external pullup/pulldown resistor to pull the signal to the opposite rail. For the boot configuration pins (listed in Section 3.3, Boot Configuration Terminal Functions), if they are both routed out and 3-stated (not driven), it is strongly recommended that an external pullup/pulldown resistor be implemented. Although, internal pullup/pulldown resistors exist on these pins and they may match the desired configuration value, providing external connectivity can help ensure that valid logic levels are latched on these device boot configuration pins. In addition, applying external pullup/pulldown resistors on the boot and configuration pins adds convenience to the user in debugging and flexibility in switching operating modes. Tips for choosing an external pullup/pulldown resistor: • Consider the total amount of current that may pass through the pullup or pulldown resistor. Make sure to include the leakage currents of all the devices connected to the net, as well as any internal pullup or pulldown resistors. • Decide a target value for the net. For a pulldown resistor, this should be below the lowest VIL level of all inputs connected to the net. For a pullup resistor, this should be above the highest VIH level of all inputs on the net. A reasonable choice would be to target the VOL or VOH levels for the logic family of the limiting device; which, by definition, have margin to the VIL and VIH levels. • Select a pullup/pulldown resistor with the largest possible value; but, which can still ensure that the net will reach the target pulled value when maximum current from all devices on the net is flowing through the resistor. The current to be considered includes leakage current plus, any other internal and external pullup/pulldown resistors on the net. • For bidirectional nets, there is an additional consideration which sets a lower limit on the resistance value of the external resistor. Verify that the resistance is small enough that the weakest output buffer can drive the net to the opposite logic level (including margin). • Remember to include tolerances when selecting the resistor value. • For pullup resistors, also remember to include tolerances on the DVDD rail. For most systems, a 1-kΩ resistor can be used to oppose the IPU/IPD while meeting the above criteria. Users should confirm this resistor value is correct for their specific application. For most systems, a 20-kΩ resistor can be used to compliment the IPU/IPD on the boot and configuration pins while meeting the above criteria. Users should confirm this resistor value is correct for their specific application. Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 117 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com For most systems, a 20-kΩ resistor can also be used as an external PU/PD on the pins that have IPUs/IPDs disabled and require an external PU/PD resistor while still meeting the above criteria. Users should confirm this resistor value is correct for their specific application. For more detailed information on input current (II), and the low-/high-level input voltages (VIL and VIH) for the device, see Section 6.4, Electrical Characteristics Over Recommended Ranges of Supply Voltage and Operating Temperature. For the internal pullup/pulldown resistors for all device pins, see the peripheral/system-specific terminal functions table. 118 Device Configurations Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 5 System Interconnect The device’s various processors, subsystems, and peripherals are interconnected through a switch fabric architecture. The switch fabric is composed of an L3 and L4 interconnect, a switched central resource (SCR), and multiple bridges (for an overview, see Figure 5-1). Not all Initiators in the switch fabric are connected to all Target peripherals. The supported initiator and target connections are designated by a "X" in Table 5-1, Target/Initiator Connectivity. EDMATC RD 0/1 EDMATC WR 0/1 ARM Cortex A8 64b 128b L3F Initiators L3F Initiators L3F Initiators L3F Initiators EDMATC RD 2/3 EDMATC WR 2/3 HDVICP2 HDVPSS (2 I/F) ISS PCIe MEDIACTL EMAC SW FD DAP JTAG USB2.0 (2 I/F) 128b 1 I/F 8 I/F 64b 128b 4 I/F 2 I/F 32b 3 I/F L3F/L3Mid Interconnect 200 MHz (Note 1) 2 I/F 128b DMM 1 I/F 128b 3 I/F 128b 64b 3 I/F L3S Interconnect 100 MHz (Note 1) 10 I/F 32b L3F Targets L3F Targets L3F Targets HDVICP2 SL2 PCIe MEDIACTL OCMC SRAM ISS MMCSD 2 HDVICP 2 CFG EDMATC 0/1/2/3 EDMACC DEBUGSS DDR 32b 2 I/F 32b L4F Interconnect 200MHz (Note 1) 1 I/F 32b 5 I/F 32b L3S Targets MCASP 0/1 Data GPMC HDMI USB 2 I/F 32b L4S Interconnect 100MHz (Note1) 42 I/F 32b L4F Targets L4S Targets EMAC SW UART 0/1/2 I2C 0/1/2/3 DMTimer 1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8 SPI 0/1/2/3 GPIO 0/1/2/3 McASP 0/1 CFG MMCSD 0/1 ELM RTC WDT 0/1 Mailbox Spinlock HDVPSS HDMIPHY PLLSS Control Module PRCM SmartReflex 0/1 OCPWP SYNCTIMER32K Note 1: The frequencies specified are for 100% OPP. Figure 5-1. System Interconnect System Interconnect Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 119 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 5-1. L3 Master/Slave Connectivity Imaging SS X USB2.0 CFG L4 HS Periph Port 0 X OCMC RAM HDMI 1.3 Tx Audio X EDMA TPCC McASP 0/1 X EDMA TPTC0 - 3 CFG PCIe Gen2 Slave X L3 Registers GPMC X L4 Std Periph Port 1 Media Controller X L4 Std Periph Port 0 HDVICP2 Hst X L4 HS Periph Port 1 HDVICP2 SL2 ARM M1 (128-bit) EDMA DMM ELLA EDMA DMM Tiler/Lisa1 SLAVES EDMA DMM Tiler/Lisa0 MASTERS SD2 X X X X X X X X ARM M2 (64-bit) X HDVICP2 VDMA X HDVPSS Mstr0 X HDVPSS Mstr1 X X X X X X X X EMAC SW X X USB2.0 DMA X X USB2.0 Queue Mgr X X PCIe Gen2 X X X Media Controller X X X DeBug Access Port (DAP) X X X EDMA TPTC0 RD X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X EDMA TPTC0 WR X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X EDMA TPTC1 RD X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X EDMA TPTC1 WR X EDMA TPTC2 RD X EDMA TPTC2 WR X X X X X X X X EDMA TPTC3 RD X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X X EDMA TPTC3 WR X ISS X 120 X System Interconnect Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 The L4 interconnect is a non-blocking peripheral interconnect that provides low-latency access to a large number of low-bandwidth, physically-dispersed target cores. The L4 can handle incoming traffic from up to four initiators and can distribute those communication requests to and collect related responses from up to 63 targets. The device provides two interfaces with L3 interconnect for high-speed and standard peripherals. Table 5-2. L4 Peripheral Connectivity (1) MASTERS L4 PERIPHERALS ARM Cortex-A8 M2 (64-bit) EDMA TPTC0 EDMA TPTC1 EDMA TPTC2 EDMA TPTC3 PCIe Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 I2C0 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 I2C1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 I2C2 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 I2C3 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SPI0 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SPI1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SPI2 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SPI3 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 UART0 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 UART1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 UART2 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer2 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer3 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer4 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer5 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer6 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer7 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Timer8 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 GPIO0 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 GPIO1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 MMC/SD0/SDIO Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 MMC/SD1/SDIO Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 MMC/SD2/SDIO Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 WDT0 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 RTC Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SmartReflex0 Port0 SmartReflex1 Port0 Mailbox Port0 Spinlock Port0 HDVPSS Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 PLLSS Port0 Port1 Control/Top Regs (Control Module) Port0 Port1 PRCM Port0 Port1 ELM Port0 Port1 L4 Fast Peripherals Port 0/1 EMAC SW L4 Slow Peripherals Port 0/1 (1) X, Port0, Port1 = Connection exists. System Interconnect Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 121 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 5-2. L4 Peripheral Connectivity(1) (continued) MASTERS L4 PERIPHERALS ARM Cortex-A8 M2 (64-bit) EDMA TPTC0 EDMA TPTC1 EDMA TPTC2 EDMA TPTC3 PCIe HDMIPHY Port0 Port1 OCPWP Port0 Port0 McASP0 CFG Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 McASP1 CFG Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 SYNCTIMER32K Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 Port0 Port1 122 System Interconnect Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 6 Device Operating Conditions 6.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Supply voltage ranges (Steady State): (1) (2) Core (CVDD, CVDD_ARM, CVDD_HDVICP) -0.3 V to 1.5 V HD-DAC Digital Logic, 1.1V (VDDA_HDDAC_1P1) -0.5 V to 1.5 V I/O, 1.8 V (DVDD_DDR[0], VDDA_1P8, VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8, VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8, VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8, VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8, VDDA_L3L4PLL_1P8, VDDA_PCIE_1P8, VDDA_HDMI_1P8, VDDA_USB0_1P8, VDDA_USB1_1P8, VDDA_VDAC_1P8, VDDA_CSI2_1P8, VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8, VDDA_HDDAC_1P8, VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8, VDDS_OSC0_1P8, VDDS_OSC1_1P8 -0.3 V to 2.1 V I/O 3.3 V (DVDD, DVDD_GPMC, DVDD_RGMII, DVDD_SD, DVDD_C) -0.3 V to 4.0 V DDR Reference Voltage (VREFSSTL_DDR[0]) -0.3 V to DVDD_DDR[0] + 0.3 V V I/O, 1.35-V pins (Transient Overshoot/Undershoot) 30% of DVDD_DDR[0] for up to 30% of the signal period V I/O, 1.5-V pins (Steady State) -0.3 V to DVDD_DDR[0] + 0.3 V V I/O, 1.5-V pins (Transient Overshoot/Undershoot) 30% of DVDD_DDR[0] for up to 30% of the signal period V I/O, 1.8-V pins (Steady State) -0.3 V to DVDD + 0.3 V -0.3 V to DVDD_x + 0.3 V Input and Output voltage ranges: V I/O, 1.8-V pins (Transient Overshoot/Undershoot) V I/O, 3.3-V pins (Steady State) Commercial Temperature (default) Extended temperature Latch-up Performance (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (6) 25% of DVDDx for up to 30% of the signal period 0°C to 95°C -40°C to 95°C Storage temperature range, Tstg: Component-Level Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Stress Voltage (3) 25% of DVDDx for up to 30% of the signal period -0.3 V to DVDD + 0.3 V -0.3 V to DVDD_x + 0.3 V V I/O, 3.3-V pins (Transient Overshoot/Undershoot) Operating junction temperature range, TJ: -0.3 V to 1.1 V V I/O, 1.35-V pins (Steady State) -55°C to 150°C ESD-HBM (Human Body Model) (4) ESD-CDM (Charged-Device Model) ±1000 V (5) ±250 V Class II (105ºC) 50 mA Stresses beyond those listed under "absolute maximum ratings" may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those indicated under "recommended operating conditions" is not implied. Exposure to absolute-maximum-rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. All voltage values are with respect to their associated VSS or VSSA_x. Electrostatic discharge (ESD) to measure device sensitivity or immunity to damage caused by electrostatic discharges into the device. Level listed is the passing level per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001. JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500 V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process, and manufacturing with less than 500 V HBM is possible if necessary precautions are taken. Pins listed as 1000 V may actually have higher performance. Level listed is the passing level per EIA-JEDEC JESD22-C101E. JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250 V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process, and manufacturing with less than 250 V CDM is possible if necessary precautions are taken. Pins listed as 250 V may actually have higher performance. Based on JEDEC JESD78D [IC Latch-Up Test]. Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 123 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 6.2 www.ti.com Recommended Operating Conditions PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX 1.28 1.35 1.42 1.28 1.35 1.42 120% OPP 1.14 1.20 1.26 100% OPP (1) 1.05 1.10 1.16 OPP_Nitro 1.28 1.35 1.42 1.28 1.35 1.42 120% OPP 1.14 1.20 1.26 100% OPP (1) 1.05 1.10 1.16 OPP_Nitro 1.28 1.35 1.42 1.28 1.35 1.42 120% OPP 1.14 1.20 1.26 100% OPP (1) 1.05 1.10 1.16 DVDD Supply voltage, I/O, standard pins (2) 3.3 V 3.14 3.3 3.47 1.8 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 DVDD_GPMC Supply voltage, I/O, GPMC pin group 3.3 V 3.14 3.3 3.47 1.8 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 DVDD_RGMII Supply voltage, I/O, RGMII pin group 3.3 V 3.14 3.3 3.47 1.8 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 DVDD_SD Supply voltage, I/O, SD pin group 3.3 V 3.14 3.3 3.47 1.8 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 Supply voltage, I/O, C pin group 3.3 V 3.14 3.3 3.47 1.8 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 DDR2 1.71 1.8 1.89 DDR3 1.43 1.5 1.58 DDR3L 1.28 1.35 1.42 3.14 3.3 3.47 V 1.71 1.8 1.89 V 1.05 1.1 1.15 V OPP_Nitro Supply voltage, Core (Scalable) DVFS only, No AVS CVDD CVDD_ARM Supply voltage, Core ARM (Scalable) Supply voltage, Core, HDVICP2 CVDD_HDVICP (Scalable) DVDD_C Supply voltage, I/O, DDR[0] DVDD_DDR[0] OPP_Turbo OPP_Turbo OPP_Turbo VDDA_USB_3P Supply voltage, I/O, Analog, USB 3.3 V 3 VDDA_1P8 VDDA_x_1P8 VDDS_x_1P8 VDDA_HDDAC _1P1 VREFSSTL_DDR[0] USBx_VBUSIN (3) 124 Supply voltage, I/O, Analog, HD-DAC 1.1 V Supply Ground (VSS, VSSA_HDMI, VSSA_USB, VSSA_VDAC, VSSA_DEVOSC (3), VSSA_AUXOSC (3)) VSS (1) (2) Supply Voltage, I/O, Analog, (VDDA_1P8, VDDA_ARMPLL_1P8, VDDA_VIDPLL_1P8, VDDA_AUDIOPLL_1P8, VDDA_DDRPLL_1P8, VDDA_L3L4PLL_1P8, VDDA_PCIE_1P8, VDDA_HDMI_1P8, VDDA_USB0_1P8, VDDA_USB1_1P8, VDDA_VDAC_1P8, VDDA_CSI2_1P8, VDDA_HDDACREF_1P8, VDDA_HDDAC_1P8, VDDA_HDVICPPLL_1P8, VDDS_OSC0_1P8, VDDS_OSC1_1P8) Note: HDMI, USB0/1, and VDAC relative to their respective VSSA. IO Reference Voltage, (VREFSSTL_DDR[0]) 0 UNIT V V V V V V V V V V 0.49 * DVDD_DDR[0] 0.50 * DVDD_DDR[0] 0.51 * DVDD_DDR[0] V 4.75 5 5.25 V USBx VBUS Comparator Input OPP100 is currently supported only on DM388 commercial temperature devices. LVCMOS pins are all I/O pins powered by DVDD, DVDD_GPMC, DVDD_RGMII, DVDD_SD, DVDD_C supplies except for I2C[0] and I2C[1] pins. When using the internal Oscillators, the oscillator grounds (VSSA_DEVOSC, VSSA_AUXOSC) must be kept separate from other grounds and connected directly to the crystal load capacitor ground. Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Recommended Operating Conditions (continued) PARAMETER MIN High-level input voltage, LVCMOS (JTAG[TCK] pins), 3.3 V (2) High-level input voltage, JTAG[TCK], 3.3 V 2.15 V High-level input voltage, JTAG[TCK], 1.8 V 1.45 V 0.7DVDD V 0.65DVDDx V High-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR2 mode VREFSSTL_DDR[x] + 0.125 V High-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3 mode VREFSSTL_DDR[x] + 0.1 V High-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3L mode VREFSSTL_DDR[x] + 0.09 V High-level input voltage, LVCMOS (2), 1.8 V Low-level input voltage, JTAG[TCK] Low-level input voltage, I2C (I2C[0] and I2C[1]) Low-level input voltage, LVCMOS (2) V 0.3DVDDx V 0.35DVDDx V V Low-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3 mode VREFSSTL_DDR[x] - 0.1 V Low-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3L mode VREFSSTL_DDR[x] - 0.09 V Low-level output current IOL 6 mA I/O buffers -6 mA DDR[0] buffer @ 50-Ω impedance setting -8 mA 6 mA I/O buffers 6 mA DDR[0] buffer @ 50-Ω impedance setting 8 mA VID Differential input voltage (SERDES_CLKN/P), [AC coupled] tt Transition time, 10% - 90%, All inputs (unless otherwise specified in the Electrical Data/Timing sections of each peripheral) TJ Operating junction temperature range (5) (5) V VREFSSTL_DDR[x] - 0.125 High-level output current , 1.8 V 0.8 0.45 Low-level input voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR2 mode IOH (4) UNIT V Low-level input voltage, LVCMOS (2), 3.3 V VIL MAX 2 High-level input voltage, I2C (I2C[0] and I2C[1]) VIH NOM 0.250 2.0 V 0.25P or 10 (4) ns Commercial Temperature (default) 0 95 °C Extended temperature -40 95 °C Whichever is smaller. P = the period of the applied signal. Maintaining transition times as fast as possible is recommended to improve noise immunity on input signals. For more detailed information on estimating junction temps within systems, see the IC Package Thermal Metrics Application Report (Literature Number: SPRA953). Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 125 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Reliability Data (1) 6.3 The information in this table is provided solely for convenience and does not extend or modify the warranty provided under TI's standard terms and conditions for TI semiconductor products. CVDD (2) CVDD_ARM (2) CVDD_HDVICP (2) Commercial Junction Temp. (TJ) Lifetime (POH) (3) Nitro 1.35 V ± 5% 1.35 V ± 5% 1.35 V ± 5% 95ºC 55K Turbo 1.35 V ± 5% 1.35 V ± 5% 1.35 V ± 5% 95ºC 59K OPP120 1.20 V ± 5% 1.20 V ± 5% 1.20 V ± 5% 95ºC 100K OPP100 (4) 1.10 V ± 5% 1.10 V ± 5% 1.10 V ± 5% 95ºC 100K Operating Condition (1) (2) (3) (4) 126 Logic functions and parameter values are not ensured out of the range specified in the recommended operating conditions. The above notations cannot be deemed a warranty or deemed to extend or modify the warranty under TI's standard terms and conditions for TI semiconductor products. Voltage specification at the device package pin. Power-on-hours (POH) represent device operation under the specified nominal conditions continuously for the duration of the calculated lifetime. If actual application results in a system that operates at conditions less than the limits, the resulting POH may increase. OPP100 is currently supported only on DM388 commercial temperature devices. Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 6.4 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Electrical Characteristics Over Recommended Ranges of Supply Voltage and Operating Temperature (Unless Otherwise Noted) PARAMETER VOH VOL TEST CONDITIONS (1) MIN MAX 2.8 VDDA_USB_3P 3 High speed: USBx_DM and USBx_DP 360 440 UNIT V mV High-level output voltage, LVCMOS (2) (3.3-V I/O) 3.3 V, DVDDx = MIN, IOH = MAX 2.4 V High-level output voltage, LVCMOS (2) (1.8-V I/O) 1.8 V, DVDDx = MIN, IOH = MAX 1.26 V High-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR2 mode 1.8 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load DVDD_DDR[0] 0.4 V HIgh-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3 mode 1.5 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load DVDD_DDR[0] 0.4 V HIgh-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3L mode 1.35 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load DVDD_DDR[0] 0.4 V Low/Full speed: USBx_DM and USBx_DP 0.0 0.3 V High speed: USBx_DM and USBx_DP -10 10 mV Low-level output voltage, LVCMOS (2) (3.3-V I/O) 3.3 V, DVDDx = MAX, IOL = MAX 0.4 V Low-level output voltage, LVCMOS (2) (1.8-V I/O) 1.8 V, DVDDx = MAX, IOL = MAX 0.4 V Low-level output voltage, I2C 1.8/3.3 V, IOL = 4mA (I2C[0], I2C[1]) 0.4 V Low-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR2 mode 1.8 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load 0.4 V Low-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3 mode 1.5 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load 0.4 V Low-level output voltage, DDR[0] signals in DDR3L mode 1.35 V, IOL = 6mA, 50 ohm load 0.4 V 1.5 V LDOs (applies to all LDOCAP_x pins) (1) (2) TYP Low/Full speed: USBx_DM and USBx_DP For test conditions shown as MIN, MAX, or TYP, use the appropriate value specified in the recommended operating conditions table. LVCMOS pins are all I/O pins powered by DVDD, DVDD_GPMC, DVDD_RGMII, DVDD_SD, DVDD_C supplies except for I2C[0] and I2C[1] pins. Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 127 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Electrical Characteristics Over Recommended Ranges of Supply Voltage and Operating Temperature (Unless Otherwise Noted) (continued) PARAMETER (2) Input current, LVCMOS , 3.3 V mode Input current, LVCMOS (2), 1.8 V mode II (3) Input current, I2C (I2C[0], I2C[1]) IOZ (5) I/O Off-state output current TEST CONDITIONS (1) MIN 0 < VI < DVDDx, 3.3 V pull disabled -20 0 < VI < DVDDx, 3.3 V pulldown enabled (4) 20 0 < VI < DVDDx, 3.3 V pullup enabled (4) -20 0 < VI < DVDDx, 1.8 V pull disabled -5 0 < VI < DVDDx, 1.8 V pulldown enabled (4) 50 0 < VI < DVDDx, 1.8 V pullup enabled (4) -50 3.3 V mode 1.8 V mode TYP MAX UNIT 20 µA 100 300 µA -100 -300 µA 5 µA 100 200 µA -100 -200 µA -20 20 µA -5 5 µA 3.3 V mode, pull enabled -300 300 µA 3.3 V mode, pull disabled -20 20 µA 1.8 V mode, pull enabled -200 200 µA 1.8 V mode, pull disabled -5 5 µA CI Input capacitance LVCMOS (2) 12 pF Co Output capacitance LVCMOS (2) 12 pF (3) (4) (5) 128 II applies to input-only pins and bi-directional pins. For input-only pins, II indicates the input leakage current. For bi-directional pins, II indicates the input leakage current and off-state (Hi-Z) output leakage current. Applies only to pins with an internal pullup (IPU) or pulldown (IPD) resistor. IOZ applies to output-only pins, indicating off-state (Hi-Z) output leakage current. Device Operating Conditions Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 7 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts 7.1 Power, Reset and Clock Management (PRCM) Module The PRCM module is the centralized management module for the power, reset, and clock control signals of the device. It interfaces with all the components on the device for power, clock, and reset management through power-control signals. It integrates enhanced features to allow the device to adapt energy consumption dynamically, according to changing application and performance requirements. The innovative hardware architecture allows a substantial reduction in leakage current. The PRCM module is composed of two main entities: • Power reset manager (PRM): Handles the power, reset, wake-up management, and system clock source control (oscillator) • Clock manager (CM): Handles the clock generation, distribution, and management. For more details on the PRCM, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.2 Power 7.2.1 Voltage and Power Domains Every Module within the device belongs to a Core Logic Voltage Domain, Memory Voltage Domain, and a Power Domain (see Table 7-1). Table 7-1. Voltage and Power Domains CORE LOGIC VOLTAGE DOMAIN MEMORY VOLTAGE DOMAIN ARM_L ARM_M CORE_L CORE_M POWER DOMAIN ARM Cortex-A8 Subsystem, SmartReflex Sensor 0 ALWAYS ON ISP HDVICP_L 7.2.1.1 HDVICP_M MODULE(S) ATL, HDMI, DMM, EDMA, ELM, DDR, EMAC Switch, GPIO Banks 0/1/2/3, GPMC, I2C0/1/2/3, IPC, MCASP0/1, OCMC SRAM, PCIE, PRCM, RTC, SD/MMC0/1/2, SPI01/2/3, Timer1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8, UART0/1/2, USB0/1, WDT0, System Interconnect, JTAG, Media Controller, ISS, SmartReflex Control Module 0/1, SmartReflex Sensor 1 ISP, CSI2 PHY LOGIC HDVPSS HDVPSS, SD-DAC, HD-DAC HDVICP HDVICP2, SmartReflex Sensor 2 Core Logic Voltage Domains The device contains three Core Logic Voltage Domains. These domains define groups of Modules that share the same supply voltage for their core logic. Each Core Logic Voltage Domain is powered by a dedicated supply voltage rail that can be independently scaled using SmartReflex technology to trade off power versus performance. Table 7-2 shows the mapping between the Core Logic Voltage Domains and their associated supply pins. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 129 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 7-2. Core Logic Voltage Domains and Supply Pin Associations CORE LOGIC VOLTAGE DOMAIN SUPPLY PIN NAME ARM_L CVDD_ARM CORE_L CVDD HDVICP_L CVDD_HDVICP Note: A regulated supply voltage must be supplied to each Core Logic Voltage Domain at all times, regardless of the Core Logic Power Domain states. 7.2.1.2 Power Domains The device contains four Power Domains which supply power to both the Core Logic and SRAM within their associated modules. Each Power Domain, except for the ALWAYS ON domain, has an internal power switch that can completely remove power from that domain. All power switches are turned "OFF" by default after reset, and software can individually turn them "ON/OFF" via Control Module registers. Note: All Modules within a Power Domain are unavailable when the domain is powered "OFF". For instructions on powering "ON/OFF" the Power domains, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter of the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.2.2 SmartReflex™ [Currently Not Supported] The device contains SmartReflex modules that help to minimize power consumption on the Core Logic Voltage Domains by using external variable-voltage power supplies. Based on the device process, temperature, and desired performance, the SmartReflex modules advise the host processor to raise or lower the supply voltage to each domain for minimal power consumption. The communication link between the host processor and the external regulators is a system-level decision and can be accomplished using GPIOs, I2C, SPI, or other methods. The following sections briefly describe the two major techniques employed by SmartReflex: Dynamic Voltage Frequency Scaling (DVFS) and Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS). 7.2.2.1 Dynamic Voltage Frequency Scaling (DVFS) [Currently Supports Only Discrete OPPs] Each device Core Logic Voltage Domain can be run independently at one of several Operating Performance Points (OPPs). An OPP for a specific Core Logic Voltage Domain is defined by: (1) maximum frequencies of operation for Modules within the Domain and (2) an associated supply voltage range. Trading off power versus performance, OPPs with lower maximum frequencies also have lower voltage ranges for power savings. The OPP for a domain can be changed in real-time without requiring a reset. This feature is called Dynamic Voltage Frequency Scaling (DVFS) Table 7-3 contains a list of voltage ranges and maximum module frequencies for the OPPs of each Core Logic Voltage Domain. NOTE Not all devices support all OPP frequencies. OPP100 is currently supported only on DM388 commercial temperature devices. 130 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 7-3. Device Operating Points (OPPs) CORE LOGIC VOLTAGE DOMAINS (1) (2) ARM HDVICP2 CORE OPP Cortex A8 (MHz) HDVICP2 HDVPSS (MHz) ISS (MHz) Media Ctlr. (MHz) L3/L4, Core (MHz) DDR (MHz) (1) 100%(1.1 V) (AAR0x) (2) 600 220 200 400 200 200 400 120% (1.2 V) (AAR0x) 720 290 200 400 200 200 400 Turbo (1.35 V) (AAR1x) 970 410 240 480 240 240 533 Nitro (1.35 V) (AAR2x) 1000 450 260 560 280 240 533 All DDR access must be suspended prior to changing the DDR frequency of operation. OPP100 is currently supported only on DM388 commercial temperature devices. Although the OPP for each Core Logic Voltage Domain is independently selectable, not all combinations of OPPs are supported. Table 7-4 marks the supported ARM OPPs for a given CORE OPP. Table 7-4. Supported OPP Combinations (1) ARM CORE Nitro Nitro X Turbo Turbo HDVICP2 OPP120 Nitro Turbo OPP120 OPP100 (2) X X X X X OPP120 X OPP100 (2) (1) (2) OPP100 (2) X X X "X" denotes supported combinations. OPP100 is currently only supported on DM388 commercial temperature devices. 7.2.2.2 Adaptive Voltage Scaling [Currently Not Supported] As mentioned in Section 7.2.2.1, Dynamic Voltage Frequency Scaling (DVFS) above, every OPP has an associated voltage range. Based on the silicon process, temperature, and chosen OPP, the SmartReflex modules guide software in adjusting the Core Logic Voltage Domain supply voltage (CVDD) within these ranges. This technique is called Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS). AVS occurs continuously and in realtime, helping to minimize power consumption in response to changing operating conditions. 7.2.3 Memory Power Management In order to reduce SRAM leakage, many SRAM blocks can be switched from ACTIVE mode to SHUTDOWN mode. When SRAM is put in SHUTDOWN mode, the voltage supplied to it is automatically removed and all data in that SRAM is lost. All SRAM located in a switchable power domain (all domains except ALWAYS_ON) automatically enters SHUTDOWN mode whenever its associated power domain goes into the "OFF" state. The SRAM returns to the ACTIVE state when the corresponding Power Domain returns to the "ON" state. In addition, the following SRAM within the ALWAYS_ON Power Domain can also be independently put into SHUTDOWN by programming the x_MEM_PWRDN registers in the Control Module: • Media Controller SRAM • OCMC SRAM 7.2.4 SERDES_CLKP/N LDO The SERDES_CLKP/N input buffers are powered by an internal LDO which is programmed through the REFCLK_LJCBLDO_CTRL register in the Control Module. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 131 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 7.2.5 www.ti.com Dual Voltage I/Os The device supports dual voltages on some of its I/Os. These I/Os are partitioned into the following groups, and each group has its own dedicated supply pins: DVDD, DVDD_GPMC, DVDD_C, and DVDD_SD. The supply voltage for each group can be independently powered with either 1.8 V or 3.3 V. For the mapping between pins and power groups, see Section 3.3, Terminal Functions of the datasheet. In addition, the I/O voltage on the DDR interface is independently selectable between 1.35 V, 1.5 V or 1.8 V to support various DDR device types. 7.2.6 I/O Power-Down Modes On the device, there are power-down modes available for the following PHYs: • Video DACs • DDR • USB • HDMI • CSI2 • PCIE When a PHY controller is in a power domain that is to be turned "OFF", software must configure the corresponding PHY into power-down mode, prior to putting the power domain in the "OFF" state. 132 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 7.2.7 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Standby and Deep Sleep Modes The device supports Low-Power Standby and Deep-Sleep Modes as described below. Standby Mode is defined as a state in which: • All switchable power domains are in "OFF" state • The ARM Cortex-A8 is executing an IDLE loop at its lowest frequency of operation • All functional blocks not needed for a given application are clock gated Deep Sleep Mode is defined to be the same as Standby Mode, with the addition of gating the crystal oscillator to further eliminate all active power. The device core voltages can be reduced for optimal power savings. For detailed instructions on entering and exiting from Standby and Deep Sleep Modes, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.2.8 Supply Sequencing The device power supplies are organized into five Supply Sequencing Groups: 1. CVDD Core Logic supply (CVDD) 2. All CVDD_x supplies (CVDD_ARM and CVDD_HDVICP) 3. All 1.35-/1.5-/1.8-V DVDD_DDR[0] Supplies (1.35 V for DDR3L, 1.5 V for DDR3, 1.8 V for DDR2) 4. All 1.8-V Supplies (DVDD_x, VDDA_x_1P8, VDDA_1P8) 5. All 3.3-V Supplies (DVDD, DVDD_x, DVDD_C, VDDA_x_3P3) To ensure proper device operation, a specific power-up and power-down sequence must be followed. Some TI power-supply devices include features that facilitate these power sequencing requirements — for example, TI’s TPS659113 integrated PMIC. For more information on TI power supplies and their features, visit www.ti.com/processorpower. 7.2.8.1 Power-Up Sequence For proper device operation, the following power-up sequence in Table 7-5 and Figure 7-1 must be followed. Table 7-5. Power-Up Sequence Ramping Values NO. 1 (1) (2) DESCRIPTION 1.8 V supplies to 1.35-/1.5-/1.8-V DVDD_DDR[x] supplies 2 DVDD_DDR supplies stable to 3.3 V supplies ramp start 3 1.8 V supplies stable to CVDD, CVDD_x variable supplies ramp start 4 All supplies valid to power-on-reset (POR high) MIN MAX UNIT 0 (1) ms 0 (2) ms 0 (1) ms 4 096 Master Clocks The 1.8 V supplies must be ≥ 1.35-/1.5-/1.8-V DVDD_DDR[x] and CVDD, CVDD_x variable supplies. Both 1.8 V and DVDD_DDR[x] supplies must be powered up and stable prior to starting the ramp of the 3.3 V supplies. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 133 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com POR 1.8 V Supplies (DVDD, DVDD_x, VDDA_x_1P8, VDDA_1P8) 1.35 V/1.5 V/1.8 V DVDD_DDR[0] 3.3 V Supplies (DVDD, DVDD_x, VDDA_x_3P3) CVDD CVDD_x 2 1 3 4 Both 1.8 V and DVDD_DDR[x] supplies must be powered up and stable prior to starting the ramp of the 3.3 V supplies. CVDD powered-up coincidently or prior to CVDD_ARM and CVDD_HDVICP supplies. Figure 7-1. Power-Up Sequence 7.2.8.2 Power-Down Sequence For proper device operation, the following power-down sequence in Table 7-6, Figure 7-2, Figure 7-3, and Figure 7-4 must be followed. Table 7-6. Power-Down Sequence Ramping Values NO. 134 MIN MAX UNIT 5 CVDD, CVDD_x variable supplies to 1.8 V supplies 0 6 1.35-/1.5-/1.8-V DVDD_DDR[x] supplies to 1.8 V supplies 0 7 3.3 V supplies to 1.8 V supplies (1) (1) ms CVDD_x supplies to CVDD supply (2) (2) ms 8 (1) (2) DESCRIPTION ms ms The 3.3 V supplies must never be more than 2 V above the 1.8 V supplies (see Figure 7-3). The CVDD supply must be powered down coincidentally or after CVDD_ARM and CVDD_HDVICP supplies (see Figure 7-4). Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 1.8 V Supplies (DVDD, DVDD_x, VDDA_x_1P8, VDDA_1P8) 3.3 V Supplies (DVDD, DVDD_x, DVDD_C, VDDA_x_3P3) 1.35 V/1.5 V/1.8 V DVDD_DDR[0] CVDD, CVDD_x 7 6 5 Figure 7-2. Power-Down Sequence 3.3 V Supplies V Delta (A) 1.8 V Supplies (Excluding DVDD_DDR[x]) A. V Delta Max = 2 V. Figure 7-3. 3.3 V Supplies Falling After 1.8 V Supplies Delta CVDD_x CVDD 8 Figure 7-4. CVDD and CVDD_x Power-Down Sequence 7.2.9 Power-Supply Decoupling 7.2.9.1 Analog and PLL PLL and Analog supplies benefit from filters or ferrite beads to keep the noise from causing problems. The minimum recommendation is a ferrite bead along with at least one capacitor on the device side of the bead. An additional recommendation is to add one capacitor just before the bead to form a Pi filter. The filter needs to be as close as possible to the device pin, with the device side capacitor being the most important component to be close to the device pin. PLL pins close together can be combined on the same supply, but analog pins should all have their own filters. PLL pins farther away from each other may need their own filtered supply. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 135 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 7.2.9.2 www.ti.com Digital Recommended capacitors for power supply decoupling are all 0.1uF in the smallest body size that can be used. Capacitors are more effective in the smallest physical size to limit lead inductance. For example, 0201 sized capacitors are better than 0402 sized capacitors, and so on. TI recommends using capacitors no larger than 0402. Place at least one capacitor for every two power pins. For those power pins that have only one pin, a capacitor is still required. Place one bulk (10 uF or larger) capacitor for every 10 or so power pins as closely as possible to the chip. These larger caps do not need to be under the chip footprint. Pay special attention not to put so much capacitance on the supply that it slows the start-up voltage ramp enough to change the power sequencing order. Also be sure to verify that the main chip reset is low until after all supplies are at their correct voltage and stable. DDR peripheral related supply capacitor numbers are provided in Section 8.13, DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller. 136 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 7.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Reset 7.3.1 System-Level Reset Sources The device has several types of system-level resets. Table 7-7 lists these reset types, along with the reset initiator, and the effects of each reset on the device. Table 7-7. System-Level Reset Types TYPE Power-on Reset (POR) External Warm Reset Emulation Warm Reset INITIATOR RESETS ALL MODULES, EXCLUDING EMAC SWITCH, EMULATION, PLL AND CLOCK CONFIG RESETS EMAC SWITCH RESETS EMULATION PLL AND CLOCK CONFIG LATCHES BOOT PINS ASSERTS RSTOUT_WD_OUT PIN POR pin Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Optional (1) (2) (3) No No Yes Optional (1) (2) No No No Optional (1) RESET pin Yes Optional On-Chip Emulation Logic Yes Optional (3) Watchdog Timer Yes Optional (3) No No No Yes Software Global Cold Reset Software Yes Optional (3) Yes Yes No Optional (1) Software Global Warm Reset Software Yes Optional (3) No No No Optional (1) Test Reset TRST pin No No Yes No No No Watchdog Reset (1) (2) (3) RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin asserted only if BTMODE[11] was latched as "0" when coming out of reset. While POR and/or RESET is asserted, the RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin is 3-stated and the internal pull resistor is disabled; therefore, an external pullup/pulldown can be used to set the state of this pin (high/low) while POR and/or RESET is asserted. For more detailed information on external PUs/PDs, see Section 4.5.1, Pullup/Pulldown Resistors. EMAC Switch is NOT reset when the ISO_CONTROL bit in the RESET_ISO Control Module register is set to "1". 7.3.2 Power-on Reset (POR pin) Power-on Reset (POR) is initiated by the POR pin and is used to reset the entire chip, including the Test and Emulation logic, and the EMAC Switch. POR is also referred to as a cold reset since it is required to be asserted when the device goes through a power-up cycle. However, a device power-up cycle is not required to initiate a Power-on Reset. The following sequence must be followed during a Power-on Reset: 1. Wait for the power supplies to reach normal operating conditions while keeping the POR pin asserted. 2. Wait for the input clock sources DEV_CLKIN, AUX_CLKIN, and SERDES_CLKN/P to be stable (if used by the system) while keeping the POR pin asserted (low). 3. Once the power supplies and the input clock sources are stable, the POR pin must remain asserted (low) [see Section 7.3.18, Reset Electrical Data/Timing]. Within the low period of the POR pin, the following happens: (a) All pins except Emulation pins enter a Hi-Z mode and the associated pulls, if applicable, will be enabled. (b) The PRCM asserts reset to all modules within the device. (c) The PRCM begins propagating these clocks to the chip with the PLLs in BYPASS mode. 4. The POR pin may now be de-asserted (driven high). When the POR pin is de-asserted (high): (a) The BTMODE[15:0] pins are latched. (b) Reset to the ARM Cortex-A8 and Modules without a local processor is de-asserted. (c) RSTOUT_WD_OUT is briefly asserted if BTMODE[11] was latched as "0". (d) The clock, reset, and power-down state of each peripheral is determined by the default settings of the PRCM. (e) The ARM Cortex-A8 begins executing from the Boot ROM. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 137 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 7.3.3 www.ti.com External Warm Reset (RESET pin) An external warm reset is activated by driving the RESET pin active-low. This resets everything in the device, except for the Test and Emulation logic, and the EMAC Switch (optional). An emulator session stays alive during warm reset. The following sequence must be followed during a warm reset: 1. Power supplies and input clock sources should already be stable. 2. The RESET pin must be asserted (low)[see Section 7.3.18, Reset Electrical Data/Timing]. Within the low period of the RESET pin, the following happens: (a) All pins, except Test and Emulation pins, enter a Hi-Z mode and the associated pulls, if applicable, will be enabled. (b) The PRCM asserts reset to all modules within the device, except for the Test and Emulation logic, EMAC Switch (optional), PLL, and Clock configuration. 3. The RESET pin may now be de-asserted (driven high). When the RESET pin is de-asserted (high): (a) The BTMODE[15:0] pins are latched. (b) Reset to the ARM Cortex-A8 and modules without a local processor is de-asserted, with the exception of Test and Emulation logic, EMAC Switch (optional), PLL, and Clock configuration. (c) RSTOUT_WD_OUT is asserted [see Section 7.3.18, Reset Electrical Data/Timing], if BTMODE[11] was latched as "0". (d) The clock, reset, and power-down state of each peripheral is determined by the default settings of the PRCM. (e) The ARM Cortex-A8 begins executing from the Boot ROM. 7.3.4 Emulation Warm Reset An Emulation Warm Reset is activated by the on-chip Emulation Module. It has the same effect and requirements as an External Warm Reset (RESET), with the following exceptions: • BTMODE[15:0] pins are not re-latched • RSTOUT_WD_OUT is not 3-stated and is actively driven based on the value previously latched on the BTMODE[11] pin. The emulator initiates an Emulation Warm Reset via the ICEPICK module. To invoke the Emulation Warm Reset via the ICEPICK module, the user can perform the following from the Code Composer Studio™ IDE menu: Target -> Reset -> System Reset. 7.3.5 Watchdog Reset A Watchdog Reset is initiated when the Watchdog Timer counter reaches zero. It has the same effect and requirements as an External Warm Reset (RESET pin), with the following exceptions: • BTMODE[15:0] pins are not re-latched • RSTOUT_WD_OUT is not 3-stated and is actively driven based on the value previously latched on the BTMODE[11] pin. In addition, a Watchdog Reset always results in RSTOUT_WD_OUT being asserted, regardless of whether the BTMODE[11] pin was latched as "0" or "1". 7.3.6 Software Global Cold Reset A Software Global Cold Reset is initiated under software control. It has the same effect and requirements as a POR Reset, with the following exceptions: • BTMODE[15:0] pins are not re-latched and EMAC Switch (optional) is not reset • RSTOUT_WD_OUT is not 3-stated and is actively driven based on the value previously latched on the BTMODE[11] pin. 138 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Software initiates a Software Global Cold Reset by writing a "1" to the RST_GLOBAL_COLD_SW bit in the PRM_RSTCTRL register in the PRCM. For more detailed information on the PRM_RSTCTRL register, see the PRCM Registers section of the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.3.7 Software Global Warm Reset A Software Global Warm Reset is initiated under software control. It has the same effect and requirements as a External Warm Reset (RESET pin), with the following exceptions: • BTMODE[15:0] pins are not re-latched • RSTOUT_WD_OUT is not 3-stated and is actively driven based on the value previously latched on the BTMODE[11] pin. Software initiates a Software Global Warm Reset by writing a "1" to the RST_GLOBAL_WARM_SW bit in the PRM_RSTCTRL register in the PRCM. For more detailed information on the PRM_RSTCTRL register, see the PRCM Registers section of the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.3.8 Test Reset (TRST pin) A Test Reset is activated by the emulator asserting the TRST pin. The only effect a Test Reset has is to reset the Test and Emulation Logic. 7.3.9 Local Reset The Local Reset for various Modules within the device is controlled by programming the PRCM and/or the Peripheral Module’s internal registers. Only the associated Module is reset when a Local Reset is asserted, leaving the rest of the device unaffected. For more details on Peripheral Local Resets, see the Reset Management section of the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.3.10 Reset Priority If any of the above reset sources occur simultaneously, the device only processes the highest-priority reset request. The reset request priorities, from high-to-low, are as follows: 1. Power-on Reset (POR) 2. Test Reset (TRST) 3. External Warm Reset (RESET pin) 4. Emulation Warm Resets 5. Watchdog Reset 6. Software Global Cold/Warm Resets 7.3.11 Reset Status Register The Reset Status Register (PRM_RSTST) contains information about the last reset that occurred in the system. For more information on this register, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.3.12 PCIE Reset Isolation The device supports reset isolation for the PCI Express (PCIE) module. This means that the PCI Express Subsystem can be reset without resetting the rest of the device. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 139 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com When the device is a PCI Express Root Complex (RC), the PCIE Subsystem can be reset by software through the PRCM. Software should ensure that there are no ongoing PCIE transactions before asserting this reset by first taking the PCIE Subsystem into the IDLE state. After bringing the PCIE Subsystem out of reset, bus enumeration should be performed again and should treat all Endpoints (EP) as if they had just been connected. When the device is a PCI Express Endpoint (EP), the PCIE Subsystem will generate an interrupt when an in-band reset is received. Software should process this interrupt by putting the PCIE Subsystem in the IDLE state and then asserting the PCIE local reset through the PRCM. All device level resets mentioned in the previous sections, except Test Reset, will also reset the PCIE Subsystem. Therefore, the PCIE peripheral should issue a Hot Reset to all downstream devices and reenumerate the bus upon coming out of reset. For more detailed information on reset isolation procedures, see the PCIe Reset Isolation section of the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.3.13 EMAC Switch Reset Isolation The device supports reset isolation for the Ethernet Switch (EMAC Switch) only when clock sourced from SERDES. The other clocking source options do not provide RESET Isolation. This allows the device to undergo all resets listed in Section 7.3.1, System-Level Reset Sources, with the exception of POR Reset, without disrupting the Ethernet Switch or the traffic being routed through the switch during the reset condition. The following reset types can optionally provide an EMAC Switch reset isolation by setting the ISO_CONTROL bit in the RESET_ISO Control Module register to a "1": • External Warm Reset • Emulation Warm Reset • Watchdog Reset • Software Global Cold Reset • Software Global Warm Reset When one of above resets occurs and the Ethernet Switch (EMAC Switch) is programmed to be isolated: • The switch function of the EMAC Switch and the PLL embedded in the SERDES Module (which provides the reference clocks to the EMAC Switch) will not be reset. • Several Control Module registers are not reset. For more details, see the description of the RESET_ISO register in the Control Module chapter of the device-specific Technical Reference Manual . • The pin multiplexing of some of the EMAC Switch pins is unaffected. For more details, see the description of the RESET_ISO register in the Control Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. The EMAC Switch is always reset when: • One of the above resets occurs and the Ethernet Switch is programmed to be “not isolated” • A POR Reset occurs 7.3.14 RSTOUT_WD_OUT Pin The RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin reflects device reset status and is de-asserted (high) when the device is out reset. This output will always be asserted when a Watchdog Timer reset (Watchdog Reset) occurs. In addition, this output is always 3-stated and the internal pull resistor is disabled on this pin while POR and/or RESET is asserted; therefore, an external pullup/pulldown can be used to set the state of this pin (high/low) while POR and/or RESET is asserted. For more detailed information on external PUs/PDs, see Section 4.5.1, Pullup/Pulldown Resistors. If the BTMODE[11] pin is latched as a "0" at the rising edge of POR or RESET, then RSTOUT_WD_OUT is also asserted when any of the below resets occur: 140 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com • • • • SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Power-On Reset (asserted after the BTMODE[11] pin is latched) External Warm Reset (asserted after the BTMODE[11] pin is latched) Emulation Warm Reset Software Global Cold/Warm Reset The RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin remains asserted until the PRCM releases the host ARM Cortex-A8 processor for reset. 7.3.15 Effect of Reset on Emulation & Trace The device Emulation & Trace Logic will only be reset by the following sources: • Power-On Reset • Software Global Cold Reset • Test Reset Other than these three reset types, none of the other resets will affect the Emulation and Trace Logic. However, the multiplexing of the EMU[4:2] pins is reset by all system reset types except Test Reset. 7.3.16 Reset During Power Domain Switching Each Power Domain has a dedicated Warm Reset and Cold Reset. Warm Reset for a Power Domain is asserted under either of the following two conditions: 1. An External Warm Reset, Emulation Warm Reset, or Software Global Warm Reset occurs 2. When that Power Domain switches from the "ON" state to the "OFF" state Cold Reset for a Power Domain is asserted under either of the following two conditions: 1. Power-On Reset or Software Global Cold Reset occurs 2. When that Power Domain switches from the "OFF" state to the "ON" state 7.3.17 Pin Behaviors at Reset When any reset, other than Test Reset, (all described in Section 7.3.1, System-Level Reset Sources) is asserted, all device I/O pins are reset into a Hi-Z state except for: • Emulation Pins. These pins are only put into a Hi-Z state when Test Reset (TRST) is asserted. • EMAC Switch Pins. These pins are always put into a Hi-Z state during Power-On Reset. However, some EMAC Switch pins will not be put into a Hi-Z state during the other reset modes when the ISO_CONTROL bit in the RESET_ISO register of the Control Module is programmed as a "1". For more details, see the description of the RESET_ISO register in the Control Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. • RSTOUT_WD_OUT Pin during any reset types except for POR and RESET. For more detailed information on RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin behavior, see Section 7.3.14, RSTOUT_WD_OUT Pin. • DDR[0] Address/Control Pins (CLK, CLK, CKE, WE, CS[0], RAS, CAS, ODT[0], RST, BA[2:0], A[15:0]). These pins are 3-stated during reset. However, these pins are then driven to the same value as their internal pull resistor reset value when reset is released. In addition, the PINCNTL registers, which control pin multiplexing, enabling the IPUs/IPDs, and enabling the receiver, are reset to their default state. Again, enabling the EMAC Switch reset isolation prevents some PINCNTL registers from being reset. For details on EMAC Switch reset isolation, see the descriptions of the RESET_ISO register and the PINCNTL registers in the Control Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Internal pull-up/down (IPU/IPD) resistors are enabled during and immediately after reset as described in Section 3.3, Terminal Functions of this document. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 141 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com NOTE The reset pin state is after all the power supplies are ramped up and stable. The state is not not ensured during power-up sequencing. Upon coming out of reset, the ARM Cortex-A8 starts executing code from the internal Boot ROM. The Boot ROM code modifies the PINCNTLx registers to configure the associated pins for the chosen primary and backup Bootmodes. 7.3.18 Reset Electrical Data/Timing NOTE For supported OPP frequencies, see Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs). Table 7-8. Timing Requirements for Reset (see Figure 7-5 and Figure 7-6) OPP100 NO. 1 tw(RESET) 2 3 (1) (2) MIN MAX UNIT 12P (1) ns POR 2P (2) ns RESET 2P (2) ns 0 ns Pulse duration, POR low or RESET low tsu(BOOT) Setup time, BTMODE[15:0] pins valid before POR high or RESET high th(BOOT) Hold time, BTMODE[15:0] pins valid after POR high or RESET high The device clock source must be stable and at a valid frequency prior to meeting the tw(RESET) requirement. P = 1/(DEV Clock) frequency in ns. Table 7-9. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions During Reset (see Figure 7-6) NO. 4 OPP100 PARAMETER td(RSTL- MIN MAX UNIT Delay time, RESET low or POR low to all I/Os entering their reset state 14 ns Delay time, RESET high or POR high to all I/Os exiting their reset state 14 ns IORST) 5 td(RSTHIOFUNC) 6 td(RSTH- RESET assertion tw(RESET) ≥ 30P 0 2P ns RESET assertion tw(RESET) < 30P 0 32P tw(RESET) ns Delay time, POR high to RSTOUT_WD_OUT high (1) (2) 0 12500P ns Delay time, RESET low to RSTOUT_WD_OUT Hi-Z (1) (2) 0 2P ns Delay time, POR high to RSTOUT_WD_OUT driven based on latched BTMODE[11] value (1) (2) 0 2P ns Delay time, RESET high to RSTOUT_WD_OUT driven based on latched BTMODE[11] value (1) (2) 0 2P ns Delay time, RESET high to RSTOUT_WD_OUT high (1) (2) RSTOUTH) 7 td(PORHRSTOUTH) 8 td(RSTLRSTOUTZ) 9 td(PORHRSTOUTL) 10 td(RSTHRSTOUTD) (1) (2) 142 For more detailed information on RSTOUT_WD_OUT pin behavior, see Section 7.3.14, RSTOUT_WD_OUT Pin. P = 1/(DEV Clock) frequency in ns. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Figure 7-5 shows the Power-Up Timing. Figure 7-6 shows the Warm Reset (RESET) Timing. Max Reset Timing is identical to Warm Reset Timing, except the BTMODE[15:0] pins are not re-latched. Power Supplies Ramping Power Supplies Stable Clock Source Stable DEV_CLKIN/ (A) AUX_CLKIN 1 POR RESET 7 9 RSTOUT_WD_OUT Hi-Z BTMODE[11] (B) 5 3 2 BTMODE[15:0] Hi-Z Config 5 (C) Other I/O Pins A. B. C. RESET STATE Power supplies and DEV_CLKIN/AUX_CLKIN must be stable before the start of tw(RESET). RSTOUT_WD_OUT only asserted if BTMODE[11] was latched as a "0" when coming out of reset. For more detailed information on the RESET STATE of each pin, see Section 7.3.17, Pin Behaviors at Reset. Also see , Terminal Functions for the IPU/IPD settings during reset. Figure 7-5. Power-Up Timing Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 143 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Power Supplies Stable DEV_CLKIN/ AUX_CLKIN POR 1 RESET 8 6 10 Hi-Z RSTOUT_WD_OUT BTMODE[11] 5 4 3 2 Hi-Z BTMODE[15:0] Config 5 4 (B) Other I/O Pins A. B. (A) RESET STATE RSTOUT_WD_OUT only asserted if BTMODE[11] was latched as a "0" when coming out of reset. For more detailed information on the RESET STATE of each pin, see Section 7.3.17, Pin Behaviors at Reset. Also see , Terminal Functions for the IPU/IPD settings during reset. Figure 7-6. Warm Reset (RESET) Timing 144 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 7.4 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Clocking The device clocks are generated from several reference clocks that are fed to on-chip PLLs and dividers (both inside and outside of the PRCM Module). Figure 7-7 shows a high-level overview of the device system clocking structure (Note: to reduce complexity, not all clocking connections are shown). For detailed information on the device clocks, see the Clock Generation and Management section of the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. NOTE For supported OPP frequencies, see Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs). Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 145 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com PLL_HDVPSS HDVPSS PLL_MEDIACTL ISS, Media Controller SYSCLK4 L3 Fast/Medium, L4 Fast, EDMA, OCMC PRCM PLL_L3L4 L3/L4 Slow, GPMC, ELM, McASP, Mailbox, Spinlock SYSCLK6 USB0/1 CLKDCO PLL_USB DEVOSC/ DEV_CLKIN AUXOSC/ AUX_CLKIN SYSCLK10 M U X CLKOUT PRCM SPI0/1/2/3, I2C0/1/2/3, UART0/1/2, HDMI CEC SYSCLK8 MMC0/1/2 (Note: Separate MUX exists for each PLL) PLL_DDR DDR /2 DMM HDVPSS SD VENC PLL_VIDEO0 HDMI PLL_VIDEO2 HDMI PHY HDVPSS VOUT1 M U X M U X M U X PLL_VIDEO1 PLL_AUDIO HDVPSS VOUT0 PRCM From PLL_VIDEO0/1/2 HDVPSS HD VENC PRCM SYSCLK20 SYSCLK21 From AUX Clock, AUD_CLK0/1/2 PLL_ARM (Embedded PLL) RTCDIVIDER From CLKIN32 Pin PRCM M U X MCASP0/1 AUX_CLK, ATL M U X HDMI I2S M U X Cortex-A8 SYSCLK18 From DEV/AUX Clock, AUD_CLK0/1/2, TCLKIN RTC, GPIO, SyncTimer, Cortex-A8 (Optional) M U X TIMER1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8 WDT0 (Optional) SmartReflex M U X SERDES_CLK From PLL_VIDEO0 M U X SERDES (Embedded PLL) EMAC Switch PCIE SERDES (Embedded PLL) WDT0 (Optional) RCOSC32K Figure 7-7. System Clocking Overview 146 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 7.4.1 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Device (DEV) and Auxiliary (AUX) Clock Inputs The device provides two clock inputs, Device (DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN) and Auxiliary (AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN). The Device (DEV) clock is used to generate the majority of the internal reference clocks, while the Auxiliary (AUX) clock can optionally be used as a source for the Audio and/or Video PLLs. The DEV and AUX clocks can be sourced in two ways: 1. Using an external crystal in conjunction with the internal oscillator or 2. Using an external 1.8-V LVCMOS-compatible clock input Note: The external crystals used with the internal oscillators must operate in fundamental parallel resonant mode only. There is no overtone support. The DEV Clock should in most cases be 20 MHz. However, it can optionally range anywhere from 20 - 30 MHz if the following are true: • A precise 32768-Hz clock is not needed for Real-Time Clock functionality • If the boot mode is FAST XIP The AUX Clock is optional and can range from 20-30 MHz. It can be used to source the Audio and/or Video PLLs when a very precise audio or video frequency is required. 7.4.1.1 Using the Internal Oscillators When the internal oscillators are used to generate the DEV and AUX clocks, external crystals are required to be connected across the DEVOSC or AUXOSC oscillator MXI and MXO pins, along with two load capacitors (see Figure 7-8 and Figure 7-9). The external crystal load capacitors should also be connected to the associated oscillator ground pin (VSSA_DEVOSC or VSSA_AUXOSC). The capacitors should not be connected to board ground (VSS). Figure 7-8. Device Oscillator Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 147 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com AUXOSC_MXI/ AUX_CLKIN AUXOSC_MXO Rd (Optional) Crystal C1 VSSA_AUXOSC C2 Figure 7-9. Auxiliary Oscillator The load capacitors, C1 and C2 in the above pictures, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator MXI, MXO, and VSS pins. CL = C1 C2 (C1 + C2 ) + Cshunt Table 7-10. Input Requirements for Crystal Circuit on the Device Oscillator (DEVOSC) PARAMETER MIN TYP MAX 4 ms Crystal Oscillation frequency (1) 20 20 30 MHz Parallel Load Capacitance (C1 and C2) 12 24 pF Start-up time (from power up until oscillating at stable frequency) Crystal ESR 50 Crystal Shunt Capacitance (Cshunt) 5 Crystal Oscillation Mode Ω pF Fundamental Only Crystal Frequency stability (1) UNIT n/a ±50 ppm 20-MHz DEV clock is required for all bootmodes other than Fast XIP. For more detailed information on boot modes, see the ROM Code Memory and Peripheral Booting chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Table 7-11. Input Requirements for Crystal Circuit on the Auxiliary Oscillator (AUXOSC) PARAMETER MIN TYP Start-up time (from power up until oscillating at stable frequency) UNIT 4 ms Crystal Oscillation frequency 20 30 MHz Parallel Load Capacitance (C1 and C2) 12 24 pF Crystal ESR 50 Crystal Shunt Capacitance (Cshunt) 5 Crystal Oscillation Mode Ω pF Fundamental Only Crystal Frequency stability (1) (1) MAX n/a ±50 ppm Applies only when sourcing the HDMI or HDVPSS DAC clocks from the AUXOSC 7.4.1.2 Using a 1.8V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillators as the DEV and AUX clock inputs to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in Figure 7-10 and Figure 7-11. The DEV_CLKIN and AUX_CLKIN pins are connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock sources. The DEV_MXO and AUX_MXO pins are left unconnected. The VSSA_DEVOSC and VSSA_AUXOSC pins are connected to board ground (VSS). 148 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DEVOSC_MXI/ DEV_CLKIN DEVOSC_MXO VSSA_DEVOSC NC Figure 7-10. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input (DEV_OSC) AUXOSC_MXI/ AUX_CLKIN AUXOSC_MXO VSSA_AUXOSC NC Figure 7-11. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input (AUX_OSC) The clock source must meet the DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN timing requirements shown in Table 7-14, Timing Requirements for DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN. The clock source must meet the AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN timing requirements shown in Table 7-15, Timing Requirements for AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN. 7.4.2 SERDES_CLKN/P Input Clock A high-quality, low-jitter differential clock source is required for the PCIE PHY. The clock is required to be AC coupled to the device's SERDES_CLKP and SERDES_CLKN pins according to the specifications in Table 7-12. Both the clock source and the coupling capacitors should be placed physically as close to the processor as possible. In addition, make sure to follow any PCB routing and termination recommendations that the clock source manufacturer recommends. Table 7-12. SERDES_CLKN/P AC Coupling Capacitors Recommendations PARAMETER SERDES_CLKN/P AC coupling capacitor value SERDES_CLKN/P AC coupling capacitor package size (1) (2) (1) (2) MIN TYP MAX 0.25 0.27 4.0 UNIT nF 0402 0603 EIA L x W, 10 Mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40 x 20 Mil surface mount capacitor. The physical size of the capacitor should be as small as practical. Use the same size on both lines in each pair placed side-by-side. The value of this capacitor depends on several factors including differential input clock swing. For a 100MHz differential clock with an approximate 1V voltage swing, the recommended typical value for the SerDes Clock AC Coupling Capacitors is 270pF. Deviating from this recommendation can result in the reduction of clock signal amplitude or lowering the noise rejection characteristics. Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 149 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com The differential clock source is required to meet the REFCLK AC Specifications outlined in the PCI EXPRESS CARD ELECTROMECHANICAL SPECIFICATION, REV. 2.0, at the input to the AC coupling capacitors. In addition, LVDS clock sources that are compliant to the above specification, but with the following exceptions, are also acceptable: Table 7-13. Acceptable Exceptions to the REFCLK AC Specifications for LVDS Clock Sources PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT VIH Differential High-Level Input Voltage 125 1000 mV VIL Differential Low-Level Input Voltage -1000 -125 mV 7.4.3 CLKIN32 Input Clock An external 32768-Hz clock input can optionally be provided at the CLKIN32 pin to serve as a reference clock in place of the RTCDIVIDER clock for the following Modules: • RTC • GPIO0/1/2/3 • TIMER1/2/3/4/5/6/7 • ARM Cortex-A8 • SYNCTIMER The CLKIN32 source must meet the timing requirements shown in Table 7-16. 7.4.4 Output Clocks Select Logic The device includes two selectable general-purpose clock outputs (CLKOUT0 and CLKOUT1). The source for these output clocks is controlled by the CLKOUT_MUX register in the Control Module (see Figure 712). 150 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 CLKOUT_MUX RESERVED RCOSC32K Output PLL_AUDIO ARM Cortex-A8 Functional Clock / 16 AUX Clock DEV Clock PLL_L3L4 Output PLL_MEDIACTL Output / 2 PLL_HDVPSS Output / 2 PCIE SERDES Observation Clock CLKIN32 PLL_VIDEO0 PLL_HDVICP PLL_HDVPSS SERDES Observation Clock 11 10 01 00 PRCM SYSCLK Output 1011-1111 1010 1001 1000 0111 CLKOUT0 0110 CLKOUT1 0101 0100 0011 0010 0001 0000 Figure 7-12. CLKOUTx Source Selection Logic For detailed information on the CLKOUTx switching characteristics, see Table 7-17. 7.4.5 Input/Output Clocks Electrical Data/Timing Note: If an external clock oscillator is used, a single clean power supply should be used to power both the device and the external clock oscillator circuit. Table 7-14. Timing Requirements for DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN (1) (2) (3) (see Figure 7-13) OPP100 NO. MIN NOM 50 (2) (3) UNIT 1 tc(DMXI) Cycle time, DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN 33.33 50 ns 2 tw(DMXIH) Pulse duration, DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN high 0.45C 0.55C ns 3 tw(DMXIL) Pulse duration, DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN low 0.45C 0.55C ns 4 tt(DMXI) Transition time, DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN 7 ns 5 tJ(DMXI) Period jitter, DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN 0.02C ns Frequency Stability (1) MAX ±50 ppm The DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN frequency and PLL settings should be chosen such that the resulting SYSCLKs and Module Clocks are within the specific ranges shown in the Section 7.4.7, SYSCLKs and Section 7.4.8, Module Clocks. The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN. C = DEV_CLKIN cycle time in ns. For example, when DEVOSC_MXI/DEV_CLKIN frequency is 20 MHz, use C = 50 ns. 5 1 1 4 2 DEVOSC_MXI/ DEV_CLKIN 3 4 Figure 7-13. DEV_MXI/DEV_CLKIN Timing Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 151 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 7-15. Timing Requirements for AUX_MXI/AUX_CLKIN (1) (2) (see Figure 7-14) OPP100 NO. MIN NOM 33.3 50 MAX UNIT 1 tc(AMXI) Cycle time, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN 50 ns 2 tw(AMXIH) Pulse duration, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN high 0.45C 0.55C ns 3 tw(AMXIL) Pulse duration, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN low 0.45C 0.55C ns 4 tt(AMXI) Transition time, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN 7 ns 5 tJ(AMXI) Period jitter, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN 0.02C ns 6 Sf Frequency stability, AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN (3) (1) (2) (3) ± 50 ppm The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN. C = AUX_CLKIN cycle time in ns. For example, when AUXOSC_MXI/AUX_CLKIN frequency is 20 MHz, use C = 50 ns. Applies only when sourcing the HDMI or HDVPSS DAC clocks from the AUXOSC. 5 1 1 4 2 AUXOSC_MXI/ AUX_CLKIN 3 4 Figure 7-14. AUX_MXI/AUX_CLKIN Timing 152 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 7-16. Timing Requirements for CLKIN32 (1) (2) (see Figure 7-15) OPP100 NO. MIN NOM MAX 1 tc(CLKIN32) Cycle time, CLKIN32 2 tw(CLKIN32H) Pulse duration, CLKIN32 high 0.45C 0.55C ns 3 tw(CKIN32L) Pulse duration, CLKIN32 low 0.45C 0.55C ns 4 tt(CLKIN32) Transition time, CLKIN32 7 ns tJ(CLKIN32) Period jitter, CLKIN32 0.02C ns 5 (1) (2) 1/32768 UNIT s The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VIL MAX and VIH MIN. C = CLKIN32 cycle time in ns. For example, when CLKIN32 frequency is 32768 Hz, use C = 1/32768 s. 5 1 4 1 2 CLKIN32 3 4 Figure 7-15. CLKIN32 Timing Table 7-17. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for CLKOUTx (CLKOUT0 and CLKOUT1) (1) (2) (see Figure 7-16) NO. MIN MAX 5 UNIT 1 tc(CLKOUTx) Cycle time, CLKOUTx 2 tw(CLKOUTxH) Pulse duration, CLKOUTx high 0.45P 0.55P ns 3 tw(CLKOUTxL) Pulse duration, CLKOUTx low 0.45P 0.55P ns tt(CLKOUTx) Transition time, CLKOUTx 0.05P ns 4 (1) (2) OPP100 PARAMETER ns The reference points for the rise and fall transitions are measured at VOL MAX and VOH MIN. P = 1/CLKOUTx clock frequency in nanoseconds (ns). For example, when CLKOUTx frequency is 200 MHz, use P = 5 ns. 2 4 1 CLKOUTx (Divide-by-1) 3 4 Figure 7-16. CLKOUTx Timing Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 153 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 7.4.6 www.ti.com PLLs The device contains 10 top-level PLLs, and embedded PLLs (within the ARM Cortex-A8, PCIE, and CSI) that provide clocks to different parts of the system. Figure 7-17 and Figure 7-18 show simplified block diagrams of the Top-Level PLL and PLL_ARM. In addition, see the System Clocking Overview (Figure 77) for a high-level view of the device clock architecture including the PLL reference clock sources and connections. DEV/AUX Clock REFCLK 1 (N + 1) xM Multiplier CLKDCO 1 M2 CLKOUT 1 (N 2 + 1) Figure 7-17. Top-Level PLL Simplified Block Diagram DEV Clock 1 (N + 1) REFCLK x2M Multiplier DCOCLK 1 M2 1 2 CLKOUT 1 (N 2 + 1) Figure 7-18. PLL_ARM Simplified Block Diagram The reference clock for most of the PLLs comes from the DEV input clock, with select PLLs also having the option to use the AUX input clock as a reference. Also, each PLL supports a Bypass mode in which the reference clock can be directly passed to the PLL CLKOUT through a divider. All device PLL’s will come-up in Bypass mode after reset. For details on programming the device PLLs, see the Control Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 7.4.6.1 PLL Power Supply Filtering The device PLLs are supplied externally via the VDDA_xPLL_1P8 power-supply pins (where "x" represents ARM, VID0, VID1, AUDIO, DDR, and/or L3). External filtering must be added on the PLL supply pins to ensure that the requirements in Table 7-18 are met. Table 7-18. PLL Power Supply Requirements PARAMETER MIN MAX Dynamic noise at VDDA_xPLL_1P8 pins 7.4.6.2 50 UNIT mV p-p PLL Multipliers and Dividers The Top-Level and PLL_ARM PLLs support the internal multiplier and divider values shown in Table 7-19, Top-Level PLL Multiplier and Divider Limits and Table 7-20, PLL_ARM Multiplier and Divider Limits. The PLLs must be programmed to conform to the various REFCLK, CLKDCO, DCOCLK, and CLKOUT limits described in Section 7.4.6.3, PLL Frequency Limits. Table 7-19. Top-Level PLL Multiplier and Divider Limits PARAMETER N Pre-Divider 154 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts MIN MAX 0 255 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 7-19. Top-Level PLL Multiplier and Divider Limits (continued) PARAMETER (1) MIN MAX PLL Multiplier (M) 2 4095 (1) M2 Post Divider 1 127 N2 Bypass Divider 0 15 MIN MAX The PLL Multiplier supports fractional values (up to 18-bits of fraction) except when the PLL Multiplier is > 4093. Table 7-20. PLL_ARM Multiplier and Divider Limits PARAMETER (1) (2) N Pre-Divider 0 127 PLL Multiplier (M) (1) 2 2047 (2) M2 Post Divider 1 31 N2 Bypass Divider 0 15 This parameter describes the limits on the programmable multiplier value M. The multiplication factor for the PLL_ARM is equal to 2 * M (also see Figure 7-18). The PLL Multiplier supports fractional values (up to 18-bits of fraction) except when the PLL Multiplier is < 20 OR > 2045. 7.4.6.3 PLL Frequency Limits Each PLL supports a minimum and maximum operating frequency for its REFCLK, CKLDCO, and CLKOUT values. The PLLs must be configured not to exceed any of the constraints placed on these values shown in Table 7-21 through Table 7-23. Care must be taken to stay within these limits when selecting external clock input frequencies, internal divider values, and PLL multiply ratios. In addition, limits shown in these tables may be further restricted by the clock frequency limitations of the device modules using these clocks. For more detailed information on the SYSCLK and Module Clock frequency limits, see Section 7.4.7, SYSCLKs and Section 7.4.8, Module Clocks. Table 7-21. Top-Level PLL Frequency Ranges (ALL OPPs) CLOCK (1) (2) MIN MAX UNIT REFCLK 0.5 2.5 MHz CLKDCO (HS1) (1) 1000 2000 MHz CLKDCO (HS2) (2) 500 1000 MHz CLKOUT see Table 7-23 see Table 7-23 MHz The PLL has two modes of operation: HS1 and HS2. The mode of operation should be set, according to the desired CLKDCO frequency, by programming the SELFREQDCO field of the ADPLLLJx_CLKCTRL registers in the Control Module. CLKDCO of the PLL_USB is used undivided by the USB modules; therefore, CLKDCO for the PLL_USB PLL must be programmed to 960 MHz for proper operation. Table 7-22. ARM Cortex-A8 Embedded PLL (PLL_ARM) Frequency Ranges (ALL OPPs) CLOCK MIN MAX UNIT REFCLK 0.032 52 MHz DCOCLK 20 2000 MHz CLKOUT see Table 7-23 see Table 7-23 MHz Table 7-23. PLL CLKOUT Frequency Ranges PLL OPP100 MIN MAX UNIT PLL_ARM 10 600 MHz PLL_HDVICP 10 266 MHz PLL_L3L4 10 200 MHz Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 155 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 7-23. PLL CLKOUT Frequency Ranges (continued) OPP100 PLL (1) 7.4.6.4 MIN MAX UNIT PLL_DDR 10 400 MHz PLL_HDVPSS 10 200 MHz PLL_AUDIO 10 200 MHz PLL_MEDIACTL 10 400 MHz PLL_USB 10 (1) 960 MHz PLL_VIDEO0 10 200 MHz PLL_VIDEO1 10 200 MHz PLL_VIDEO2 10 200 MHz When the USB is used, PLL_USB must be fixed at 960 MHz. PLL Register Description(s) The PLL Control Registers reside in the Control Module and are listed in Section 4.1, Control Module of this datasheet. 7.4.7 SYSCLKs In some cases, the system clock inputs and PLL outputs are sent to the PRCM Module for division and multiplexing before being routed to the various device Modules. These clock outputs from the PRCM Module are called SYSCLKs. Table Table 7-24 lists the device SYSCLKs along with their maximum supported clock frequencies. In addition, limits shown in these tables may be further restricted by the clock frequency limitations of the device modules using these clocks. For more details on Module Clock frequency limits, see Section 7.4.8 Module Clocks. NOTE For supported OPP frequencies, see Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs). Table 7-24. Maximum SYSCLK Clock Frequencies 156 SYSCLK MAX CLOCK FREQUENCY OPP100 (MHz) SYSCLK1 RSV SYSCLK2 RSV SYSCLK3 266 SYSCLK4 220 SYSCLK5 RSV SYSCLK6 110 SYSCLK7 RSV SYSCLK8 192 SYSCLK9 RSV SYSCLK10 48 SYSCLK11 RSV SYSCLK12 RSV SYSCLK13 RSV SYSCLK14 27 SYSCLK15 RSV SYSCLK16 27 SYSCLK17 RSV Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 7-24. Maximum SYSCLK Clock Frequencies (continued) 7.4.8 SYSCLK MAX CLOCK FREQUENCY OPP100 (MHz) SYSCLK18 0.032768 SYSCLK19 192 SYSCLK20 192 SYSCLK21 192 SYSCLK22 RSV SYSCLK23 RSV Module Clocks Device Modules either receive their clock directly from an external clock input, directly from a PLL, or from a PRCM SYSCLK output. Table 7-25 lists the clock source options for each Module on this device, along with the maximum frequency that Module can accept. To ensure proper Module functionality, the device PLLs and dividers must be programmed not to exceed the maximum frequencies listed in this table. Table 7-25. Maximum Module Clock Frequencies MODULE CLOCK SOURCE(S) MAX FREQUENCY OPP100 (MHz) Cortex-A8 PLL_ARM SYSCLK18 600 DDR0 PLL_DDR 400 DMM PLL_DDR/2 200 EDMA SYSCLK4 220 EMAC Switch (GMII) SERDES PLL_VIDEO0 Fixed 125 EMAC Switch (RGMII) PLL_VIDEO0 SERDES Fixed 250 EMAC Switch (RMII and MII) SERDES PLL_VIDEO0 EMAC_RMREFCLK Pin Fixed 50 Face Detect SYSCLK4 220 GPIO SYSCLK6 110 GPIO Debounce SYSCLK18 Fixed 0.032768 GPMC SYSCLK6 110 HDMI PLL_VIDEO2 186 HDMI CEC SYSCLK10 Fixed 48 HDMI I2S SYSCLK20 SYSCLK21 AUD_CLK0/1/2 AUX Clock 50 HDVICP2 SYSCLK3 266 HDVPSS PLL_HDVPSS 200 HDVPSS VOUT1 PLL_VIDEO2 HDMI PHY 186 HDVPSS VOUT0 PLL_VIDEO1 PLL_VIDEO2 165 HDVPSS SD VENC PLL_VIDEO0 Fixed 54 HDVPSS HD VENC PLL_VIDEO0 PLL_VIDEO1 HDMI Fixed 148.5 I2C0/1/2/3 SYSCLK10 48 ISS PLL_ MEDIACTL 400 L3 Fast SYSCLK4 220 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 157 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 7-25. Maximum Module Clock Frequencies (continued) 158 MODULE CLOCK SOURCE(S) MAX FREQUENCY OPP100 (MHz) L3 Medium SYSCLK4 220 L3 Slow SYSCLK6 110 L4 Fast SYSCLK4 220 L4 Slow SYSCLK6 110 Mailbox SYSCLK6 110 McASP SYSCLK6 110 McASP0/1 AUX_CLK SYSCLK20 SYSCLK21 192 Media Controller PLL_MEDIACTL 400 MMCSD0/1/2 SYSCLK8 192 OCMC RAM SYSCLK4 220 PCIe SERDES SERDES_CLKx Pins 100 SERDES DEV Clock SERDES_CLKx Pins 20 or 100 SmartReflex DEV Clock 30 SPI0/1/2/3 SYSCLK10 48 Spinlock SYSCLK6 110 Sync Timer SYSCLK18 Fixed 0.032768 TIMER1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8 SYSCLK18 DEV Clock AUX Clock AUD_CLK0/1/2 TCLKIN 30 UART0/1/2 SYSCLK10 48 USB PLL_USB CLKDCO Fixed 960 WDT0 RTCDIVIDER RCOSC32K Fixed 0.032768 Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 7.5 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Interrupts The device has a large number of interrupts to service the needs of its many peripherals and subsystems. The ARM Cortex-A8 and Media Controller are capable of servicing these interrupts. The following sections list the device interrupt mapping and multiplexing schemes. 7.5.1 ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupts The ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) is responsible for prioritizing all service requests from the System peripherals and generating either IRQs or FIQs to the Cortex-A8. The AINTC has the capability to handle up to 128 requests, and the priority of the interrupt inputs are programmable. Table 7-26 lists the interrupt sources for the AINTC. For more details on ARM Cortex-A8 interrupt control, see the Interrupt Controller section of the Chip Level Resources chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Table 7-26. ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) Interrupt Sources Cortex-A8 INTERRUPT NUMBER ACRONYM SOURCE 0 EMUINT Cortex-A8 Emulation 1 COMMTX Cortex-A8 Emulation 2 COMMRX Cortex-A8 Emulation 3 BENCH Cortex-A8 Emulation 4 ELM_IRQ 5 – Reserved 6 – Reserved 7 NMI NMIn Pin 8 – Reserved ELM 9 L3DEBUG L3 Interconnect 10 L3APPINT L3 Interconnect 11 TINT8 12 EDMACOMPINT 13 EDMAMPERR EDMA Memory Protection Error 14 EDMAERRINT EDMA CC Error 15 WDTINT0 16 – 17 USBSSINT 18 USBINT0 USB0 USB1 TIMER8 EDMA CC Completion Watchdog Timer 0 Reserved USB Subsystem 19 USBINT1 20-27 – Reserved 28 SDINT1 MMC/SD1 29 SDINT2 MMC/SD2 30 I2CINT2 I2C2 31 I2CINT3 I2C3 32 GPIOINT2A GPIO2 A 33 GPIOINT2B GPIO2 B 34 USBWAKEUP USB Subsystem Wakeup 35 PCIeWAKEUP PCIe Wakeup 36 DSSINT HDVPSS 37 – Reserved 38 HDMIINT 39 ISS_IRQ_5 HDMI ISS Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 159 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 7-26. ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) Interrupt Sources (continued) 160 Cortex-A8 INTERRUPT NUMBER ACRONYM 40 3PGSWRXTHR0 EMAC Switch RX Threshold 41 3PGSWRXINT0 EMAC Switch Receive 42 3PGSWTXINT0 EMAC Switch Transmit EMAC Switch Miscellaneous SOURCE 43 3PGSWMISC0 44-47 – 48 PCIINT0 PCIe 49 PCIINT1 PCIe 50 PCIINT2 PCIe 51 PCIINT3 PCIe 52-61 – 62 GPIOINT3A GPIO3 63 GPIOINT3B GPIO3 64 SDINT0 MMC/SD0 65 SPIINT0 SPI0 66 - 67 TINT1 TIMER1 68 TINT2 TIMER2 69 TINT3 TIMER3 70 I2CINT0 I2C0 71 I2CINT1 I2C1 72 UARTINT0 UART0 73 UARTINT1 UART1 74 UARTINT2 UART2 75 RTCINT 76 RTCALARMINT 77 MBINT Reserved Reserved Reserved RTC RTC Alarm Mailbox 78 – 79 PLLINT Reserved 80 MCATXINT0 McASP0 Transmit 81 MCARXINT0 McASP0 Receive 82 MCATXINT1 McASP1 Transmit 83 MCARXINT1 McASP1 Receive 84 – Reserved 85 – Reserved 86 – Reserved 87 – Reserved 88 – Reserved 89 – Reserved 90 SMRFLX_HDVICP 91 – 92 TINT4 TIMER4 93 TINT5 TIMER5 94 TINT6 TIMER6 95 TINT7 TIMER7 96 GPIOINT0A GPIO0 97 GPIOINT0B GPIO0 98 GPIOINT1A GPIO1 PLL Recalculation Interrupt SmartReflex HDVICP Domain Reserved Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 7-26. ARM Cortex-A8 Interrupt Controller (AINTC) Interrupt Sources (continued) Cortex-A8 INTERRUPT NUMBER ACRONYM SOURCE 99 GPIOINT1B GPIO1 100 GPMCINT GPMC 101 DDRERR DDR 102 – Reserved 103 HDVICPCONT1SYNC HDVICP2 104 HDVICPCONT2SYNC HDVICP2 105 – Reserved 106 – Reserved 107 IVA0MBOXINT 108 – Reserved 109 – Reserved 110 – Reserved 111 – Reserved 112 TCERRINT0 EDMA TC 0 Error 113 TCERRINT1 EDMA TC 1 Error 114 TCERRINT2 EDMA TC 2 Error EDMA TC 3 Error 115 TCERRINT3 116-119 – 120 SMRFLX_ARM 121 SMRFLX_CORE HDVICP2 Mailbox Reserved SmartReflex ARM Domain SmartReflex CORE Domain 122 – 123 MCMMUINT Reserved 124 DMMINT DMM 125 SPIINT1 SPI1 126 SPIINT2 SPI2 127 SPIINT3 SPI3 Media Controller Power, Reset, Clocking, and Interrupts Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 161 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8 Peripheral Information and Timings 8.1 Parameter Information Tester Pin Electronics 42 Ω 3.5 nH Transmission Line Z0 = 50 Ω (see Note) 4.0 pF 1.85 pF Data Sheet Timing Reference Point Output Under Test Device Pin (see Note) NOTE: The data sheet provides timing at the device pin. For output timing analysis, the tester pin electronics and its transmission line effects must be taken into account. A transmission line with a delay of 2 ns can be used to produce the desired transmission line effect. The transmission line is intended as a load only. It is not necessary to add or subtract the transmission line delay (2 ns) from the data sheet timings. Input requirements in this data sheet are tested with an input slew rate of < 4 Volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns) at the device pin. Figure 8-1. Test Load Circuit for AC Timing Measurements The load capacitance value stated is only for characterization and measurement of AC timing signals. This load capacitance value does not indicate the maximum load the device is capable of driving. 8.1.1 1.8-V and 3.3-V Signal Transition Levels All input and output timing parameters are referenced to Vref for both "0" and "1" logic levels. For 3.3-V I/O, Vref = 1.5 V. For 1.8-V I/O, Vref = 0.9 V. Vref Figure 8-2. Input and Output Voltage Reference Levels for AC Timing Measurements All rise and fall transition timing parameters are referenced to VIL MAX and VIH MIN for input clocks, VOL MAX and VOH MIN for output clocks. Vref = VIH MIN (or VOH MIN) Vref = VIL MAX (or VOL MAX) Figure 8-3. Rise and Fall Transition Time Voltage Reference Levels 8.1.2 3.3-V Signal Transition Rates All timings are tested with an input edge rate of 4 volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns). 162 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.1.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Timing Parameters and Board Routing Analysis The timing parameter values specified in this data manual do not include delays by board routings. As a good board design practice, such delays must always be taken into account. Timing values may be adjusted by increasing/decreasing such delays. TI recommends utilizing the available I/O buffer information specification (IBIS) models to analyze the timing characteristics correctly. If needed, external logic hardware such as buffers may be used to compensate any timing differences. 8.2 Recommended Clock and Control Signal Transition Behavior All clocks and control signals must transition between VIH and VIL (or between VIL and VIH) in a monotonic manner. NOTE For supported OPP frequencies, see Table 7-3, Device Operating Points (OPPs). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 163 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.3 www.ti.com Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) 8.3.1 Overview The device contains four ATL modules that can be used for asynchronous sample rate conversion of audio. The ATL calculates the error between two time bases, such as audio syncs, and optionally generates an averaged clock using cycle stealing via software. For more detailed information on the ATL peripheral, see the Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) chapter of the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.3.2 ATL Peripheral Registers This ATL peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual (TRM). Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.3.3 ATL Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-1. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for ATL_CLKOUTx NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN 1 tc(ATLCLKOUT) Cycle time, ATL_CLKOUTx 20 ns (1) ns ns 2 tw(ATLCLKOUTL) Pulse Duration, ATL_CLKOUTx low 0.45*P - M 3 tw(ATLCLKOUTH) Pulse Duration, ATL_CLKOUTx high 0.45*P - M (1) (1) UNIT MAX P = ATL_CLKOUTx period. M = internal ATL PCLK period. 1 2 ATL_CLKOUTx 3 Figure 8-4. ATL_CLKOUTx Timing 164 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.4 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 EDMA The EDMA controller handles all data transfers between memories and the device slave peripherals on the device. These data transfers include cache servicing, non-cacheable memory accesses, userprogrammed data transfers, and host accesses. 8.4.1 EDMA Channel Synchronization Events The EDMA channel controller supports up to 64 channels which service peripherals and memory. Each EDMA channel is mapped to a default EDMA synchronization event as shown in Table 8-2. In addition, each EDMA channel can alternatively be mapped to one of the 31 multiplexed EDMA synchronization events shown in Table 8-3. The EVT_MUX_x registers in the Control Module are used to select between the default event and the multiplexed events for each channel. For more detailed information on the EDMA module and how EDMA events are enabled, captured, processed, linked, chained, cleared, and more, see the Enhanced Direct Memory Access Controller chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Table 8-2. EDMA Default Synchronization Events EVENT NUMBER DEFAULT EVENT NAME DEFAULT EVENT DESCRIPTION 0-1 – 2 SDTXEVT1 Reserved SD1 Transmit SD1 Receive 3 SDRXEVT1 4-7 – 8 AXEVT0 McASP0 Transmit Reserved 9 AREVT0 McASP0 Receive 10 AXEVT1 McASP1 Transmit 11 AREVT1 McASP1 Receive 12 – Reserved 13 – Reserved 14 – Reserved 15 – Reserved 16 SPI0XEVT0 SPI0 Transmit 0 17 SPI0REVT0 SPI0 Receive 0 18 SPI0XEVT1 SPI0 Transmit 1 19 SPI0REVT1 SPI0 Receive 1 20 SPI0XEVT2 SPI0 Transmit 2 21 SPI0REVT2 SPI0 Receive 2 22 SPI0XEVT3 SPI0 Transmit 3 23 SPI0REVT3 SPI0 Receive 3 24 SDTXEVT0 SD0 Transmit 25 SDRXEVT0 SD0 Receive 26 UTXEVT0 UART0 Transmit 27 URXEVT0 UART0 Receive 28 UTXEVT1 UART1 Transmit 29 URXEVT1 UART1 Receive 30 UTXEVT2 UART2 Transmit 31 URXEVT2 UART2 Receive 32-35 – 36 ISS_DMA_REQ1 ISS Event 1 37 ISS_DMA_REQ2 ISS Event 2 38 ISS_DMA_REQ3 ISS Event 3 Reserved Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 165 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-2. EDMA Default Synchronization Events (continued) EVENT NUMBER DEFAULT EVENT NAME 39 ISS_DMA_REQ4 40 – Reserved 41 – Reserved DEFAULT EVENT DESCRIPTION ISS Event 4 42 SPI1XEVT0 SPI1 Transmit 0 43 SPI1REVT0 SPI1 Receive 0 44 SPI1XEVT1 SPI1 Transmit 1 45 SPI1REVT1 SPI1 Receive 1 46 – Reserved 47 – Reserved 48 TINT4 TIMER4 49 TINT5 TIMER5 50 TINT6 TIMER6 51 TINT7 TIMER7 52 GPMCEVT GPMC 53 HDMIEVT HDMI 54 – Reserved 55 – Reserved 56 – Reserved 57 – Reserved 58 I2CTXEVT0 I2C0 Transmit 59 I2CRXEVT0 I2C0 Receive 60 I2CTXEVT1 I2C1 Transmit 61 I2CRXEVT1 I2C1 Receive 62 – Reserved 63 – Reserved Table 8-3. EDMA Multiplexed Synchronization Events 166 EVT_MUX_x VALUE MULTIPLEXED EVENT NAME 0 - Default Event 1 SDTXEVT2 SD2 Transmit 2 SDRXEVT2 SD2 Receive 3 I2CTXEVT2 I2C2 Transmit 4 I2CRXEVT2 I2C2 Receive 5 I2CTXEVT3 I2C3 Transmit 6 I2CRXEVT3 I2C3 Receive 7 – Reserved 8 – Reserved 9 – Reserved 10 – Reserved 11 – Reserved 12 – Reserved 13 – Reserved 14 – Reserved 15 – Reserved 16 SPI2XEVT0 SPI2 Transmit 0 17 SPI2REVT0 SPI2 Receive 0 MULTIPLEXED EVENT DESCRIPTION Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-3. EDMA Multiplexed Synchronization Events (continued) EVT_MUX_x VALUE 8.4.2 MULTIPLEXED EVENT NAME MULTIPLEXED EVENT DESCRIPTION 18 SPI2XEVT1 SPI2 Transmit 1 19 SPI2REVT1 SPI2 Receive 1 20 SPI3XEVT0 SPI3 Transmit 0 21 SPI3REVT0 SPI3 Receive 0 22 – 23 TINT1 TIMER1 24 TINT2 TIMER2 25 TINT3 TIMER3 26 – Reserved 27 – Reserved 28 EDMAEVT0 EDMA_EVT0 Pin 29 EDMAEVT1 EDMA_EVT1 Pin 30 EDMAEVT2 EDMA_EVT2 Pin 31 EDMAEVT3 EDMA_EVT3 Pin Reserved EDMA Peripheral Register Description The EDMA peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 167 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.5 8.5.1 www.ti.com Emulation Features and Capability Advanced Event Triggering (AET) The device supports Advanced Event Triggering (AET). This capability can be used to debug complex problems as well as understand performance characteristics of user applications. AET provides the following capabilities: • Hardware Program Breakpoints: specify addresses or address ranges that can generate events such as halting the processor or triggering the trace capture. • Data Watchpoints: specify data variable addresses, address ranges, or data values that can generate events such as halting the processor or triggering the trace capture. • Counters: count the occurrence of an event or cycles for performance monitoring. • State Sequencing: allows combinations of hardware program breakpoints and data watchpoints to precisely generate events for complex sequences. For more information on AET, see the following documents: • Using Advanced Event Triggering to Find and Fix Intermittent Real-Time Bugs application report (Literature Number: SPRA753). • Using Advanced Event Triggering to Debug Real-Time Problems in High Speed Embedded Microprocessor Systems application report (Literature Number: SPRA387). 8.5.2 Trace The device supports Trace at the Cortex™-A8 and System levels. Trace is a debug technology that provides a detailed, historical account of application code execution, timing, and data accesses. Trace collects, compresses, and exports debug information for analysis. The debug information can be exported to the Embedded Trace Buffer (ETB), or to the 5-pin Trace Interface (system trace only). Trace works in real-time and does not impact the execution of the system. For more information on board design guidelines for Trace Advanced Emulation, see the Emulation and Trace Headers Technical Reference Manual (Literature Number: SPRU655). 8.5.3 IEEE 1149.1 JTAG The JTAG (IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard-Test-Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture) interface is used for BSDL testing and emulation of the device. The TRST pin only needs to be released when it is necessary to use a JTAG controller to debug the device or exercise the device's boundary scan functionality. For maximum reliability, the device includes an internal pulldown (IPD) on the TRST pin to ensure that TRST is always asserted upon power up and the device's internal emulation logic is always properly initialized. JTAG controllers from Texas Instruments actively drive TRST high. However, some third-party JTAG controllers may not drive TRST high but expect the use of a pullup resistor on TRST. When using this type of JTAG controller, assert TRST to initialize the device after powerup and externally drive TRST high before attempting any emulation or boundary-scan operations. The main JTAG features include: • 32KB embedded trace buffer (ETB) • 5-pin system trace interface for debug • Supports Advanced Event Triggering (AET) • All processors can be emulated via JTAG ports • All functions on EMU pins of the device: – EMU[1:0] - cross-triggering, boot mode (WIR), STM trace – EMU[4:2] - STM trace only (single direction) 168 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.5.3.1 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 JTAG ID (JTAGID) Register Description Table 8-4. JTAG ID Register (1) (1) (2) HEX ADDRESS ACRONYM 0x4814 0600 JTAGID REGISTER NAME JTAG Identification Register (2) IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard-Test-Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture. Read-only. Provides the device 32-bit JTAG ID. The JTAG ID register is a read-only register that identifies to the customer the JTAG/device ID. For this device, the JTAG ID register resides at address location 0x4814 0600. For the actual register bit names and their associated bit field descriptions, see Figure 8-5 and Table 8-5. 31 28 27 12 11 1 0 VARIANT (4bit) PART NUMBER (16-bit) MANUFACTURER (11-bit) LSB R-xxxx R-1011 1001 0110 1011 R-0000 0010 111 R-1 LEGEND: R/W = Read/Write; R = Read only; -n = value after reset Figure 8-5. JTAG ID Register Description - Device Register Value: 0x0B8F 202F Table 8-5. JTAG ID Register Selection Bit Descriptions Bit Field Description 31:28 VARIANT Variant (4-bit) value. Device value: xxxx. This value reflects the device silicon revision [For example, 0x0 (0000) for initial silicon (1.0)]. For more detailed information on the current device silicon revision, see the device-specific Silicon Errata. 27:12 PART NUMBER Part Number (16-bit) value. Device value: 0xB96B (1011 1001 0110 1011) 11:1 MANUFACTURER Manufacturer (11-bit) value. Device value: 0x017 (0000 0010 111) LSB LSB. This bit is read as a ""1 for this device. 0 8.5.3.2 JTAG Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-6. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG (see Figure 8-6) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN UNIT MAX 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 59 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 23.6 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low (40% of tc) 23.6 ns 3 tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high (20% of (tc * 0.5)) 5.9 ns 3 tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high (20% of (tc * 0.5)) 5.9 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 29.5 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 29.5 ns 4 Table 8-7. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG (see Figure 8-6) NO. 2 (1) PARAMETER td(TCKL-TDOV) Delay time, TCK low to TDO valid OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro MIN MAX 0 23.575 (1) UNIT ns (0.5 * tc) - 2 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 169 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 1 1a 1b TCK 2 TDO 3 4 TDI/TMS Figure 8-6. JTAG Timing Table 8-8. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK (see Figure 8-6) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN UNIT MAX 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 59 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 23.6 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low (40% of tc) 23.6 ns 3 tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high (20% of (tc * 0.5)) 5.9 ns 3 tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high (20% of (tc * 0.5)) 5.9 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 29.5 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 29.5 ns 4 Table 8-9. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK (see Figure 8-7) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER UNIT MIN MAX 0 24 5 td(TCK-RTCK) Delay time, TCK to RTCK with no selected subpaths (that is, ICEPick is the only tap selected - when the ARM is in the scan chain, the delay time is a function of the ARM functional clock.) 6 tc(RTCK) Cycle time, RTCK 59 ns 7 tw(RTCKH) Pulse duration, RTCK high (40% of tc) 23.6 ns 8 tw(RTCKL) Pulse duration, RTCK low (40% of tc) 23.6 ns ns 5 TCK 6 7 8 RTCK Figure 8-7. JTAG With RTCK Timing 170 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-10. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for STM Trace (see Figure 8-8) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN 1 2 3 (1) UNIT MAX tw(EMUH50) Pulse duration, EMUx high detected at 50% VOH with 60/40 duty cycle 4 (1) ns tw(EMUH90) Pulse duration, EMUx high detected at 90% VOH 3.5 ns tw(EMUL50) Pulse duration, EMUx low detected at 50% VOH with 60/40 duty cycle 4 (1) ns tw(EMUL10) Pulse duration, EMUx low detected at 10% VOH 3.5 ns tsko(EMU) Output skew time, time delay difference between EMUx pins configured as trace. tskp(EMU) Pulse skew, magnitude of difference between high-to-low (tPHL) and low-to-high (tPLH) propagation delays tsldp_o(EMU) Output slew rate EMUx -0.5 0.5 ns 0.6 (1) ns 3.3 V/ns This parameter applies to the maximum trace export frequency operating in a 40/60 duty cycle. Buffer Inputs A Buffers EMUx Pins B tPLH tPHL 1 2 B A 3 C C Figure 8-8. STM Trace Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 171 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.6 www.ti.com Ethernet MAC Switch (EMAC SW) The EMAC SW controls the flow of packet data between the device and two external Ethernet PHYs, with hardware flow control and quality-of-service (QOS) support. The EMAC SW contains a 3-port gigabit switch, where one port is internally connected and the other two ports are brought out externally. Each of the external EMAC ports supports 10Base-T (10 Mbits/second [Mbps]), and 100BaseTX (100 Mbps), in either half- or full-duplex mode, and 1000BaseT (1000 Mbps) in full-duplex mode. The EMAC SW controls the flow of packet data from the device to the external PHYs. The EMAC0/1 ports on the device support four interface modes: Media Independent Interface (MII), Gigabit Media Independent Interface (GMII), Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII) and Reduced Gigabit Media Independent Interface (RGMII). In addition, a single MDIO interface is pinned out to control the PHY configuration and status monitoring. Multiple external PHYs can be controlled by the MDIO interface. The EMAC SW module conforms to the IEEE 802.3-2002 standard, describing the “Carrier Sense Multiple Access with Collision Detection (CSMA/CD) Access Method and Physical Layer” specifications. The IEEE 802.3 standard has also been adopted by ISO/IEC and re-designated as ISO/IEC 8802-3:2000(E). Deviating from this standard, the EMAC SW module does not use the Transmit Coding Error signal MTXER. Instead of driving the error pin when an underflow condition occurs on a transmitted frame, the EMAC SW will intentionally generate an incorrect checksum by inverting the frame CRC, so that the transmitted frame will be detected as an error by the network. In addition, the EMAC SW I/Os operate at 3.3 V and are not compatible with 2.5-V I/O signaling. Therefore, only Ethernet PHYs with 3.3-V I/O interface should be used. In networking systems, packet transmission and reception are critical tasks. The communications port programming interface (CPPI) protocol maximizes the efficiency of interaction between the host software and communications modules. The CPPI block contains 2048 words of 32-bit buffer descriptor memory that holds up to 512 buffer descriptors. Ethernet port mirroring is not supported internally on this device. This function is supported by using an external Ethernet repeater. For more detailed information on the EMAC SW module, see the 3PSW Ethernet Subsystem chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.6.1 EMAC Peripheral Register Descriptions The EMAC peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 172 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.6.2 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 EMAC Electrical Data/Timing 8.6.2.1 EMAC MII and GMII Electrical Data/Timing GMII mode is not supported for OPP50. Table 8-11. Timing Requirements for EMAC[x]_MRCLK - [G]MII Operation (see Figure 8-9) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro 1000 Mbps (1 Gbps) (GMII Only) NO. MIN 1 tc(MRCLK) Cycle time, EMAC[x]_MRCLK 2 MAX 100 Mbps MIN 10 Mbps MAX MIN UNIT MAX 8 40 400 ns tw(MRCLKH) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_MRCLK high 2.8 14 140 ns 3 tw(MRCLKL) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_MRCLK low 2.8 14 140 ns 4 tt(MRCLK) Transition time, EMAC[x]_MRCLK 1 3 3 ns 4 1 3 2 EMAC[x]_MRCLK 4 Figure 8-9. EMAC[x]_MRCLK Timing (EMAC Receive) - [G]MII Operation Table 8-12. Timing Requirements for EMAC[x]_MTCLK - [G]MII Operation (see Figure 8-14) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro 1000 Mbps (1 Gbps) (GMII Only) NO. MIN 1 MAX 100 Mbps MIN 10 Mbps MAX MIN UNIT MAX tc(MTCLK) Cycle time, EMAC[x]_MTCLK 8 40 400 ns 2 tw(MTCLKH) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_MTCLK high 2.8 14 140 ns 3 tw(MTCLKL) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_MTCLK low 2.8 14 140 ns 4 tt(MTCLK) Transition time, EMAC[x]_MTCLK 1 3 3 4 1 2 ns 3 EMAC[x]_MTCLK 4 Figure 8-10. EMAC[x]_MTCLK Timing (EMAC Transmit) - [G]MII Operation Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 173 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-13. Timing Requirements for EMAC [G]MII Receive 10/100/1000 Mbit/s (see Figure 8-11) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro 1000 Mbps (1 Gbps) NO. MIN 100/10 Mbps MAX MIN UNIT MAX tsu(MRXD-MRCLK) 1 tsu(MRXDV-MRCLK) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before EMAC[1:0]_MRCLK 3.14 8 ns Hold time, receive selected signals valid after EMAC[1:0]_MRCLK 1.09 8 ns tsu(MRXER-MRCLK) th(MRCLK-MRXD) 2 th(MRCLK-MRXDV) th(MRCLK-MRXER) 1 2 EMAC[x]_MRCLK (Input) EMAC[x]_MRXD3−EMAC[x]_MRXD0, EMAC[x]_MRXDV, EMAC[x]_MRXER (Inputs) Figure 8-11. EMAC Receive Interface Timing [G]MII Operation Table 8-14. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for EMAC [G]MII Transmit 10/100 Mbits/s (see Figure 8-12) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. 1 PARAMETER td(MTXCLK-MTXD) td(MTCLK-MTXEN) UNIT 100/10 Mbps MIN MAX 0 25 Delay time, EMAC[x]_MTCLK to transmit selected signals valid ns Table 8-15. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for EMAC [G]MII Transmit 1000 Mbits/s (see Figure 8-12) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. 1 PARAMETER td(GMTCLK-MTXD) Delay time, EMAC[x]_GMTCLK to transmit selected signals valid td(GMTCLK-MTXEN) UNIT 1000 Mbps (1 Gbps) MIN MAX 0.5 5 ns 1 EMAC[x]_MTCLK (Input) EMAC[x]_MTXD3−EMAC[x]_MTXD0, EMAC[x]_MTXEN (Outputs) Figure 8-12. EMAC Transmit Interface Timing [G]MII Operation 174 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.6.2.2 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 EMAC RMII Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-16. Timing Requirements for EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK - RMII Operation (see Figure 8-13) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(RMREFCLK) Cycle time, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK 19.999 20.001 ns 2 tw(RMREFCLKH) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK high 7 13 ns 3 tw(RMREFCLKL) Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK low 7 13 ns 4 tt(RMREFCLK) Transition time, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK 3 ns 1 2 4 RMREFCLK (Input) 3 4 Figure 8-13. RMREFCLK Timing RMII Operation Table 8-17. Timing Requirements for EMAC RMII Receive (see Figure 8-13) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN UNIT MAX tsu(RMRXD-RMREFCLK) 1 tsu(RMCRSDV-RMREFCLK) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK 4 ns Hold time, receive selected signals valid after EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK 2 ns tsu(RMRXER-RMREFCLK) th(RMREFCLK-RMRXD) 2 th(RMREFCLK-RMCRSDV) th(RMREFCLK-RMRXER) 1 2 RMREFCLK RMRXD1−RMRXD0, RMCRSDV, RMRXER (inputs) Figure 8-14. EMAC Receive Interface Timing RMII Operation Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 175 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-18. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for EMAC RMII Transmit 10/100 Mbits/s (see Figure 8-15) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER UNIT MIN MAX 1 td(RMREFCLK-RMTXD) Delay time, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK high to EMAC[x]_RMTXD[x] valid 2.4 13 2 tdd(RMREFCLK-RMTXEN) Delay time, EMAC[x]_RMREFCLK high to EMAC[x]_RMTXEN valid 2.4 13 ns 1 RMREFCLK RMTXD1−RMTXD0, RMTXEN (Outputs) Figure 8-15. EMAC Transmit Interface Timing RMII Operation 8.6.2.3 EMAC RGMII Electrical Data/Timing RGMII mode is not supported for OPP50. Table 8-19. Timing Requirements for EMAC[x]_RGRXC - RGMII Operation (see Figure 8-16) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro NO. 1 2 3 4 176 tc(RGRXC) tw(RGRXCH) tw(RGRXCL) tt(RGRXC) Cycle time, EMAC[x]_RGRXC Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RGRXC high Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RGRXC low Transition time, EMAC[x]_RGRXC MIN MAX 10 Mbps 360 440 100 Mbps 36 44 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 10 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGRXC) 0.60*tc(RGRXC) 100 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGRXC) 0.60*tc(RGRXC) 1000 Mbps 0.45*tc(RGRXC) 0.55*tc(RGRXC) 10 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGRXC) 0.60*tc(RGRXC) 100 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGRXC) 0.60*tc(RGRXC) 1000 Mbps 0.45*tc(RGRXC) 0.55*tc(RGRXC) 10 Mbps 0.75 100 Mbps 0.75 1000 Mbps 0.75 Peripheral Information and Timings UNIT ns ns ns ns Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-20. Timing Requirements for EMAC RGMII Input Receive for 10/100/1000 Mbps (1) (see Figure 8-16) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN tsu(RGRXD- 5 RGRXCH) th(RGRXCH- 6 RGRXD) (1) UNIT MAX Setup time, receive selected signals valid before EMAC[x]_RGRXC (at device) high/low Internal delay enabled 1.0 ns Hold time, receive selected signals valid after EMAC[x]_RGRXC (at device) high/low Internal delay enabled 1.0 ns For RGMII, receive selected signals include: EMAC[x]_RGRXD[3:0] and EMAC[x]_RGRXCTL. 1 4 2 4 3 EMAC[x]_RGRXC (A) (at device) 5 1st Half-byte 6 2nd Half-byte EMAC[x]_RGRXD[3:0] EMAC[x]_RGRXCTL A. B. (B) (B) RGRXD[3:0] RGRXD[7:4] RXDV RXERR EMAC[x]_RGRXC must be externally delayed relative to the data and control pins. The internal delay can be enabled or disabled via the EMAC RGMIIn_ID_MODE register. Data and control information is received using both edges of the clocks. EMAC[x]_RGRXD[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of EMAC[x]_RGRXC and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge of EMAC[x]_RGRXC. Similarly, EMAC[x]_RGRXCTL carries RXDV on rising edge of EMAC[x]_RGRXC and RXERR on falling edge of EMAC[x]_RGRXC. Figure 8-16. EMAC Receive Interface Timing [RGMII Operation] Table 8-21. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for RGTXC - RGMII Operation for 10/100/1000 Mbit/s (see Figure 8-17) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN 10 Mbps 1 2 3 4 tc(RGTXC) tw(RGTXCH) tw(RGTXCL) tt(RGTXC) Cycle time, EMAC[x]_RGTXC Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RGTXC high Pulse duration, EMAC[x]_RGTXC low Transition time, EMAC[x]_RGTXC UNIT MAX 360 440 100 Mbps 36 44 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 10 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGTXC) 0.60*tc(RGTXC) 100 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGTXC) 0.60*tc(RGTXC) 1000 Mbps 0.45*tc(RGTXC) 0.55*tc(RGTXC) 10 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGTXC) 0.60*tc(RGTXC) 100 Mbps 0.40*tc(RGTXC) 0.60*tc(RGTXC) 1000 Mbps 0.45*tc(RGTXC) 0.55*tc(RGTXC) 10 Mbps 0.75 100 Mbps 0.75 1000 Mbps 0.75 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 ns ns ns ns 177 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-22. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for EMAC RGMII Transmit (1) (see Figure 8-17) NO. OPP100/OPP120 / Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN tsu(RGTXD- 5 RGTXCH) th(RGTXCH- 6 RGTXD) (1) UNIT MAX Setup time, transmit selected signals valid before EMAC[x]_RGTXC (at device) high/low Internal delay enabled 1.2 ns Hold time, transmit selected signals valid after EMAC[x]_RGTXC (at device) high/low Internal delay enabled 1.2 ns For RGMII, transmit selected signals include: EMAC[x]_RGTXD[3:0] and EMAC[x]_RGTXCTL. RGTXC at device pins 1 2 EMQAC[x]_RGTXC (A) (at device) Internal RGTXC 3 4 4 1 5 (B) 1st Half-byte (B) TXEN EMAC[x]_RGTXD[3:0] 2nd Half-byte 6 2 EMAC[x]_RGTXCTL A. B. TXERR RGTXC is delayed internally before being driven to the EMAC[x]_RGTXC pin. The internal delay can be enabled or disabled via the EMAC RGMIIn_ID_MODE register. Data and control information is transmitted using both edges of the clocks. EMAC[x]_RGTXD[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of EMAC[x]_RGTXC and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge of EMAC[x]_RGTXC. Similarly, EMAC[x]_RGTXCTL carries TXEN on rising edge of EMAC[x]_RGTXC and TXERR of falling edge of EMAC[x]_RGTXC. Figure 8-17. EMAC Transmit Interface Timing [RGMII Operation] 178 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.6.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) The Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) module continuously polls all 32 MDIO addresses in order to enumerate all PHY devices in the system. The MDIO module implements the 802.3 serial management interface to interrogate and control Ethernet PHYs using a shared two-wire bus. Host software uses the MDIO module to configure the autonegotiation parameters of each PHY attached to the EMAC SW, retrieve the negotiation results, and configure required parameters in the EMAC SW module for correct operation. The module is designed to allow almost transparent operation of the MDIO interface, with very little maintenance from the core processor. A single MDIO interface is pinned out to control the PHY configuration and status monitoring. Multiple external PHYs can be controlled by the MDIO interface. For more detailed information on the MDIO peripheral, see the 3PSW Ethernet Subsystem chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.6.3.1 MDIO Peripheral Register Descriptions The MDIO peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.6.3.2 MDIO Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-23. Timing Requirements for MDIO Input (see Figure 8-18) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN 1 UNIT MAX tc(MDCLK) Cycle time, MDCLK 400 ns tw(MDCLK) Pulse duration, MDCLK high or low 180 ns 4 tsu(MDIO-MDCLKH) Setup time, MDIO data input valid before MDCLK high 15 ns 5 th(MDCLKH-MDIO) Hold time, MDIO data input valid after MDCLK high 10 ns 1 MDCLK 4 5 MDIO (input) Figure 8-18. MDIO Input Timing Table 8-24. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for MDIO Output (see Figure 8-19) NO. PARAMETER OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro MIN 7 td(MDCLKL-MDIO) Delay time, MDCLK low to MDIO data output valid UNIT MAX 100 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 ns 179 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 1 MDCLK 7 MDIO (output) Figure 8-19. MDIO Output Timing 180 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.7 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 General-Purpose Input/Output (GPIO) The GPIO peripheral provides general-purpose pins that can be configured as either inputs When configured as an output, a write to an internal register controls the state driven on the When configured as an input, the state of the input is detectable by reading the state of register. In addition, the GPIO peripheral can produce CPU interrupts in different interrupt modes. The GPIO peripheral provides generic connections to external devices. or outputs. output pin. an internal generation The device contains four GPIO modules and each GPIO module consists of up to 32 identical channels. The device GPIO peripheral supports the following: • Up to 125 1.8-V/3.3-V GPIO pins, GP0[0:28], GP1[0:31], GP2[0:31], and GP3[0:31] (the exact number available varies as a function of the device configuration). Each channel can be configured to be used in the following applications: – Data input/output – Keyboard interface with a de-bouncing cell – Synchronous interrupt generation (in active mode) upon the detection of external events (signal transitions and/or signal levels). • Synchronous interrupt requests from each channel are processed by four identical interrupt generation sub-modules to be used independently by the ARM or Media Controller. Interrupts can be triggered by rising and/or falling edge, specified for each interrupt-capable GPIO signal. • Shared registers can be accessed through "Set & Clear" protocol. Software writes 1 to corresponding bit positions to set or to clear GPIO signals. This allows multiple software processes to toggle GPIO output signals without critical section protection (disable interrupts, program GPIO, re-enable interrupts, to prevent context switching to another process during GPIO programming). • Separate input/output registers. • Output register in addition to set/clear so that, if preferred by software, some GPIO output signals can be toggled by direct write to the output registers. • Output register, when read, reflects output drive status. This, in addition to the input register reflecting pin status and open-drain I/O cell, allows wired logic to be implemented. For more detailed information on GPIOs, see the General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Interface chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.7.1 GPIO Peripheral Register Descriptions The GPIO peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 181 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.7.2 www.ti.com GPIO Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-25. Timing Requirements for GPIO Inputs (see Figure 8-20) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN 1 tw(GPIH) 2 (1) tw(GPIL) Pulse duration, GPx[31:0] input high Pulse duration, GPx[31:0] input low UNIT MAX 12P (1) ns (1) ns 12P P = Module clock. Table 8-26. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPIO Outputs (see Figure 8-20) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN UNIT MAX 3 tw(GPOH) Pulse duration, GPx[31:0] output high 36P-8 (1) ns 4 tw(GPOL) Pulse duration, GPx[31:0] output low 36P-8 (1) ns (1) P = Module clock. 2 GPx[31:0] input 1 4 GPx[31:0] output 3 Figure 8-20. GPIO Port Timing 182 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.8 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) and Error Location Module (ELM) The GPMC is a device memory controller used to provide a glueless interface to external memory devices such as NOR Flash, NAND Flash (with BCH and Hamming Error Code Detection for 8-bit or 16-bit NAND Flash), SRAM, and Pseudo-SRAM. It includes flexible asynchronous protocol control for interface to SRAM-like memories and custom logic (FPGA, CPLD, ASICs, etc.). Other supported features include: • 8-/16-bit wide multiplexed address/data bus • 512 MBytes maximum addressing capability divided among up to eight chip selects • Non-multiplexed address/data mode • Pre-fetch and write posting engine associated with system DMA to get full performance from NAND device with minimum impact on NOR/SRAM concurrent access. The device also contains an Error Locator Module (ELM) which is used to extract error addresses from syndrome polynomials generated using a BCH algorithm. Each of these polynomials gives a status of the read operations for a 512 bytes block from a NAND flash and its associated BCH parity bits, plus optionally spare area information. The ELM has the following features: • 4-bit, 8-bit and 16-bit per 512byte block error location based on BCH algorithms • Eight simultaneous processing contexts • Page-based and continuous modes • Interrupt generation on error location process completion – When the full page has been processed in page mode – For each syndrome polynomial in continuous mode 8.8.1 GPMC and ELM Peripherals Register Descriptions The GPMC and ELM peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 183 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.8.2 www.ti.com GPMC Electrical Data/Timing 8.8.2.1 GPMC and NOR Flash Interface Synchronous Mode Timing (Non-Multiplexed and Multiplexed Modes) Table 8-27. Timing Requirements for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Synchronous Mode (see Figure 8-21, Figure 8-22, Figure 8-23 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-24, Figure 8-25, Figure 8-26 for Multiplexed Modes) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o NO. MIN UNIT MAX 13 tsu(DV-CLKH) Setup time, read GPMC_D[15:0] valid before GPMC_CLK high 3.2 ns 14 th(CLKH-DV) Hold time, read GPMC_D[15:0] valid after GPMC_CLK high 2.5 ns 22 tsu(WAITV-CLKH) Setup time, GPMC_WAIT[x] valid before GPMC_CLK high 3.2 ns 23 th(CLKH-WAITV) Hold time, GPMC_WAIT[x] valid after GPMC_CLK high 2.5 ns Table 8-28. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Synchronous Mode (see Figure 8-21, Figure 8-22, Figure 8-23 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-24, Figure 8-25, Figure 8-26 for Multiplexed Modes) NO. OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro PARAMETER MIN 1 2 3 16 (1) tc(CLK) Cycle time, output clock GPMC_CLK period tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, output clock GPMC_CLK high 0.5P (2) tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, output clock GPMC_CLK low 0.5P (2) td(CLKH-nCSV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_CS[x] transition UNIT MAX ns ns F - 2.2 (3) F + 4.5 (3) ns (4) (4) ns B + 2.3 (5) ns 4 td(CLKH-nCSIV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_CS[x] invalid E - 2.2 5 td(ADDV-CLK) Delay time, GPMC_A[27:0] address bus valid to GPMC_CLK first edge B - 4.5 (5) 6 td(CLKH-ADDIV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_A[27:0] GPMC address bus invalid -2.3 7 td(nBEV-CLK) Delay time, GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 valid to GPMC_CLK first edge B - 1.9 (5) B + 2.3 (5) ns (6) D + 1.9 (6) ns 8 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) 184 td(CLKH-nBEIV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 invalid D - 2.3 E + 4.5 ns Sync mode = 62.5 MHz; Async mode = 125 MHz. P = GPMC_CLK period. For nCS falling edge (CS activated): • For GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • For GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are even) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • For GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For single read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: E = (CSWrOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK B = ClkActivationTime * GPMC_FCLK For single read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: D = (WrCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-28. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Synchronous Mode (continued) (see Figure 8-21, Figure 8-22, Figure 8-23 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-24, Figure 8-25, Figure 8-26 for Multiplexed Modes) NO. 9 PARAMETER td(CLKH-nADV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_ADV_ALE transition OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro UNIT MIN MAX G - 2.3 (7) G + 4.5 (7) ns (6) D + 4.5 (6) ns 10 td(CLKH-nADVIV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_ADV_ALE invalid D - 2.3 11 td(CLKH-nOE) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_OE_RE transition H - 2.3 (8) H + 3.5 (8) ns (4) (4) ns 12 (7) (8) td(CLKH-nOEIV) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_OE_RE invalid E - 2.3 E + 3.5 For ADV falling edge (ADV activated): • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Reading mode: • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV deactivated) in Writing mode: • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For OE falling edge (OE activated) / IO DIR rising edge (IN direction) : • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are even) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For OE rising edge (OE deactivated): • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are even) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 185 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-28. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Synchronous Mode (continued) (see Figure 8-21, Figure 8-22, Figure 8-23 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-24, Figure 8-25, Figure 8-26 for Multiplexed Modes) NO. 15 16 OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro PARAMETER td(CLKH-nWE) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_WE transition UNIT MIN MAX I - 2.3 (9) I + 4.5 (9) ns (10) J + 1.9 (10) ns J + 1.9 (10) ns td(CLKH-Data) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_D[15:0] data bus transition J - 2.3 18 td(CLKH-nBE) Delay time, GPMC_CLK rising edge to GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 transition J - 2.3 (10) 19 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, GPMC_CS[x] low A (11) ns 20 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 low C (12) ns 21 tw(nADVV) Pulse duration, GPMC_ADV_ALE low K (13) ns (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) 186 For WE falling edge (WE activated): • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are even) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For WE rising edge (WE deactivated): • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are even) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise • Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) J = GPMC_FCLK period. For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period [n = page burst access number] For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period [n = page burst access number] For single read: C = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: C = (RdCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK [n = page burst access number] For Burst write: C = (WrCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK [n = page burst access number] For read: K = (ADVRdOffTime - ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For write: K = (ADVWrOffTime - ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2 1 2 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:0] Address 7 8 20 GPMC_BE1 7 8 20 GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 11 12 GPMC_OE 14 13 GPMC_D[15:0] D0 23 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-21. GPMC Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) 2 1 2 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:0] Address 8 7 20 Valid GPMC_BE1 8 7 20 Valid GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 11 12 GPMC_OE 14 13 13 13 13 GPMC_D[15:0] (Non-Multplexed Mode) D0 23 D1 D2 D3 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-22. GPMC Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - 14x16-bit Synchronous Burst Read (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 187 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 2 1 2 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:0] Address 7 18 18 18 GPMC_BE1 18 7 18 18 GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 15 15 GPMC_WE GPMC_D[15:0] (Non-Multiplexed Mode) 16 16 16 D1 D0 23 16 D2 D3 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-23. GPMC Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) 2 2 1 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:16] Address 7 8 20 GPMC_BE1 7 8 20 GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 11 12 GPMC_OE 5 GPMC_D[15:0] (Multiplexed Mode) 6 Address (LSB) 23 13 14 D0 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-24. GPMC Multiplexed NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) 188 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2 1 2 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:16] Address (MSB) 8 7 20 Valid GPMC_BE1 8 7 20 Valid GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 11 12 GPMC_OE 14 13 5 GPMC_D[15:0] (Multplexed Mode) 13 13 13 6 Address (LSB) D0 23 D1 D2 D3 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-25. GPMC Multiplexed NOR Flash - 14x16-bit Synchronous Burst Read (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) 2 1 2 GPMC_CLK 3 4 19 GPMC_CS[x] 5 GPMC_A[27:16] 6 Address (MSB) 7 18 18 18 GPMC_BE1 18 7 18 18 GPMC_BE0_CLE 9 9 10 21 GPMC_ADV_ALE 15 15 GPMC_WE GPMC_D[15:0] (Multiplexed Mode) 16 6,16 5 Address (LSB) 16 D0 23 D1 16 D2 D3 22 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-26. GPMC Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write (GPMCFCLKDIVIDER = 0) 8.8.2.2 GPMC and NOR Flash Interface Asynchronous Mode Timing (Non-Multiplexed and Multiplexed Modes) Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 189 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-29. Timing Requirements for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Asynchronous Mode (see Figure 8-27, Figure 8-28 for Non-Multiplexed Mode ) (see Figure 8-29, Figure 8-31 for Multiplexed Mode) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o NO. MIN 6 H (1) cycles (2) cycles H (1) cycles tacc(DAT) Data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) 21 tacc1-pgmode(DAT) Page mode successive data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) P 22 tacc2-pgmode(DAT) Page mode first data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) (1) (2) UNIT MAX H = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) P = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1). Table 8-30. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Asynchronous Mode (see Figure 8-27, Figure 8-28, Figure 8-29, Figure 8-30 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-31, Figure 8-32 for Multiplexed Modes) NO . OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro PARAMETER MIN UNIT MAX 1 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 valid time N (1) ns 2 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, GPMC_CS[x] low A (2) ns 4 td(nCSV-nADVIV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_NADV_ALE invalid B - 0.2 (3) B + 2.0 (3) ns (4) (4) ns 5 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_OE_RE invalid (single read) C - 0.2 10 td(AV-nCSV) Delay time, GPMC_A[27:0] address bus valid to GPMC_CS[x] valid J - 0.2 (5) J + 2.0 (5) ns 11 td(nBEV-nCSV) Delay time, GPMC_BE0_CLE, GPMC_BE1 valid to GPMC_CS[x] valid J - 0.2 (5) J + 2.0 (5) ns (6) (6) ns L + 2.0 (7) ns 13 td(nCSV-nADVV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_ADV_ALE valid K - 0.2 14 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_OE_RE valid L - 0.2 (7) 17 tw(AIV) Pulse duration, GPMC_A[27:0] address bus invalid between 2 successive R/W accesses 19 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_OE_RE invalid (burst read) 21 tw(AV) Pulse duration, GPMC_A[27:0] address bus valid: second, third and fourth accesses 26 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_WE valid C + 2.0 K + 2.0 G (8) I - 0.2 (9) D ns I + 2.0 (9) (10) E - 0.2 (11) ns ns E + 2.0 (11) ns (1) For single read: N = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: N = WrCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: N = (RdCycleTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: N = (WrCycleTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (2) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (3) = B - nCS Max Delay + nADV Min Delay For reading: B = ((ADVRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK For writing: B = ((ADVWrOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) = C - nCS Max Delay + nOE Min Delay C = ((OEOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (5) = J - Address Max Delay + nCS Min Delay J = (CSOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK (6) = K - nCS Max Delay + nADV Min Delay K = ((ADVOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (7) = L - nCS Max Delay + nOE Min Delay L = ((OEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (8) G = Cycle2CycleDelay * GPMC_FCLK (9) = I - nCS Max Delay + nOE Min Delay I = ((OEOffTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) D = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (11) = E - nCS Max Delay + nWE Min Delay E = ((WEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK 190 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-30. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC and NOR Flash Interface - Asynchronous Mode (continued) (see Figure 8-27, Figure 8-28, Figure 8-29, Figure 8-30 for Non-Multiplexed Modes) (see Figure 8-31, Figure 8-32 for Multiplexed Modes) NO . OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro PARAMETER UNIT MIN MAX F - 0.2 (12) F + 2.0 (12) ns 2.0 ns J + 2.0 (5) ns 28 td(nCSV-nWEIV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[x] valid to GPMC_WE invalid 29 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, GPMC_WE valid to GPMC_D[15:0] data bus valid 30 td(DV-nCSV) Delay time, GPMC_D[15:0] data bus valid to GPMC_CS[x] valid 37 td(ADVV-AIV) Delay time, GPMC_ADV_ALE valid to GPMC_D[15:0] address invalid 2.0 ns 38 td(nOEV-AIV) Delay time, GPMC_OE_RE valid to GPMC_D[15:0] address/data busses phase end 2.0 ns 39 td(AIV-ADVV) Delay time, GPMC_D[15:0] address valid to GPMC_ADV_ALE invalid 2.0 ns J - 0.2 (5) (12) = F - nCS Max Delay + nWE Min Delay F = ((WEOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 6 2 GPMC_CS[x] 10 GPMC_A[10:1] Valid Address 11 1 GPMC_BE1 11 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 4 13 GPMC_ADV_ALE 5 14 GPMC_OE GPMC_D[15:0] Data In 0 Data In 0 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-27. GPMC/Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 191 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 6 6 2 2 GPMC_CS[x] 17 10 10 GPMC_A[10:1] Address 1 Address 2 11 11 1 1 GPMC_BE1 11 11 1 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 4 4 13 13 GPMC_ADV_ALE 5 5 14 14 GPMC_OE GPMC_D[15:0] Data Upper GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-28. GPMC/Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - 32-Bit Access Timing GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 22 21 21 21 2 GPMC_CS[x] 10 GPMC_A[10:1] Add0 Add1 Add2 Add3 D0 D1 D2 Add4 11 1 GPMC_BE1 11 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 13 GPMC_ADV_ALE 19 14 GPMC_OE GPMC_D[15:0] D3 D3 GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-29. GPMC/Non-Multiplexed Only NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Page Mode 4x16-Bit Timing 192 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 2 GPMC_CS[x] 10 GPMC_A[10:1] Valid Address 11 1 GPMC_BE1 11 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 4 13 GPMC_ADV_ALE 28 26 GPMC_WE 30 GPMC_D[15:0] Data OUT GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-30. GPMC/Non-Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 2 6 GPMC_CS[x] 10 Address (MSB) GPMC_A[26:17] 11 1 GPMC_BE1 11 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 13 4 GPMC_ADV_ALE 5 14 GPMC_OE GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] 38 30 Address (LSB) Data IN Data IN GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-31. GPMC/Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 193 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK GPMC_CLK 2 GPMC_CS[x] 10 Address (MSB) GPMC_A[26:17] 11 1 GPMC_BE1 11 1 GPMC_BE0_CLE 13 4 GPMC_ADV_ALE 28 26 GPMC_WE 30 GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] 29 Valid Address (LSB) Data OUT GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-32. GPMC/Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing 194 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com 8.8.2.3 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 GPMC/NAND Flash and ELM Interface Timing Table 8-31. Timing Requirements for GPMC/NAND Flash Interface (see Figure 8-35) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o NO. MIN 13 (1) tacc(DAT) J (1) Data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) UNIT MAX cycles J = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) Table 8-32. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GPMC/NAND Flash Interface (see Figure 8-33, Figure 8-34, Figure 8-35, Figure 8-36) NO. PARAMETER OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o MIN 1 tw(nWEV) Pulse duration, GPMC_WE valid time (2) UNIT MAX A (1) ns (2) ns 2 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[X] valid to GPMC_WE valid B - 0.2 3 td(CLEH-nWEV) Delay time, GPMC_BE0_CLE high to GPMC_WE valid C - 0.2 (3) C + 2.0 (3) B + 2.0 ns 4 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, GPMC_D[15:0] valid to GPMC_WE valid D - 0.2 (4) D + 2.0 (4) ns 5 td(nWEIV-DIV) Delay time, GPMC_WE invalid to GPMC_AD[15:0] invalid E - 0.2 (5) E + 2.0 (5) ns (6) (6) ns 6 td(nWEIV-CLEIV) Delay time, GPMC_WE invalid to GPMC_BE0_CLE invalid F - 0.2 7 td(nWEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, GPMC_WE invalid to GPMC_CS[X] invalid G - 0.2 (7) G + 2.0 (7) ns 8 td(ALEH-nWEV) Delay time, GPMC_ADV_ALE High to GPMC_WE valid C - 0.2 (3) C + 2.0 (3) ns (6) (6) ns H (8) ns I + 2.0 (9) ns (10) ns 9 td(nWEIV-ALEIV) Delay time, GPMC_WE invalid to GPMC_ADV_ALE invalid 10 tc(nWE) Cycle time, write cycle time 11 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, GPMC_CS[X] valid to GPMC_OE_RE valid F - 0.2 I - 0.2 (9) F + 2.0 F + 2.0 12 tw(nOEV) Pulse duration, GPMC_OE_RE valid time K 13 tc(nOE) Cycle time, read cycle time L (11) ns 14 td(nOEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, GPMC_OE_RE invalid to GPMC_CS[X] invalid M + 2.0 (12) ns M - 0.2 (12) (1) (2) A = (WEOffTime - WEOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK = B + nWE Min Delay - nCS Max Delay B = ((WEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (3) = C + nWE Min Delay - CLE Max Delay C = ((WEOnTime - ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - ADVExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) = D + nWE Min Delay - Data Max Delay D = (WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (5) =E + Data Min Delay - nWE Max Delay E = ((WrCycleTime - WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) - 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (6) = F + CLE Min Delay - nWE Max Delay F = ((ADVWrOffTime - WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - WEExtraDelay )) * GPMC_FCLK (7) =G + nCS Min Delay - nWE Max Delay G = ((CSWrOffTime - WEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay - WEExtraDelay )) * GPMC_FCLK (8) H = WrCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (9) = I + nOE Min Delay - nCS Max Delay I = ((OEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) K = (OEOffTime - OEOnTime) * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (11) L = RdCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (12) =M + nCS Min Delay - nOE Max Delay M = ((CSRdOffTime - OEOffTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay - OEExtraDelay ))* GPMC_FCLK Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 195 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK 2 7 GPMC_CS[x] 3 6 GPMC_BE0_CLE GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC_OE 1 GPMC_WE 5 4 GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] Command Figure 8-33. GPMC/NAND Flash - Command Latch Cycle Timing GPMC_FCLK 2 7 GPMC_CS[x] GPMC_BE0_CLE 8 9 GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC_OE 10 1 GPMC_WE 5 4 GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] Address Figure 8-34. GPMC/NAND Flash - Address Latch Cycle Timing 196 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 GPMC_FCLK 13 16 11 GPMC_CS[x] GPMC_BE0_CLE GPMC_ADV_ALE 15 14 GPMC_OE GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] Data GPMC_WAIT[x] Figure 8-35. GPMC/NAND Flash - Data Read Cycle Timing GPMC_FCLK 2 7 GPMC_CS[x] GPMC_BE0_CLE GPMC_ADV_ALE GPMC_OE 10 1 GPMC_WE 5 4 GPMC_A[16:1] GPMC_D[15:0] Data Figure 8-36. GPMC/NAND Flash - Data Write Cycle Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 197 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.9 www.ti.com High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) The device includes an HDMI 1.3a-compliant transmitter for digital video and audio data to display devices. The HDMI interface consists of a digital HDMI transmitter core with TMDS encoder, a core wrapper with interface logic and control registers, and a transmit PHY, with the following features: • Hot-plug detection • Consumer electronics control (CEC) messages • DVI 1.0 compliant (only RGB pixel format) • CEA 861-D and VESA DMT formats • Supports up to 165-MHz pixel clock – 1920 x 1080p @75 Hz with 8-bit/component color depth – 1600 x 1200 @60 Hz with 8-bit/component color depth • Support for deep-color mode: – 10-bit/component color depth up to 1080p @60 Hz (Max pixel clock = 148.5 MHz) – 12-bit/component color depth up to 720p/1080i @60 Hz (Max pixel clock = 123.75 MHz) • TMDS clock to the HDMI-PHY is up to 185.625 MHz • Maximum supported pixel clock: – 165 MHz for 8-bit color depth – 148.5 MHz for 10-bit color depth – 123.75 MHz for 12-bit color depth • Uncompressed multichannel (up to eight channels) audio (L-PCM) support • Master I2C interface for display data channel (DDC) connection • Options available to support HDCP encryption engine for transmitting protected audio and video (for information, contact your local TI sales representative). For more details on the HDMI, see the High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) chapter in the devicespecific Technical Reference Manual. 8.9.1 HDMI Design Guidelines This section provides PCB design and layout guidelines for the HDMI interface. The design rules constrain PCB trace length, PCB trace skew, signal integrity, cross-talk, and signal timing. Simulation and system design work has been done to ensure the HDMI interface requirements are met. 8.9.1.1 HDMI Interface Schematic The HDMI bus is separated into three main sections: 1. Transition Minimized Differential Signaling (TMDS) high-speed digital video interface 2. Display Data Channel (I2C bus for configuration and status exchange between two devices) 3. Consumer Electronics Control (optional) for remote control of connected devices. The DDC and CEC are low-speed interfaces, so nothing special is required for PCB layout of these signals. Their connection is shown in Figure 8-37, HDMI Interface High-Level Schematic. The TMDS channels are high-speed differential pairs and, therefore, require the most care in layout. Specifications for TMDS layout are below. Figure 8-37 shows the HDMI interface schematic. The specific pin numbers can be obtained from , HDMI Terminal Functions. 198 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DEVICE HDMI CONNECTOR HDMI_DP0 HDMI_DN0 TD0+ TD0- HDMI_DP1 HDMI_DN1 TD1+ TD1- HDMI_DP2 HDMI_DN2 TPD12S521 or other ESD Protection w/I2C-Level Translation HDMI_CLKP HDMI_CLKN TD0 Shld TD1 Shld TD2 Shld TD2+ TD2TCLK TCLK+ HDMI_CEC TCLK Shld CEC DDC Gnd 3.3 V Rpullup HDMI_SDA HDMI_SCL (A) SDA SCL HDMI_HPDET A. HPDET 5K-10K Ω pullup resistors are required if not integrated in the ESD protection chip. Figure 8-37. HDMI Interface High-Level Schematic 8.9.1.2 TMDS Routing The TMDS signals are high-speed differential pairs. Care must be taken in the PCB layout of these signals to ensure good signal integrity. The TMDS differential signal traces must be routed to achieve 100 Ω (±10%) differential impedance and 60 Ω (±10%) single-ended impedance. Single-ended impedance control is required because differential signals are extremely difficult to closely couple on PCBs and, therefore, single-ended impedance becomes important. These impedances are impacted by trace width, trace spacing, distance to reference planes, and dielectric material. Verify with a PCB design tool that the trace geometry for both data signal pairs results in as close to 60 Ω impedance traces as possible. For best accuracy, work with your PCB fabricator to ensure this impedance is met. In general, closely coupled differential signal traces are not an advantage on PCBs. When differential signals are closely coupled, tight spacing and width control is necessary. Very small width and spacing variations affect impedance dramatically, so tight impedance control can be more problematic to maintain in production. Loosely coupled PCB differential signals make impedance control much easier. Wider traces and spacing make obstacle avoidance easier, and trace width variations do not affect impedance as much; therefore, it is easier to maintain an accurate impedance over the length of the signal. The wider traces also show reduced skin effect and, therefore, often result in better signal integrity. Table 8-33 shows the routing specifications for the TMDS signals. Table 8-33. TMDS Routing Specifications PARAMETER MIN TYP Processor-to-HDMI header trace length MAX UNIT 7000 Number of stubs allowed on TMDS traces 0 Mils Stubs TX/RX pair differential impedance 90 100 110 Ω TX/RX single ended impedance 54 60 66 Ω Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 199 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-33. TMDS Routing Specifications (continued) PARAMETER MIN TYP Number of vias on each TMDS trace 2 UNIT Vias (1) 2*DS (2) TMDS differential pair to any other trace spacing (1) (2) MAX Vias must be used in pairs with their distance minimized. DS = differential spacing of the HDMI traces. 8.9.1.3 DDC Signals As shown in Figure 8-37, HDMI Interface High-Level Schematic, the DDC connects just like a standard I2C bus. As such, resistor pullups must be used to pull up the open drain buffer signals unless they are integrated into the ESD protection chip used. If used, these pullup resistors should be connected to a 3.3V supply. 8.9.1.4 HDMI ESD Protection Device (Required) Interfaces that connect to a cable such as HDMI generally require more ESD protection than can be built into the processor's outputs. Therefore, this HDMI interface requires the use of an ESD protection chip to provide adequate ESD protection and to translate I2C voltage levels from the 3.3 V supplied by the device to the 5 volts required by the HDMI specification. When selecting an ESD protection chip, choose the lowest capacitance ESD protection available to minimize signal degradation. In no case should the ESD protection circuit capacitance be more than 5 pF. TI manufactures devices that provide ESD protection for HDMI signals such as the TPD12S521. For more information see the www.ti.com website. 8.9.1.5 PCB Stackup Specifications Table 8-34 shows the stackup and feature sizes required for HDMI. Table 8-34. HDMI PCB Stackup Specifications MIN TYP MAX PCB routing/plane layers PARAMETER 4 6 - Layers Signal routing layers 2 3 - Layers Number of ground plane cuts allowed within HDMI routing region - - 0 Cuts Number of layers between HDMI routing region and reference ground plane - - 0 Layers PCB trace width - 4 - Mils PCB BGA escape via pad size - 20 - Mils PCB BGA escape via hole size - Processor device BGA pad size (1) (2) (1) (2) UNIT 10 Mils 0.4 mm Non-solder mask defined pad. Per IPC-7351A BGA pad size guideline. 8.9.1.6 Grounding Each TMDS channel has its own shield pin which should be grounded to provide a return current path for the TMDS signal. 200 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.10 High-Definition Video Processing Subsystem (HDVPSS) The device High-Definition Video Processing Subsystem (HDVPSS) provides a video input interface for external imaging peripherals (for example, image sensors, video decoders, and more) and a video output interface for display devices, such as analog SDTV and HDTV displays, digital HDTV displays, digital LCD panels, and more. It includes HD and SD video encoders and an HDMI transmitter interface. The device HDVPSS features include: • Two display processing pipelines with de-interlacing, scaling, alpha blending, chroma keying, color space conversion, flicker filtering, and pixel format conversion. • HD/SD compositor features for PIP support. • Format conversions (up to 1080p 60 Hz) include scan format conversion, scan rate conversion, aspectratio conversion, and frame size conversion. • Supports additional video processing capabilities by using the subsystem's memory-to-memory feature. • Two parallel video processing pipelines support HD (up to 1080p60) and SD (NTSC/PAL) simultaneous outputs. – HD analog component output with OSD and embedded timing codes (BT.1120) • 3-channel HD-DAC with 10-bit resolution. • External HSYNC and VSYNC signals. – SD analog output with OSD with embedded timing codes (BT.656) • Composite output • 1-channel SD-DAC with 10-bit resolution • Options available to support MacroVision and CGMS-A (contact local TI Sales rep for information). – Digital HDMI 1.3a-compliant transmitter (for details, see Section 8.9, High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI)). – One digital video output supporting up to 30-bits @ 165 MHz – One digital video output supporting up to 24-bits @ 165 MHz – Supports clock inversion for VOUT[0] and VOUT[1] clock signals. • Two independently configurable external video input capture ports (up to 165 MHz). – 16/24-bit HD digital video input or dual clock independent 8-bit SD inputs on each capture port. – 8/16/24-bit digital video input – 8-bit digital video input – Embedded sync and external sync modes are supported for all input configurations (VIN1 Port B supports embedded sync only). – De-multiplexing of both pixel-to-pixel and line-to-line multiplexed streams, effectively supporting up to 16 simultaneous SD inputs with a glueless interface to an external multiplexer such as the TVP5158. – Additional features include: programmable color space conversion, scaler and chroma downsampler, ancillary VANC/VBI data capture (decoded by software). • Graphics features: – Three independently-generated graphics layers. – Each supports full-screen resolution graphics in HD, SD or both. – Up/down scaler optimized for graphics. – Global and pixel-level alpha blending supported. For more detailed information on specific features and registers, see the High Definition Video Processing Subsystem chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 201 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.10.1 HDVPSS Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-35. Timing Requirements for HDVPSS Input (see Figure 8-38 and Figure 8-39) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN UNIT MAX VIN[X]A_CLK 6.06 (1) ns Pulse duration, VIN[x]A_CLK high (45% of tc) 2.73 ns tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, VIN[x]A_CLK low (45% of tc) 2.73 ns tt(CLK) Transition time, VIN[x]A_CLK (10%-90%) 1 tc(CLK) Cycle time, VIN[x]A_CLK 2 tw(CLKH) 3 7 2.64 ns tsu(DE-CLK) tsu(VSYNC-CLK) 4 tsu(FLD-CLK) Input setup time, control valid to VIN[x]A_CLK high/low 3.11 Input setup time, data valid to VIN[x]A_CLK high/low 3.11 Input hold time, control valid from VIN[x]A_CLK high/low -0.5 Input hold time, data valid from VIN[x]A_CLK high/low -0.5 ns tsu(HSYNC-CLK) tsu(D-CLK) th(CLK-DE) th(CLK-VSYNC) 5 th(CLK-FLD) ns th(CLK-HSYNC) th(CLK-D) VIN[x]B_CLK 6.06 (1) ns Pulse duration, VIN[x]B_CLK high (45% of tc) 2.73 ns Pulse duration, VIN[x]B_CLK low (45% of tc) 2.73 1 tc(CLK) Cycle time, VIN[x]B_CLK 2 tw(CLKH) 3 tw(CLKH) 7 tt(CLK) Transition time, VIN[x]B_CLK (10%-90%) ns 2.64 ns tsu(DE-CLK) tsu(VSYNC-CLK) 4 tsu(FLD-CLK) Input setup time, control valid to VIN[x]B_CLK high/low 3.11 Input setup time, data valid to VIN[x]B_CLK high/low 3.11 Input hold time, control valid from VIN[x]B_CLK high/low -0.5 Input hold time, data valid from VIN[x]B_CLK high/low -0.5 ns tsu(HSYNC-CLK) tsu(D-CLK) th(CLK-DE) th(CLK-VSYNC) 5 th(CLK-FLD) ns th(CLK-HSYNC) th(CLK-D) (1) 202 For maximum frequency of 165 MHz. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-36. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for HDVPSS Output (see Figure 8-38 and Figure 8-40) NO. OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/ Nitro PARAMETER MIN UNIT MAX 6.06 (1) ns Pulse duration, VOUT[x]_CLK high (45% of tc) 2.73 ns tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, VOUT[x]_CLK low (45% of tc) 2.73 ns tt(CLK) Transition time, VOUT[x]_CLK (10%-90%) 1 tc(CLK) Cycle time, VOUT[x]_CLK 2 tw(CLKH) 3 7 2.64 ns 1.64 4.18 ns 1.64 4.18 ns -1.64 4.18 ns -1.64 4.18 ns td(CLK-AVID) td(CLK-FLD) Delay time, VOUT[x]_CLK low (falling) to control valid, positive clock edge td(CLK-VSYNC) td(CLK-HSYNC) td(CLK-RCR) Delay time, VOUT[0]_CLK low (falling) to data valid, positive clock edge td(CLK-GYYC) td(CLK-BCBC) td(CLK-YYC) 6 Delay time, VOUT[1]_CLK low (falling) to data valid, positive clock edge td(CLK-C) td(CLK-AVID) td(CLK-FLD) Delay time, VOUT[x]_CLK low (falling) to control valid, negative clock edge td(CLK-VSYNC) td(CLK-HSYNC) td(CLK-RCR) Delay time, VOUT[0]_CLK low (falling) to data valid, negative clock edge td(CLK-GYYC) td(CLK-BCBC) td(CLK-YYC) Delay time, VOUT[1]_CLK low (falling) to data valid, negative clock edge td(CLK-C) (1) For maximum frequency of 165 MHz. 3 2 1 VIN[x]A_CLK/ VIN[x]B_CLK/ VOUT[x]_CLK 7 1 7 Figure 8-38. HDVPSS Clock Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 203 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com VIN[x]A_CLK/ VIN[x]B_CLK (positive-edge clocking) VIN[x]A_CLK/ VIN[x]B_CLK (negative-edge clocking) 5 4 VIN[x]A/ VIN[x]B Figure 8-39. HDVPSS Input Timing VOUT[x]_CLK 6 VOUT[x] Figure 8-40. HDVPSS Output Timing 204 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.10.2 Video SD-DAC Guidelines and Electrical Data/Timing The device's analog video SD-DAC output can be operated in one of two modes: Normal mode and TVOUT Bypass mode. In Normal mode, the device’s internal video amplifier is used. In TVOUT Bypass mode, the internal video amplifier is bypassed and an external amplifier is required. Figure 8-41 shows a typical circuit that permits connecting the analog video output from the device to standard 75-Ω impedance video systems in Normal mode. Figure 8-42 shows a typical circuit that permits connecting the analog video output from the device to standard 75-Ω impedance video systems in TVOUT Bypass mode. Reconstruction (A) Filter ~9.5 MHz TV_OUTx CAC (B) ROUT TV_VFBx A. B. Reconstruction Filter (optional) AC coupling capacitor (optional) Figure 8-41. TV Output (Normal Mode) Reconstruction (A) Filter ~9.5 MHz TV_VFBx Amplifier 3.7 V/V 75 Ω CAC (B) RLOAD A. B. Reconstruction Filter (optional). Note: An amplifier with an integrated reconstruction filter can alternatively be used instead of a discrete reconstruction filter. AC coupling capacitor (optional) Figure 8-42. TV Output (TVOUT Bypass Mode) During board design, the onboard traces and parasitics must be matched for the channel. The video SDDAC output pin (TV_OUT0/TV_VFB0) are very high-frequency analog signals and must be routed with extreme care. As a result, the paths of these signals must be as short as possible, and as isolated as possible from other interfering signals. In TVOUT Bypass mode, the load resistor and amplifier/buffer should be placed as close as possible to the TV_VFB0 pin. Other layout guidelines include: • Take special care to bypass the VDDA_VDAC_1P8 power supply pin with a capacitor. For more information, see Section 7.2.9, Power-Supply Decoupling. • In TVOUT Bypass mode, place the RLOAD resistor as close as possible to the Reconstruction Filter and Amplifier. In addition, place the 75-Ω resistor as close as possible (< 0.5 ") to the Amplifier/buffer output pin. To maintain a high-quality video signal, the onboard traces after the 75-Ω resistor should have a characteristic impedance of 75 Ω (± 20%). • In Normal mode, TV_VFB0 is the most sensitive pin in the TV out system. The ROUT resistor should be placed as close as possible to the device pin. To maintain a high-quality video signal, the onboard traces leading to the TV_OUT0 pin should have a characteristic impedance of 75 Ω (± 20%) starting from the closest possible place to the device pin output. • Minimize input trace lengths to the device to reduce parasitic capacitance. • Include solid ground return paths. For additional Video SD-DAC Design guidelines, see the High Definition Video Processing Subsystem chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 205 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-37. Static and Dynamic SD-DAC Specifications VDAC STATIC SPECIFICATIONS PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN TYP MAX UNIT Reference Current Setting Resistor (RSET) Normal Mode 4653 4700 4747 Ω TVOUT Bypass Mode 9900 10000 10100 Ω Output resistor between TV_OUT0 and TV_VFB0 pins (ROUT) Normal Mode 2673 2700 2727 Ω Load Resistor (RLOAD) Normal Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode N/A 75-Ω Inside the Display TVOUT Bypass Mode 1485 AC-Coupling Capacitor (Optional) [CAC] Normal Mode 220 Total Capacitance from TV_OUT0 to VSSA_VDAC_1P8 Normal Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode 1500 1515 See External Amplifier Specification TVOUT Bypass Mode 300 pF 4 LSB N/A Resolution 10 Integral Non-Linearity (INL), Best Fit Normal Mode Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) Normal Mode -4 TVOUT Bypass Mode TVOUT Bypass Mode Full-Scale Output Voltage Full-Scale Output Current Ω uF Bits -1 1 LSB -2.5 2.5 LSB -1 1 LSB Normal Mode (RLOAD = 75 Ω) 1.3 V TVOUT Bypass Mode (RLOAD = 1.5 kΩ) 0.7 V 470 uA Normal Mode N/A TVOUT Bypass Mode Gain Error Normal Mode (Composite) and TVOUT Bypass Mode Output Impedance Looking into TV_OUT0 nodes -10 10 %FS Ω 75 VDAC DYNAMIC SPECIFICATIONS PARAMETER TEST CONDITIONS MIN Output Update Rate (FCLK) TYP MAX UNIT 54 60 MHz Signal Bandwidth 3 dB 6 MHz Spurious-Free Dynamic Range (SFDR) within bandwidth FCLK = 54 MHz, FOUT = 1 MHz 50 dBc Signal-to-Noise Ration (SNR) FCLK = 54 MHz, FOUT = 1 MHz 54 dB Normal Mode, 100 mVpp @ 6 MHz on VDDA_VDAC_1P8 6 TVOUT Bypass Mode, 100 mVpp @ 6 MHz on VDDA_VDAC_1P8 20 Power Supply Rejection (PSR) 206 Peripheral Information and Timings dB Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.10.3 Video HD-DAC Guidelines and Electrical Data/Timing The device's analog video HD-DAC outputs are designed to drive a 165-Ω load. An external video buffer/amplifier is required to provide additional gain (4.5V/V) and to drive the actual video outputs. 75-Ω back termination resistors should be connected in series with the video buffer output pins. For component video applications, a reconstruction filter should precede the video buffer. One solution is to use a video buffer/amplifier with integrated reconstruction filter, such as the Texas Instruments THS7360, which provides a complete solution for the typical output circuit, shown in Figure 8-43. Reconstruction Filter HDDAC_x RLOAD SD: ED: HD: 1080p: Amplifier 75 W 4.5 V/V 9.5 MHz 18 MHz 36 MHz 72 MHz Figure 8-43. Typical Output Circuits for Analog Video from DACs During board design, the onboard traces and parasitics must be matched for the channel. The video HDDAC output pins (HDDAC_x) are very high-frequency analog signals and must be routed with extreme care. As a result, the path of this signal must be as short as possible, and as isolated as possible from other interfering signals. Other schematic and layout guidelines include: • The correct external video gain (4.5V/V) must always be provided (even when not using the recommended video buffer). The recommended video buffer is the THS7360. • The load resistor (RLOAD) should be placed as close as possible (< 0.5 in.) to the THS7360 video buffer input pins. • The 75-Ω series resistors should be placed as close as possible (< 0.5 in.) to the THS7360 video buffer output pins. • The trace lengths within a video format group should match as close as possible (for example, for component video outputs, the Y, Pb, and Pr trace lengths should match each other). • The characteristic impedance of the HD-DAC output signal traces should match the HD-DAC load value (165Ω) as close as possible (±10%). The minimum trace width may limit how closely these impedances can be matched. • The characteristic impedance of the video buffer output signal traces should match the back termination value (75 Ω) as close as possible (±10%). The minimum trace width may limit how closely these impedances can be matched. • To provide adequate frequency response on the VGA/YPbPr output, recommend the following: – The length of the signal traces from the HD-DAC output pins to the THS7360 video buffer input pins should be minimized (< 1 in.) to reduce parasitic capacitance (~2 pF per inch). – Ensure the THS7360 reconstruction filter is properly programmed for each output format. – Enable 2x up-sampling for 720p/1080i component video outputs. • To minimize noise on the VGA/YPbPr output, recommend the following: – The HD-DAC power supply pins (VDDA_REF_1P8V, VDDA_HD_1P8V) should be connected to a low-noise 1.8-V analog supply. Use a dedicated voltage regulator for best noise performance. – The THS7360 power supply pin should be connected to a low-noise 3.3-V analog supply. Use a dedicated voltage regulator for best noise performance. – Special care should be taken to provide adequate power supply decoupling on all analog supply pins (for example, ferrite bead and bypass capacitor). – Provide a ground guard adjacent to analog video signal traces to minimize noise coupling. – Provide a low impedance path to ground for the shield of the VGA/YPbPr output connector. – Include solid ground return paths. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 207 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 • • www.ti.com To – – – provide adequate ESD protection on the VGA/YPbPr output, recommend the following: Provide ESD protection on all output signals (that is, Video, Syncs and DDC I/F). Minimize the distance from the ESD protection device to the VGA/YPbPr output connector. Mount all ESD protection devices on the PCB level next to the ground plane to provide the lowest possible impedance path to ground. – Provide a low impedance path to ground for the shield of the VGA/YPbPr output connector. For VGA outputs, recommend the following: – 3.3 V to 5 V level shifters should be used for the H/V Sync signals. – 3.3 V to 5 V bi-directional level shifters should be used for the DDC signals. This is typically implemented using two N-channel enhancement MOSFETs. – Recommend using the TPD7S019 ESD protection device with integrated level shifters for the H/V Sync and DDC signals. – The source impedance of the H/V Sync outputs should be 50 Ω. – The characteristic impedance of the H/V Sync output signal traces should be 50 Ω. – The THS7360 reconstruction filter should be bypassed to provide maximum bandwidth. – The 5-V supply output should be current limited (for example, using a series resistor or resettable fuse). For additional video HD-DAC design guidelines, see the High Definition Video Processing Subsystem chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Table 8-38. HD-DAC Recommended Operating Conditions MIN NOM MAX Output Load Capacitance (CLOAD) (1) UNIT 5 pF Output Load Resistors (RLOAD) –1% 165 +1% Ω Full-Scale Current Adjust Resistor (RHDDAC_IREF) –1% 2.67 +1% kΩ Optional External Voltage Reference (HDDAC_VREF) (2) –5% 467 +5% mV Required External Amplification (THS7360) –3% 4.5 +3% V/V (1) (2) The output load capacitance includes the signal trace parasitic capacitance and the video buffer input capacitance. An external voltage reference is not required since an internal bandgap reference is provided. Table 8-39. HD-DAC Specifications PARAMETER CONDITIONS MIN Resolution TYP MAX 10 UNIT Bits DC Accuracy Integral Non-Linearity (INL), best fit 2.5 LSB Differential Non-Linearity (DNL) 1.0 LSB Analog Output Full-Scale Output Current (IFS) DAC input = 1023 Full-Scale Output Voltage (VFS) DAC input = 1023 3 –15% Zero Scale Offset Error (ZSET) 494 mA +15% 0.5 Channel matching mV LSB 2 % Dynamic Specifications Maximum Output Update Rate (FCLK) Spurious - Free Dynamic Range (SFDR) 208 150 MHz FCLK = 74.25 MHz, 30-MHz full-scale sine wave 70 dB FCLK = 148.5 MHz, 30-MHz full-scale sine wave 60 dB Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.11 Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) The device includes four inter-integrated circuit (I2C) modules which provide an interface to other devices compliant with Philips Semiconductors Inter-IC bus (I2C-bus™) specification version 2.1. External components attached to this 2-wire serial bus can transmit/receive 8-bit data to/from the device through the I2C module. The I2C port does not support CBUS compatible devices. The I2C port supports the following features: • Compatible with Philips I2C Specification Revision 2.1 (January 2000) • Standard and fast modes from 10 - 400 Kbps (no fail-safe I/O buffers) • Noise filter to remove noise 50 ns or less • Seven- and ten-bit device addressing modes • Multimaster transmitter/slave receiver mode • Multimaster receiver/slave transmitter mode • Combined master transmit/receive and receive/transmit modes • Two DMA channels, one interrupt line • Built-in FIFO (32 byte) for buffered read or write. For more detailed information on the I2C peripheral, see the Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Controller Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.11.1 I2C Peripheral Register Descriptions The I2C peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 209 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.11.2 I2C Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-40. Timing Requirements for I2C Input Timings (1) (see Figure 8-44) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro STANDARD MODE NO. MIN 1 MAX FAST MODE MIN UNIT MAX tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 2 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 3 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 4 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 5 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs (2) 6 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 7 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low 0 (3) 3.45 (4) 100 0 (3) 8 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 4.7 1.3 9 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb (5) 300 ns 10 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb (5) 300 ns 300 ns 300 ns 11 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb (5) 12 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb (5) 13 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 14 tw(SP) Pulse duration, spike (must be suppressed) 15 (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) Cb 4 ns 0.9 (4) µs 0.6 µs 0 Capacitive load for each bus line 400 µs 50 ns 400 pF The I2C pins SDA and SCL do not feature fail-safe I/O buffers. These pins could potentially draw current when the device is powered down. A Fast-mode I2C-bus™ device can be used in a Standard-mode I2C-bus system, but the requirement tsu(SDA-SCLH)≥ 250 ns must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal. If such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit to the SDA line tr max + tsu(SDA-SCLH)= 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the Standard-mode I2C-Bus Specification) before the SCL line is released. A device must internally provide a hold time of at least 300 ns for the SDA signal (referred to the VIHmin of the SCL signal) to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of SCL. The maximum th(SDA-SCLL) has only to be met if the device does not stretch the low period [tw(SCLL)] of the SCL signal. Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. 9 11 I2C[x]_SDA 6 8 14 4 13 5 10 I2C[x]_SCL 1 12 3 7 2 3 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop Figure 8-44. I2C Receive Timing 210 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-41. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for I2C Output Timings (see Figure 8-45) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitro NO. STANDARD MODE PARAMETER MIN 16 (1) MAX FAST MODE MIN UNIT MAX tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 17 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 18 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 19 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 20 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs 21 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 100 22 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low (for I2C bus devices) 23 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 24 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 25 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 26 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 27 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300 ns 28 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 29 Cp Capacitance for each I2C pin 0 3.45 4.7 0 ns 0.9 µs 1.3 4 (1) (1) (1) (1) µs 0.6 10 µs 10 pF Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. 24 26 I2C[x]_SDA 21 23 19 28 20 25 I2C[x]_SCL 27 16 18 22 17 18 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop Figure 8-45. I2C Transmit Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 211 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.12 Imaging Subsystem (ISS) The device Imaging Subsystem captures and processes pixel data from external image and video inputs. The inputs can be connected to the Image Processing block through the Parallel Camera Interface (CAM). In addition, a Timing control module provides flash strobe and mechanical shutter interfaces. The features of each component of the ISS are described below. • Parallel Camera (CAM) interface features: – Input format • Bayer pattern Raw (up to 16bit) or YCbCr 422 (8-bit or 16-bit) data. • ITU-R BT.656/1120 standard format – Generates HD/VD timing signals and field ID to an external timing generator, or can synchronize to the external timing generator. – Support for progressive and interlaced sensors (hardware support for up to 2 fields and firmware supports for higher number of fields, typically 3-, 4-, and 5-field sensors. • CSI2 Serial Connection features: – Supports up to 1Gb/s data-rate per lane for 1, 2, and 3 Data-lane configurations, and up to 824Mbps per lane for a 4 Data-lane configuration – Supports sensor capture up to 4K x 2K 10-bit Bayer @ 30fps – Supports up to four data configurable links in addition to the clock signaling – Data merger for 2-, 3-, or 4-data lane configurations – 1-D and 2-D addressing mode – Supports all primary and secondary MIPI-defined formats (RGB, RAW, YUV, and more) – DPCM decompression – Image cropping and A-Law/DPCM compression • Image Sensor Interface (ISIF) features: – Support for up to 32K pixels (image size) in both the horizontal and vertical direction – Color space conversion for non-Bayer pattern Raw data – Digital black clamping with Horizontal/Vertical offset drift compensation – Vertical Line defect correction based on a lookup table – Color-dependent gain control and black level offset control – Ability to control output to the DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L via an external write enable signal – Down sampling via programmable culling patterns – A-law/DPCM compression – Generating 16-, 12- or 8-bit output to memory • Two independent Resizers – Providing two different sizes of outputs simultaneously on one input – Maximum line width is 5376 and 2336, respectively – YUV422 to YUV420 conversion – Data output format: RGB565, ARGB888, YUV422 co sited and YUV4:2:0 planar – Resizer Ratio: x1/4096 ~ x20 – Input from memory • Timing control module features: – STROBE signal for flash pre-strobe and flash strobe – SHUTTER signal for mechanical shutter control – Global reset control For more detailed information on the ISS, see the ISS Overview section, the ISS Interfaces section, and the ISS ISP section of the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 212 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.12.1 ISS Peripheral Register Description The ISS peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.12.2 ISSCAM Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-42. Timing Requirements for ISSCAM (see Figure 8-46) OPP100/OPP120/Turb o/Nitro UNIT MIN NOM MAX N O. 1 tc(PCLK) Cycle time, PCLK 6.17 ns 2 tw(PCLKH) Pulse duration, PCLK high 2.78 ns 3 tw(PCLKL) Pulse duration, PCLK low 2.78 4 tt(PCLK) Transition time, PCLK ns 2.64 tsu(DATA- ns 3.11 ns tsu(DE-PCLK) 3.11 ns tsu(VS-PCLK) Input setup time, Data/Control valid before PCLK high/low 3.11 ns tsu(HS-PCLK) 3.11 ns tsu(FLD- 3.11 ns -0.5 ns 0.0 ns -0.5 ns -0.5 ns -0.5 ns -0.5 ns PCLK) 5 PCLK) th(PCLK- ≤ 148.5 MHz clock rate Input hold time, Data valid after PCLK high/low DATA) 6 > 148.5 MHz and ≤ 162 MHz clock rate th(PCLK-DE) th(PCLK-VS) th(PCLK-HS) Input hold time, Control valid after PCLK high/low th(PCLK-FLD) Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 213 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-43. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for ISSCAM (see Figure 8-46) NO. OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT 15 td(PCLK-FLD) Delay time, PCLK rising/falling clock edge to Control valid 1.64 14.68 ns 16 td(PCLK-VS) Delay time, PCLK rising/falling clock edge to Control valid 1.64 14.68 ns 17 td(PCLK-HS) Delay time, PCLK rising/falling clock edge to Control valid 1.64 14.68 ns 18 td(PCLK-STROBE) Delay time, PCLK rising/falling clock edge to Control valid 1.64 14.68 ns 19 td(PCLK-SHUTTER) Delay time, PCLK rising/falling clock edge to Control valid 1.64 14.68 ns PCLK (negative edge clocking) 4 1 3 PCLK (positive edge clocking) 2 4 Data/Control input 5 6 Data/Control output 7 Figure 8-46. ISSCAM Timings 8.12.3 CSI2 PCB Layout Specifications The following PCB guidelines for CSI2 working at 1 Gbps (up to 3 data lanes), 824 Mbps (up to 4 data lanes), and 800 Mbps (up to 4 data lanes) are based on a three-step design and validation methodology. For the design of the PCB differential lines, PCB designers need to keep in mind the requirements of Step 1 and Step 2: the characteristic impedance must be 50 Ω, the total length must be smaller than 100 mm, and the length mismatch requirements must be satisfied. After the PCB design is finished, the S-parameters of the PCB differential lines will be extracted with a 3D Maxwell Equation Solver, such as High-Frequency Structure Simulator (HFSS) or equivalent, and compared to the frequency-domain specification as outlined in Step 3 of the design methodology. If the PCB lines satisfy the frequency-domain specification, the design is done. Otherwise, the design needs to be improved. 8.12.3.1 Step 1: General Guidelines The general guidelines for the PCB differential lines of CSI2 are given as: • Single-ended Z0 = 50 Ω • Total conductor length on the board < 100 mm In this step, the general rule of thumb for the space S = 2 × W is not designated. Although the S = 2 × W rule is a good rule of thumb, it is not always the best solution. The electrical performance will be checked with the frequency-domain specification in Step 3. Even if the design does not follow the S = 2 × W rule, the differential lines are okay if the lines satisfy the frequency-domain specification in Step 3. 214 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.12.3.2 Step 2: Length Mismatch Guidelines 8.12.3.2.1 CSI2 at 1.0 Gbps The guidelines of the length mismatch for CSI2 at 1.0 Gbps are presented in Table 8-44. The intralane length mismatch must be less than 0.5 mm, and the interlane length mismatch must be less than 1.5 mm. Table 8-44. Length Mismatch Guidelines for CSI2 at 1.0 Gbps PARAMETER TYPICAL VALUE UNIT Operating speed 1000 Mbps UI (bit time) 1000 ps Intralane skew (UI / 300) Length between N and P traces 3 ps 0.5 mm Interlane skew (UI / 100) 10 ps Length between pairs 1.5 mm 8.12.3.2.2 CSI2 at 824 Mbps The guidelines of the length mismatch for CSI2 at 824 Mbps are presented in Table 8-45. The intralane length mismatch must be less than 0.6 mm, and the interlane length mismatch must be less than 1.8 mm. Table 8-45. Length Mismatch Guidelines for CSI2 at 824 Mbps PARAMETER TYPICAL VALUE UNIT Operating speed 824 Mbps UI (bit time) 1213 ps Intralane skew (UI / 300) 4 ps Length between N and P traces 0.6 mm Interlane skew (UI / 100) 12 ps Length between pairs 1.8 mm 8.12.3.2.3 CSI2 at 800 Mbps The guidelines of the length mismatch for CSI2 at 800 Mbps are presented in Table 8-46. The intralane length mismatch must be less than 0.6 mm, and the interlane length mismatch must be less than 1.8 mm. Table 8-46. Length Mismatch Guidelines for CSI2 at 800 Mbps PARAMETER TYPICAL VALUE UNIT Operating speed 800 Mbps UI (bit time) 1250 ps 4 ps Length between N and P traces 0.6 mm Interlane skew (UI / 100) 12 ps Length between pairs 1.8 mm Intralane skew (UI / 300) Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 215 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.12.3.3 Step 3: Frequency-Domain Specification Guidelines The PCB differential lines should be drawn in order to satisfy the Step 1 and Step 2 requirements. However, although the PCB designer may draw the lines carefully, the lines can have poor electrical performance due to many reasons. Vertical connections such as vias and non-uniform line connections can degrade the electrical performance of the differential lines. The ground design around the lines can also affect the electrical performance. To ensure that the differential lines are well designed, the frequency-domain behavior must be compared to the frequency-domain specification. 1. Intralane frequency-domain specification – Differential-mode characteristics – Sdd12, Sdd11/Sdd22 – Common-mode characteristics – Scc11/Scc22 – Mode-conversion characteristics – Scd11, Scd12, Scd21, Scd22, Sdc11, Sdc12, Sdc21, Sdc22 2. Interlane frequency-domain specification – Differential-mode characteristics – Sdd11/Sdd22 – Common-mode characteristics – Scc11/Scc22 216 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13 DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller The device has a dedicated interface to DDR3L, DDR3 and DDR2 SDRAM. It supports DDR2, DDR3 and DDR3L SDRAM devices with the following features: • 16-bit or 32-bit data path to external SDRAM memory • Memory device capacity: 64Mb, 128Mb, 256Mb, 512Mb, 1Gb, 2Gb, and 4Gb devices • One interface with associated DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L PHY For details on the DDR2, DDR3 and DDR3L Memory Controller, see the DDR2/DDR3/DDR3L Memory Controller chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 217 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.13.1 DDR2/3/3L Memory Controller Register Descriptions The DDR2/3/3L peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.13.2 DDR2 Routing Specifications 8.13.2.1 Board Designs TI only supports board designs that follow the guidelines outlined in this document. The switching characteristics and the timing diagram for the DDR2 memory controller are shown in Table 8-47 and Figure 8-47. Table 8-47. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR2 Memory Controller NO. 1 -1G PARAMETER tc(DDR_CLK) Cycle time, DDR_CLK MIN MAX 2.5 8 UNIT ns 1 DDR_CLK Figure 8-47. DDR2 Memory Controller Clock Timing 8.13.2.2 DDR2 Interface This section provides the timing specification for the DDR2 interface as a PCB design and manufacturing specification. The design rules constrain PCB trace length, PCB trace skew, signal integrity, cross-talk, and signal timing. These rules, when followed, result in a reliable DDR2 memory system without the need for a complex timing closure process. For more information regarding the guidelines for using this DDR2 specification, see the Understanding TI’s PCB Routing Rule-Based DDR Timing Specification Application Report (Literature Number: SPRAAV0). 8.13.2.2.1 DDR2 Interface Schematic Figure 8-48 shows the DDR2 interface schematic for a x32 DDR2 memory system. In Figure 8-49 the x16 DDR2 system schematic is identical except that the high-word DDR2 device is deleted. When not using a DDR2 interface, the proper method of handling the unused pins is to tie off the DQS pins by pulling the non-inverted DQS pin to the DVDD_DDR[0] supply via a 1k-Ω resistor and pulling the inverted DQS pin to ground via a 1k-Ω resistor. This needs to be done for each byte not used. Also, include the 50-Ω pulldown for DDR[0]_VTP. The DVDD_DDR[0] and VREFSSTL_DDR[0] power supply pins must be connected to their respective power supplies even if DDR[0] is not used. All other DDR interface pins can be left unconnected. Note that the supported modes for use of the DDR EMIF are 32bits wide, 16-bits wide, or not used. 218 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DDR2 DDR[0]_D[0] DQ0 DDR[0]_D[7] DDR[0]_DQM[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] DQ7 LDM LDQS DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_D[8] LDQS DQ8 DDR[0]_D[15] DDR[0]_DQM[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DQ15 UDM UDQS DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_ODT[0] UDQS ODT T0 DDR2 ODT DDR[0]_D[16] DQ0 DDR[0]_D[23] DDR[0]_DQM[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_D[24] DQ7 LDM LDQS LDQS DQ8 DDR[0]_D[31] DDR[0]_DQM[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] DQ15 UDM UDQS UDQS DDR[0]_BA[0] T0 BA0 BA0 DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_A[0] T0 T0 BA2 A0 BA2 A0 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0]_CS[0] T0 T0 A15 CS A15 CS DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0]_RAS T0 T0 CAS RAS CAS DDR[0]_WE DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0]_CLK T0 T0 T0 T0 WE CKE CK CK VREF WE CKE CK CK VREF DDR[0]_CLK VREFSSTL_DDR[0] 0.1 µF DDR[0]_RST (B) (B) 0.1 µF (A) Vio 1.8 RAS VREF 0.1 µF 0.1 µF VREF 1 K Ω 1% VREF (B) 0.1 µF 1 K Ω 1% NC DDR[0]_VTP 50 Ω (±2%) T0 A. B. Termination is required. See terminator comments. Vio1.8 is the power supply for the DDR2 memories and the device DDR2 interface. One of these capacitors can be eliminated if the divider and its capacitors are placed near a VREF pin. Figure 8-48. 32-Bit DDR2 High-Level Schematic Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 219 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com DDR2 DDR[0]_D[0] DQ0 DDR[0]_D[7] DDR[0]_DQM[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] DQ7 LDM LDQS DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_D[8] LDQS DQ8 DDR[0]_D[15] DDR[0]_DQM[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DQ15 UDM UDQS UDQS DDR[0]_ODT[0] T0 ODT DDR[0]_D[16] NC DDR[0]_D[23] DDR[0]_DQM[2] NC NC 1 KΩ DDR[0]_D[24] NC 1 KΩ DDR[0]_D[31] DDR[0]_DQM[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] NC NC (A) Vio 1.8 DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] (A) Vio 1.8 1 KΩ 1 KΩ DDR[0]_BA[0] T0 BA0 DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_A[0] T0 T0 BA2 A0 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0]_CS[0] T0 T0 A15 CS DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0]_WE DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0]_CLK T0 T0 T0 T0 T0 T0 CAS DDR[0]_CLK VREFSSTL_DDR[0] VREF (B) 0.1 µF VREF 1 K Ω 1% VREF (B) 0.1 µF DDR[0]_RST (A) Vio 1.8 RAS WE CKE CK CK 0.1 µF 0.1 µF 1 K Ω 1% NC DDR[0]_VTP 50 Ω (±2%) T0 A. B. Termination is required. See terminator comments. Vio1.8 is the power supply for the DDR2 memories and the device DDR2 interface. One of these capacitors can be eliminated if the divider and its capacitors are placed near a VREF pin. Figure 8-49. 16-Bit DDR2 High-Level Schematic 220 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.2.2.2 Compatible DDR2 Devices Table 8-48 shows the parameters of the DDR2 devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the DDR2 interface is compatible with x16 DDR2-800 speed grade DDR2 devices. Table 8-48. Compatible DDR2 Devices (Per Interface) NO. (1) (2) (3) PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT 1 DDR2 device speed grade (1) 2 DDR2 device bit width x16 x16 3 DDR2 device count (2) 1 2 Devices 4 DDR2 device ball count (3) 84 92 Balls DDR2-800 Bits Higher DDR2 speed grades are supported due to inherent DDR2 backwards compatibility. One DDR2 device is used for a 16-bit DDR2 memory system. Two DDR2 devices are used for a 32-bit DDR2 memory system. The 92-ball devices are retained for legacy support. New designs will migrate to 84-ball DDR2 devices. Electrically, the 92- and 84-ball DDR2 devices are the same. 8.13.2.2.3 PCB Stackup The minimum stackup required for routing the device is a six-layer stackup as shown in Table 8-49. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Table 8-49. Minimum PCB Stackup LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top routing mostly horizontal 2 Plane Ground 3 Plane Power 4 Signal Internal routing 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal Bottom routing mostly vertical Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 221 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Complete stackup specifications are provided in Table 8-50. Table 8-50. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. PARAMETER MIN TYP 1 PCB routing/plane layers 6 2 Signal routing layers 3 3 Full ground layers under DDR2 routing region 2 4 Number of ground plane cuts allowed within DDR routing region 5 Number of ground reference planes required for each DDR2 routing layer 6 Number of layers between DDR2 routing layer and reference ground plane 7 PCB feature spacing 4 8 PCB trace width, w 4 9 PCB BGA escape via pad size (1) 10 PCB BGA escape via hole size 11 Processor BGA pad size 13 Single-ended impedance, Zo 14 Impedance control (2) (1) (2) 222 MAX UNIT 0 1 0 18 (1) Mils Mils 20 10 Mils 0.4 50 Z-5 Z Mils mm 75 Ω Z+5 Ω A 20/10 via may be used if enough power routing resources are available. An 18/10 via allows for more flexible power routing to the processor. Z is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by item 13. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.2.2.4 Placement Figure 8-50 shows the required placement for the processor as well as the DDR2 devices. The dimensions for this figure are defined in Table 8-51. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB on which the devices are mounted. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For a 16-bit DDR memory system, the high-word DDR2 device is omitted from the placement. Recommended DDR2 Device Orientation X X1 A1 X1 X1 OFFSET OFFSET DDR2 Controller Y A1 Figure 8-50. Device and DDR2 Device Placement Table 8-51. Placement Specifications NO. (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) PARAMETER MIN (1) (2) 1 X+Y 2 X' (1) (2) 3 X' Offset (1) (2) 4 DDR2 keepout region (4) 5 Clearance from non-DDR2 signal to DDR2 keepout region (5) (3) MAX UNIT 1660 Mils 1280 Mils 650 Mils 4 w For dimension definitions, see Figure 8-48. Measurements from center of processor to center of DDR2 device. For 16-bit memory systems, it is recommended that X' offset be as small as possible. DDR2 keepout region to encompass entire DDR2 routing area. Non-DDR2 signals allowed within DDR2 keepout region provided they are separated from DDR2 routing layers by a ground plane. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 223 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.13.2.2.5 DDR2 Keepout Region The region of the PCB used for the DDR2 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The DDR2 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 8-51. The size of this region varies with the placement and DDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keepout region are shown in Table 8-51. A1 DDR2 Device A1 A1 DDR2 Controller A1 Figure 8-51. DDR2 Keepout Region NOTE The region shown in should encompass all the DDR2 circuitry and varies depending on placement. Non-DDR2 signals should not be routed on the DDR signal layers within the DDR2 keepout region. Non-DDR2 signals may be routed in the region, provided they are routed on layers separated from DDR2 signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the 1.8-V power plane should cover the entire keepout region. Routes for the DDR interface must be separated by at least 4x; the more separation, the better. 8.13.2.2.6 Bulk Bypass Capacitors Bulk bypass capacitors are required for moderate speed bypassing of the DDR2 and other circuitry. Table 8-52 contains the minimum numbers and capacitance required for the bulk bypass capacitors. Note that this table only covers the bypass needs of the DDR2 interfaces and DDR2 device. Additional bulk bypass capacitance may be needed for other circuitry. Table 8-52. Bulk Bypass Capacitors No. Parameter Min Max Unit 1 DVDD18 bulk bypass capacitor count (1) 3 Devices 2 DVDD18 bulk bypass total capacitance 30 μF 1 Devices 10 μF (1) 3 DDR bulk bypass capacitor count 4 DDR bulk bypass total capacitance (1) (1) These devices should be placed near the device they are bypassing, but preference should be given to the placement of the high-speed (HS) bypass capacitors. 8.13.2.2.7 High-Speed Bypass Capacitors High-speed (HS) bypass capacitors are critical for proper DDR2 interface operation. It is particularly important to minimize the parasitic series inductance of the HS bypass capacitors, processor/DDR power, and processor/DDR ground connections. Table 8-53 contains the specification for the HS bypass capacitors as well as for the power connections on the PCB. Due to the number of required bypass capacitors, it is recommended that the bypass capacitors are placed before routing the board. 224 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-53. High-Speed Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 HS bypass capacitor package size (1) 2 Distance from HS bypass capacitor to device being bypassed 3 Number of connection vias for each HS bypass capacitor (2) 2 4 Trace length from bypass capacitor contact to connection via 1 5 Number of connection vias for each processor power/ground ball 1 6 Trace length from processor power/ground ball to connection via 7 Number of connection vias for each DDR2 device power/ground ball 8 Trace length from DDR2 device power/ground ball to connection via 9 DVDD18 HS bypass capacitor count (3) 20 10 DVDD18 HS bypass capacitor total capacitance 1.2 11 DDR device HS bypass capacitor count (4) (5) 12 DDR device HS bypass capacitor total capacitance (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) MAX UNIT 0402 10 Mils 250 Mils Vias 30 Mils Vias 35 Mils 1 Vias 35 8 Mils Devices μF Devices 0.4 μF LxW, 10-mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40x20-mil surface-mount capacitor. An additional HS bypass capacitor can share the connection vias only if it is mounted on the opposite side of the board. These devices should be placed as close as possible to the device being bypassed. These devices should be placed as close as possible to the device being bypassed. Per DDR device. 8.13.2.2.8 Net Classes Table 8-54 lists the clock net classes for the DDR2 interface. Table 8-55 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for the signals in the DDR2 interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. Table 8-54. Clock Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS PROCESSOR PIN NAMES CK DDR[0]_CLK/DDR[0]_CLK (1) DQS0 DDR[0]_DQS[0]/DDR[0]_DQS[0] DQS1 DDR[0]_DQS[1]/DDR[0]_DQS[1] DQS2 (1) DDR[0]_DQS[2]/DDR[0]_DQS[2] DQS3 (1) DDR[0]_DQS[3]/DDR[0]_DQS[3] Only used on 32-bit wide DDR2 memory systems. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 225 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-55. Signal Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 DDR[0]_D[7:0], DDR[0]_DQM[0] DQ1 DQS1 DDR[0]_D[15:8], DDR[0]_DQM[1] DQ2 (1) DQS2 DDR[0]_D[23:16], DDR[0]_DQM[2] (1) DQS3 DDR[0]_D[31:24], DDR[0]_DQM[3] DQ3 (1) PROCESSOR PIN NAMES DDR[0]_BA[2:0], DDR[0]_A[15:0], DDR[0]_CS[x], DDR[0]_CAS, DDR[0]_RAS, DDR[0]_WE, DDR[0]_CKE, DDR[0]_ODT[0] Only used on 32-bit wide DDR2 memory systems. 8.13.2.2.9 DDR2 Signal Termination Signal terminators are required in CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. Serial terminators may be used on data lines to reduce EMI risk; however, serial terminations are the only type permitted. ODT's are integrated on the data byte net classes. They should be enabled to ensure signal integrity.Table 8-56 shows the specifications for the series terminators. Table 8-56. DDR2 Signal Terminations NO. 1 PARAMETER TYP 0 (1) (2) (3) (4) 2 ADDR_CTRL net class 3 Data byte net classes (DQS0-DQS3, DQ0-DQ3) (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) MIN CK net class (1) (2) 0 0 22 MAX UNIT 10 Ω Zo Ω Zo Ω Only series termination is permitted, parallel or SST specifically disallowed on board. Only required for EMI reduction. Terminator values larger than typical only recommended to address EMI issues. Termination value should be uniform across net class. No external terminations allowed for data byte net classes. ODT is to be used. 8.13.2.2.10 VREFSSTL_DDR Routing VREFSSTL_DDR is used as a reference by the input buffers of the DDR2 memories as well as the processor. VREF is intended to be half the DDR2 power supply voltage and should be created using a resistive divider as shown in Figure 8-49. Other methods of creating VREF are not recommended. Figure 8-52 shows the layout guidelines for VREF. VREF Nominal Max Trace width is 20 mils VREF Bypass Capacitor A1 + DDR2 Device A1 + DDR2 Controller Neck down to minimum in BGA escape regions is acceptable. Narrowing to accomodate via congestion for short distances is also acceptable. Best performance is obtained if the width of VREF is maximized. Figure 8-52. VREF Routing and Topology 226 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.2.3 DDR2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Figure 8-53 shows the topology of the routing for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The route is a balanced T as it is intended that the length of segments B and C be equal. In addition, the length of A (A'+A'') should be maximized. A1 A1 C B T A´ DDR2 Controller A´´ A = A´ + A´´ Figure 8-53. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing and Topology Table 8-57. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification NO. PARAMETER MIN (1) TYP MAX UNIT 1 Center-to-center CK-CK spacing 2w 2 CK/CK skew (1) 25 Mils 3 CK A-to-B/A-to-C skew length mismatch (2) 25 Mils 4 CK B-to-C skew length mismatch 25 Mils 5 Center-to-center CK to other DDR2 trace spacing (3) 6 CK/ADDR_CTRL nominal trace length (4) CACLM+50 Mils 7 ADDR_CTRL-to-CK skew length mismatch 100 Mils 8 ADDR_CTRL-to-ADDR_CTRL skew length mismatch 100 Mils 9 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other DDR2 trace spacing (3) 4w 10 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing (3) 3w 11 ADDR_CTRL A-to-B/A-to-C skew length mismatch (2) 100 Mils 12 ADDR_CTRL B-to-C skew length mismatch 100 Mils (1) (2) (3) (4) 4w CACLM-50 CACLM The length of segment A = A' + A′′ as shown in Figure 8-53. Series terminator, if used, should be located closest to the device. Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. CACLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 227 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Figure 8-54 shows the topology and routing for the DQS and DQ net classes; the routes are point to point. Skew matching across bytes is not needed nor recommended. A1 T A1 T E0 E2 T T E1 DDR2 Controller E3 Figure 8-54. DQS and DQ Routing and Topology 228 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-58. DQS and DQ Routing Specification NO. PARAMETER 1 Center-to-center DQS-DQSn spacing in E0|E1|E2|E3 2 DQS-DQSn skew in E0|E1|E2|E3 3 Center-to-center DQS to other DDR2 trace spacing (1) 4 DQS/DQ nominal trace length 5 DQ-to-DQS skew length mismatch (2) (3) (4) 6 DQ-to-DQ skew length mismatch (2) (3) (4) MIN (2) (3) (4) DQLM-50 DQLM (2) (3) (4) DQ-to-DQ/DQS via count mismatch Center-to-center DQ to other DDR2 trace spacing (1) (5) 4w 9 Center-to-center DQ to other DQ trace spacing (1) (6) (7) 3w DQ/DQS E skew length mismatch UNIT 25 Mils DQLM+50 Mils 100 Mils 100 Mils 1 Vias 100 Mils 4w 8 10 MAX 2w 7 (1) TYP (2) (3) (4) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 500 mils of routed length to accommodate BGA escape and routing congestion. A 16-bit DDR memory system has two sets of data net classes; one for data byte 0, and one for data byte 1, each with an associated DQS (2 DQSs) per DDR EMIF used. A 32-bit DDR memory system has four sets of data net classes; one each for data bytes 0 through 3, and each associated with a DQS (4 DQSs) per DDR EMIF used. There is no need, and it is not recommended, to skew match across data bytes; that is, from DQS0 and data byte 0 to DQS1 and data byte 1. DQs from other DQS domains are considered other DDR2 trace. DQs from other data bytes are considered other DDR2 trace. DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of each of the DQS and DQ net classes. (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) 8.13.3 DDR3/DDR3L Routing Specifications 8.13.3.1 Board Designs TI only supports board designs utilizing DDR3/DDR3L memory that follow the guidelines in this document. The switching characteristics and timing diagram for the DDR3/DDR3L memory controller are shown in Table 8-59 and Figure 8-55. For the remainder of this section, DDR3 refers to both DDR3 and DDR3L. Table 8-59. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller NO. 1 (1) -1G PARAMETER tc(DDR_CLK) Cycle time, DDR_CLK MIN MAX 1.876 3.3 (1) UNIT ns This is the absolute maximum the clock period can be. Actual maximum clock period may be limited by DDR3 speed grade and operating frequency (see the DDR2/3 Memory Controller chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual). 1 DDR_CLK Figure 8-55. DDR3 Memory Controller Clock Timing 8.13.3.1.1 DDR3 versus DDR2 This specification only covers device PCB designs that utilize DDR3 memory. Designs using DDR2 memory should use the PCB design specifications for DDR2 memory in Section 8.13.2. While similar, the two memory systems have different requirements. It is currently not possible to design one PCB that covers both DDR2 and DDR3. 8.13.3.2 DDR3 Device Combinations Since there are several possible combinations of device counts and single- or dual-side mounting, Table 8-60 summarizes the supported device configurations. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 229 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-60. Supported DDR3 Device Combinations NUMBER OF DDR3 DEVICES DDR3 DEVICE WIDTH (BITS) MIRRORED? DDR3 EMIF WIDTH (BITS) 1 16 N 16 2 8 Y (1) 16 2 16 N 32 (1) (2) Y (1) 2 16 4 8 N 32 32 4 8 Y (2) 32 Two DDR3 devices are mirrored when one device is placed on the top of the board and the second device is placed on the bottom of the board. This is two mirrored pairs of DDR3 devices. 8.13.3.3 DDR3 Interface Schematic 8.13.3.3.1 32-Bit DDR3 Interface The DDR3 interface schematic varies, depending upon the width of the DDR3 devices used and the width of the bus used (16 or 32 bits). General connectivity is straightforward and very similar. 16-bit DDR devices look like two 8-bit devices. Figure 8-56 and Figure 8-57 show the schematic connections for 32-bit interfaces using x16 devices. 8.13.3.3.2 16-Bit DDR3 Interface Note that the 16-bit wide interface schematic is practically identical to the 32-bit interface (see Figure 8-56 and Figure 8-57); only the high-word DDR memories are removed and the unused DQS inputs are tied off. The processor DDR[0]_DQS[2] and DDR[0]_DQS[3] pins should be pulled to the DDR supply via 1-kΩ resistors. Similarly, the DDR[0]_DQS[2] and DDR[0]_DQS[3] pins should be pulled to ground via 1-kΩ resistors. When not using a DDR interface, the proper method of handling the unused pins is to tie off the DDR[0]_DQS[n] pins to the corresponding DVDD_DDR[0] supply via a 1-kΩ resistor and pulling the DDR[0]_DQS[n] pins to ground via a 1k-Ω resistor. This needs to be done for each byte not used. Although these signals have internal pullups and pulldowns, external pullups and pulldowns provide additional protection against external electrical noise causing activity on the signals. Also, include the 50-Ω pulldown for DDR[0]_VTP. The DVDD_DDR[0] and VREFSSTL_DDR[0] power supply pins must be connected to their respective power supplies even if DDR[0] is not used. All other DDR interface pins can be left unconnected. Note that the supported modes for use of the DDR EMIF are 32 bits wide, 16 bits wide, or not used. 230 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 32-bit DDR3 EMIF 16-Bit DDR3 Devices DDR[0]_D[31] DQ15 8 DDR[0]_D[24] DQ8 DDR[0]_DQM[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] UDM UDQS UDQS DDR[0]_D[23] DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[16] D08 DDR[0]_DQM[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] LDM LDQS LDQS DDR[0]_D[15] DQ15 8 DDR[0]_D[8] DQ8 DDR[0]_DQM[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] UDM UDQS UDQS DDR[0]_D[7] DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[0] DQ0 DDR[0]_DQM[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] LDM LDQS LDQS DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_ODT[0] DDR[0]_CS[0] DDR[0]_BA[0] DDR[0]_BA[1] DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_A[0] Zo CK CK CK CK ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A0 Zo A15 A15 Zo CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA CAS RAS WE CKE RST 0.1 µF DVDD_DDR[0] Zo DDR_VTT 16 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0]_WE DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0]_RST ZQ VREFSSTL_DDR[0] 0.1 µF 0.1 µF DDR_VREF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA ZQ 0.1 µF DDR[0]_VTP 50 Ω (±2%) Zo ZQ Termination is required. See terminator comments. Value determined according to the DDR memory device data sheet. Figure 8-56. 32-Bit, One-Bank DDR3 Interface Schematic Using Two 16-Bit DDR3 Devices Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 231 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 32-bit DDR3 EMIF www.ti.com 8-Bit DDR3 Devices 8-Bit DDR3 Devices DDR[0]_D[31] DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[24] DQ0 DDR[0]_DQM[3] NC DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_DQS[3] DDR[0]_D[23] DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[16] DQ0 DDR[0]_DQM[2] NC DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_DQS[2] DDR[0]_D[15] DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[8] DQ0 DDR[0]_DQM[1] NC DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_DQS[1] DDR[0]_D[7] DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS DQ7 8 DDR[0]_D[0] DQ0 DDR[0]_DQM[0] NC DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_DQS[0] DDR[0]_CLK DDR[0]_CLK DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS Zo CK CK DDR[0]_ODT[0] DDR[0]_CS[0] DDR[0]_BA[0] DDR[0]_BA[1] DDR[0]_BA[2] DDR[0]_A[0] CK CK CK CK 0.1 µF CK CK DVDD_DDR[0] Zo ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A0 A0 A0 Zo A15 A15 A15 A15 Zo CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA CAS RAS WE CKE RST CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA CAS RAS WE CKE RST DDR_VTT 16 DDR[0]_A[15] DDR[0]_CAS DDR[0]_RAS DDR[0]_WE DDR[0]_CKE DDR[0]_RST ZQ VREFSSTL_DDR[0] 0.1 µF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA 0.1 µF 0.1 µF ZQ ZQ 0.1 µF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA DDR_VREF ZQ 0.1 µF DDR[0]_VTP 50 Ω (±2%) Zo ZQ Termination is required. See terminator comments. Value determined according to the DDR memory device data sheet. Figure 8-57. 32-Bit, One-Bank DDR3 Interface Schematic Using Four 8-Bit DDR3 Devices 232 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.3.4 Compatible DDR3 Devices Table 8-61 shows the parameters of the DDR3 devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the interface is compatible with DDR3 devices in the x8 or x16 widths. Table 8-61. Compatible DDR3 Devices (Per Interface) NO. MIN MAX 1 DDR3 device speed grade: ≤ 400 MHz clock rate (1) DDR3-800 (2) 2 DDR3 device speed grade: > 400 MHz clock rate (1) DDR3-1600 (2) 3 DDR3 device bit width x8 x16 2 4 4 (1) (2) (3) PARAMETER DDR3 device count (3) UNIT Bits Devices DDR3 speed grade depends on desired clock rate. Data rate is 2x the clock rate. For DDR3-800, the clock rate is 400 MHz. DDR3 devices with higher speed grades are supported; however, max clock rate will still be limited to 533 MHz as stated in Table 8-59 Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller. For valid DDR3 device configurations and device counts, see Section 8.13.3.3, Figure 8-56, and Figure 8-57. 8.13.3.5 PCB Stackup The minimum stackup for routing the DDR3 interface is a four-layer stack up as shown in Table 8-62. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry, enhance SI/EMI performance, or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. A six-layer stackup is shown in Table 8-63. Complete stackup specifications are provided in Table 8-64. Table 8-62. Minimum PCB Stackup LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top routing mostly vertical 2 Plane Split power plane 3 Plane Full ground plane 4 Signal Bottom routing mostly horizontal Table 8-63. Six-Layer PCB Stackup Suggestion LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top routing mostly vertical 2 Plane Ground 3 Plane Split power plane 4 Plane Split power plane or Internal routing 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal Bottom routing mostly horizontal Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 233 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-64. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. MIN TYP 1 PCB routing/plane layers PARAMETER 4 6 2 Signal routing layers 2 3 Full ground reference layers under DDR3 routing region (1) MAX 1 (1) 4 Full 1.35-V/1.5-V power reference layers under the DDR3 routing region 5 Number of reference plane cuts allowed within DDR routing region (2) 0 6 Number of layers between DDR3 routing layer and reference plane (3) 0 7 PCB feature spacing 4 8 PCB trace width, w 4 9 PCB BGA escape via pad size (4) 10 PCB BGA escape via hole size 10 11 Processor BGA pad size 0.4 13 Single-ended impedance, Zo 14 Impedance control (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) UNIT 1 18 50 Z-5 Z Mils Mils 20 Mils Mils mm 75 Ω Z+5 Ω Ground reference layers are preferred over power reference layers. Be sure to include bypass caps to accommodate reference layer return current as the trace routes switch routing layers. No traces should cross reference plane cuts within the DDR routing region. High-speed signal traces crossing reference plane cuts create large return current paths which can lead to excessive crosstalk and EMI radiation. Reference planes are to be directly adjacent to the signal plane to minimize the size of the return current loop. An 18-mil pad assumes Via Channel is the most economical BGA escape. A 20-mil pad may be used if additional layers are available for power routing. An 18-mil pad is required for minimum layer count escape. Z is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by item 13. 8.13.3.6 Placement Figure 8-58 shows the required placement for the processor as well as the DDR3 devices. The dimensions for this figure are defined in Table 8-65. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB on which the devices are mounted. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For a 16-bit DDR memory system, the high-word DDR3 devices are omitted from the placement. X1 X2 X2 X2 DDR3 Controller Y Figure 8-58. Placement Specifications 234 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-65. Placement Specifications NO. (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) PARAMETER MIN 1 X1 (1) (2) (3) 2 X2 (1) (2) 3 Y Offset (1) (2) (3) 4 DDR3 keepout region 5 Clearance from non-DDR3 signal to DDR3 keepout region (4) (5) MAX UNIT 1000 Mils 600 Mils 1500 Mils 4 w For dimension definitions, see Figure 8-58. Measurements from center of processor to center of DDR3 device. Minimizing X1 and Y improves timing margins. w is defined as the signal trace width. Non-DDR3 signals allowed within DDR3 keepout region provided they are separated from DDR3 routing layers by a ground plane. 8.13.3.7 DDR3 Keepout Region The region of the PCB used for DDR3 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The DDR3 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 8-59. The size of this region varies with the placement and DDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keepout region are shown in Table 865. Non-DDR3 signals should not be routed on the DDR signal layers within the DDR3 keepout region. Non-DDR3 signals may be routed in the region, provided they are routed on layers separated from the DDR signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the 1.35-V/1.5-V DDR3L/DDR3 power plane should cover the entire keepout region. Also note that the DDR3 controller's signals should be separated from each other by the specification in item 5 (see Table 8-65 for item 5 specification). DDR3 Controller DDR[0] Keep Out Region Encompasses Entire DDR[0] Routing Area Figure 8-59. DDR3 Keepout Region 8.13.3.8 Bulk Bypass Capacitors Bulk bypass capacitors are required for moderate speed bypassing of the DDR3 and other circuitry. Table 8-66 contains the minimum numbers and capacitance required for the bulk bypass capacitors. Note that this table only covers the bypass needs of the DDR3 controller and DDR3 devices. Additional bulk bypass capacitance may be needed for other circuitry. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 235 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-66. Bulk Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 DVDD_DDR[0] bulk bypass capacitor count (1) 6 2 DVDD_DDR[0] bulk bypass total capacitance 140 (1) MAX UNIT Devices μF These devices should be placed near the devices they are bypassing, but preference should be given to the placement of the highspeed (HS) bypass capacitors and DDR3 signal routing. 8.13.3.9 High-Speed Bypass Capacitors High-speed (HS) bypass capacitors are critical for proper DDR3 interface operation. It is particularly important to minimize the parasitic series inductance of the HS bypass capacitors, processor/DDR power, and processor/DDR ground connections. Table 8-67 contains the specification for the HS bypass capacitors as well as for the power connections on the PCB. Generally speaking, it is good to: 1. Fit as many HS bypass capacitors as possible. Due to the number of required bypass capacitors, it is recommended that the bypass capacitors are placed before routing the board. 2. Minimize the distance from the bypass cap to the pins/balls being bypassed. 3. Use the smallest physical sized capacitors possible with the highest capacitance readily available. 4. Connect the bypass capacitor pads to their vias using the widest traces possible and using the largest hole size via possible. 5. Minimize via sharing. Note the limits on via sharing shown in Table 8-67. Table 8-67. High-Speed Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 HS bypass capacitor package size (1) 2 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to processor being bypassed (2) (3) (4) 3 Processor DVDD_DDR[0] HS bypass capacitor count 35 4 Processor DVDD_DDR[0] HS bypass capacitor total capacitance 2.5 5 Number of connection vias for each device power/ground ball (5) 6 Trace length from device power/ground ball to connection via (2) 7 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to DDR device being bypassed (6) 8 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor count (7) 9 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor total capacitance (7) TYP MAX UNIT 201 402 10 Mils 400 Mils Devices μF Vias 35 70 150 12 (8) (9) 10 Number of connection vias for each HS capacitor 11 Trace length from bypass capacitor connect to connection via (2) (9) 12 Number of connection vias for each DDR3 device power/ground ball (10) 13 Trace length from DDR3 device power/ground ball to connection via (2) (8) Mils Mils Devices μF 0.85 2 Vias 35 100 1 Mils Vias 35 60 Mils (1) (2) (3) (4) LxW, 10-mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40x20-mil surface-mount capacitor. Closer/shorter is better. Measured from the nearest processor power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. Three of these capacitors should be located underneath the processor, between the cluster of DVDD_DDR[0] balls and ground balls, between the DDR interfaces on the package. (5) See the Via Channel™ escape for the processor package. (6) Measured from the DDR3 device power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (7) Per DDR3 device. (8) An additional HS bypass capacitor can share the connection vias only if it is mounted on the opposite side of the board. No sharing of vias is permitted on the same side of the board. (9) An HS bypass capacitor may share a via with a DDR device mounted on the same side of the PCB. A wide trace should be used for the connection and the length from the capacitor pad to the DDR device pad should be less than 150 mils. (10) Up to a total of two pairs of DDR power/ground balls may share a via. 236 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.3.9.1 Return Current Bypass Capacitors Use additional bypass capacitors if the return current reference plane changes due to DDR3 signals hopping from one signal layer to another. The bypass capacitor here provides a path for the return current to hop planes along with the signal. As many of these return current bypass capacitors should be used as possible. Since these are returns for signal current, the signal via size may be used for these capacitors. 8.13.3.10 Net Classes Table 8-68 lists the clock net classes for the DDR3 interface. Table 8-69 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for signals in the DDR3 interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. Table 8-68. Clock Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS PROCESSOR PIN NAMES CK DDR[0]_CLK/DDR[0]_CLK DQS0 DDR[0]_DQS[0]/DDR[0]_DQS[0] DQS1 DDR[0]_DQS[1]/DDR[0]_DQS[1] (1) DDR[0]_DQS[2]/DDR[0]_DQS[2] DQS3 (1) DDR[0]_DQS[3]/DDR[0]_DQS[3] DQS2 (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. Table 8-69. Signal Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 DDR[0]_D[7:0], DDR[0]_DQM[0] DQ1 DQS1 DDR[0]_D[15:8], DDR[0]_DQM[1] DQ2 (1) DQS2 DDR[0]_D[23:16], DDR[0]_DQM[2] (1) DQS3 DDR[0]_D[31:24], DDR[0]_DQM[3] DQ3 (1) PROCESSOR PIN NAMES DDR[0]_BA[2:0], DDR[0]_A[15:0], DDR[0]_CS[x], DDR[0]_CAS, DDR[0]_RAS, DDR[0]_WE, DDR[0]_CKE, DDR[0]_ODT[0] Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. 8.13.3.11 DDR3 Signal Termination Signal terminators are required for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The data lines are terminated by ODT and, thus, the PCB traces should be unterminated. Detailed termination specifications are covered in the routing rules in the following sections. 8.13.3.12 VREFSSTL_DDR Routing VREFSSTL_DDR (VREF) is used as a reference by the input buffers of the DDR3 memories as well as the processor. VREF is intended to be half the DDR3 power supply voltage and is typically generated with the DDR3 1.35-V/1.5-V and VTT power supply. It should be routed as a nominal 20-mil wide trace with 0.1 µF bypass capacitors near each device connection. Narrowing of VREF is allowed to accommodate routing congestion. 8.13.3.13 VTT Like VREF, the nominal value of the VTT supply is half the DDR3 supply voltage. Unlike VREF, VTT is expected to source and sink current, specifically the termination current for the ADDR_CTRL net class Thevinen terminators. VTT is needed at the end of the address bus and it should be routed as a power sub-plane. VTT should be bypassed near the terminator resistors. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 237 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.13.3.14 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies and Routing Definition The CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes are routed similarly and are length matched to minimize skew between them. CK is a bit more complicated because it runs at a higher transition rate and is differential. The following subsections show the topology and routing for various DDR3 configurations for CK and ADDR_CTRL. The figures in the following subsections define the terms for the routing specification detailed in Table 8-70. 8.13.3.14.1 Four DDR3 Devices Four DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of four x8 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS). These four devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in two pairs to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. 8.13.3.14.1.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Four DDR3 Devices Figure 8-60 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-61 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. + – + – + – + – AS+ AS- AS+ AS- AS+ AS- AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers Clock Parallel Terminator Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 A3 A4 DVDD_DDR[0] AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 A3 A4 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair Figure 8-60. CK Topology for Four x8 DDR3 Devices Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 A3 A4 AS AS AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers A3 Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT Figure 8-61. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Four x8 DDR3 Devices 8.13.3.14.1.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Four DDR3 Devices Figure 8-62 shows the CK routing for four DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-63 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. 238 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 A1 A1 www.ti.com DVDD_DDR[0] A3 A3 = A3 A3 A4 A4 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 A1 Figure 8-62. CK Routing for Four Single-Side DDR3 Devices Rtt A3 = A4 A3 AT Vtt AS A2 Figure 8-63. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Four Single-Side DDR3 Devices To save PCB space, the four DDR3 memories may be mounted as two mirrored pairs at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 8-64 and Figure 8-65 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for four DDR3 devices mirrored in a two-pair configuration. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 239 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com A1 A1 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DVDD_DDR[0] A3 A3 = A3 A3 A4 A4 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 A1 Figure 8-64. CK Routing for Four Mirrored DDR3 Devices Rtt = A4 A3 AT Vtt AS A3 A2 Figure 8-65. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Four Mirrored DDR3 Devices 8.13.3.14.2 Two DDR3 Devices Two DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of two x8 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide, or two x16 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 32 bits wide. These two devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in a pair to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. 8.13.3.14.2.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Two DDR3 Devices Figure 8-66 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-67 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. 240 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 + – + – AS+ AS- AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers Clock Parallel Terminator Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 DVDD_DDR[0] AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair Figure 8-66. CK Topology for Two DDR3 Devices Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers A3 Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT Figure 8-67. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Two DDR3 Devices 8.13.3.14.2.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Two DDR3 Devices Figure 8-68 shows the CK routing for two DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-69 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 241 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com A1 A1 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 DVDD_DDR[0] A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 A1 Figure 8-68. CK Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices Rtt A3 = AT Vtt AS A2 Figure 8-69. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices To save PCB space, the two DDR3 memories may be mounted as a mirrored pair at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 8-70 and Figure 8-71 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for two DDR3 devices mirrored in a single-pair configuration. 242 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 A1 A1 www.ti.com DVDD_DDR[0] A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 A1 Figure 8-70. CK Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices Rtt = AT Vtt AS A3 A2 Figure 8-71. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices 8.13.3.14.3 One DDR3 Device A single DDR3 device is supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of one x16 DDR3 device arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide. 8.13.3.14.3.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, One DDR3 Device Figure 8-72 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-73 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 243 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com DDR Differential CK Input Buffer AS+ AS- + – Clock Parallel Terminator DVDD_DDR[0] Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer AT A2 Cac + – Rcp A1 0.1 µF AT A2 Routed as Differential Pair Figure 8-72. CK Topology for One DDR3 Device AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A2 Address and Control Terminator Rtt AT Vtt Figure 8-73. ADDR_CTRL Topology for One DDR3 Device 8.13.3.14.3.2 CK and ADDR/CTRL Routing, One DDR3 Device Figure 8-74 shows the CK routing for one DDR3 device placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-75 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. 244 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 A1 A1 www.ti.com DVDD_DDR[0] Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT = AS+ AS- A2 A2 A1 Figure 8-74. CK Routing for One DDR3 Device Rtt AT = Vtt AS A2 Figure 8-75. ADDR_CTRL Routing for One DDR3 Device 8.13.3.15 Data Topologies and Routing Definition No matter the number of DDR3 devices used, the data line topology is always point to point, so its definition is simple. 8.13.3.15.1 DQS and DQ/DM Topologies, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices DQS lines are point-to-point differential, and DQ/DM lines are point-to-point singled ended. Figure 8-76 and Figure 8-77 show these topologies. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 245 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Processor DQS IO Buffer DDR DQS IO Buffer DQSn+ DQSnRouted Differentially n = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 8-76. DQS Topology Processor DQ and DM IO Buffer DDR DQ and DM IO Buffer Dn n = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 8-77. DQ/DM Topology 8.13.3.15.2 DQS and DQ/DM Routing, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Figure 8-78 and Figure 8-79 show the DQS and DQ/DM routing. DQS DQSn+ DQSn- Routed Differentially n = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 8-78. DQS Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Dn DQ and DM n = 0, 1, 2, 3 Figure 8-79. DQ/DM Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices 246 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.13.3.16 Routing Specification 8.13.3.16.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification Skew within the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and, thus, this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. A metric to establish this maximum length is Manhattan distance. The Manhattan distance between two points on a PCB is the length between the points when connecting them only with horizontal or vertical segments. A reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. CACLM is defined as Clock Address Control Longest Manhattan distance. Given the clock and address pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 8-80 and Figure 8-81 show this distance for four loads and two loads, respectively. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the address bus are determined. CACLM is determined similarly for other address bus configurations; that is, it is based on the longest net of the CK/ADDR_CTRL net class. For CK and ADDR_CTRL routing, these specifications are contained in Table 8-70. (A) A1 A8 CACLMY CACLMX A8 (A) A8 (A) A8 (A) A8 (A) Rtt A3 = A. A4 A3 AT Vtt AS A2 It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 8-80. CACLM for Four Address Loads on One Side of PCB Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 247 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 (A) A1 A8 www.ti.com CACLMY CACLMX A8 (A) A8 (A) Rtt A3 = A. AT Vtt AS A2 It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 8-81. CACLM for Two Address Loads on One Side of PCB Table 8-70. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification (1) (2) NO. PARAMETER MIN TYP MAX UNIT 2500 mils 25 mils 660 mils 1 A1+A2 length 2 A1+A2 skew 3 A3 length 4 A3 skew (3) 25 mils 5 A3 skew (4) 125 mils 6 A4 length 660 mils 7 A4 skew 25 mils 8 AS length 100 mils 9 AS skew 100 mils 10 AS+/AS- length 70 mils 11 AS+/AS- skew 5 mils (5) 12 AT length 13 AT skew (6) 14 AT skew (7) 15 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) 248 CK/ADDR_CTRL nominal trace length 500 mils 100 (8) CACLM-50 CACLM mils 5 mils CACLM+50 mils The use of vias should be minimized. Additional bypass capacitors are required when using the DVDD_DDR[0] plane as the reference plane to allow the return current to jump between the DVDD_DDR[0] plane and the ground plane when the net class switches layers at a via. Non-mirrored configuration (all DDR3 memories on same side of PCB). Mirrored configuration (one DDR3 device on top of the board and one DDR3 device on the bottom). While this length can be increased for convenience, its length should be minimized. ADDR_CTRL net class only (not CK net class). Minimizing this skew is recommended, but not required. CK net class only. CACLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes + 300 mils. For definition, see Section 8.13.3.16.1, Figure 8-80, and Figure 8-81. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-70. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification(1)(2) (continued) NO. PARAMETER MIN 16 Center-to-center CK to other DDR3 trace spacing (9) 4w 17 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other DDR3 trace spacing (9) (10) 4w 18 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing (9) 3w 19 CK center-to-center spacing (11) 20 CK spacing to other net (9) 21 Rcp (12) Zo-1 22 Rtt (12) (13) Zo-5 (9) (10) (11) (12) (13) TYP MAX UNIT Zo Zo+ Ω Zo Zo+5 Ω 4w Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 1250 mils of routed length. The ADDR_CTRL net class of the other DDR EMIF is considered other DDR3 trace spacing. CK spacing set to ensure proper differential impedance. Source termination (series resistor at driver) is specifically not allowed. Termination values should be uniform across the net class. 8.13.3.16.2 DQS and DQ Routing Specification Skew within the DQS and DQ/DM net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and thus this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. As with CK and ADDR_CTRL, a reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. DQLMn is defined as DQ Longest Manhattan distance n, where n is the byte number. For a 32-bit interface, there are four DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM3. Likewise, for a 16-bit interface, there are two DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM1. NOTE It is not required, nor is it recommended, to match the lengths across all bytes. Length matching is only required within each byte. Given the DQS and DQ/DM pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 8-82 shows this distance for four loads. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the data bus are determined. For DQS and DQ/DM routing, these specifications are contained in Table 8-71. DQLMX0 DB0 DB1 DQ[0:7]/DM0/DQS0 DQ[8:15]/DM1/DQS1 DQLMX1 DQ[16:23]/DM2/DQS2 DB2 DQLMY0 DQLMX2 DQLMY3 DQLMY2 DB3 DQLMY1 DQ[23:31]/DM3/DQS3 DQLMX3 3 2 1 0 DB0 - DB3 represent data bytes 0 - 3. There are four DQLMs, one for each byte (32-bit interface). Each DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the byte; therefore: DQLM0 = DQLMX0 + DQLMY0 DQLM1 = DQLMX1 + DQLMY1 DQLM2 = DQLMX2 + DQLMY2 DQLM3 = DQLMX3 + DQLMY3 Figure 8-82. DQLM for Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 249 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-71. Data Routing Specification (1) NO. MAX UNIT 1 DB0 nominal length (2) (3) PARAMETER MIN DQLM0 mils 2 DB1 nominal length (2) (4) DQLM1 mils 3 DB2 nominal length (2) (5) DQLM2 mils 4 DB3 nominal length (2) (6) DQLM3 mils 5 DBn skew (7) 25 mils 6 DQSn+ to DQSn- skew 5 mils 25 mils (7) (8) 7 DQSn to DBn skew 8 Center-to-center DBn to other DDR3 trace spacing (9) (10) 4w 9 Center-to-center DBn to other DBn trace spacing (9) (11) 3w (12) 10 DQSn center-to-center spacing 11 DQSn center-to-center spacing to other net(9) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) (12) 250 TYP 4w External termination disallowed. Data termination should use built-in ODT functionality. DQLMn is the longest Manhattan distance of a byte. r definition, see Section 8.13.3.16.2 and Figure 8-82. DQLM0 is the longest Manhattan length for the net classes of Byte 0. DQLM1 is the longest Manhattan length for the net classes of Byte 1. DQLM2 is the longest Manhattan length for the net classes of Byte 2. DQLM3 is the longest Manhattan length for the net classes of Byte 3. Length matching is only done within a byte. Length matching across bytes is neither required nor recommended. Each DQS pair is length matched to its associated byte. Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum (2w) for up to 1250 mils of routed length. Other DDR3 trace spacing means other DDR3 net classes not within the byte. This applies to spacing within the net classes of a byte. DQS pair spacing is set to ensure proper differential impedance. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.14 Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) The multichannel audio serial port (McASP) functions as a general-purpose audio serial port optimized for the needs of multichannel audio applications. The McASP is useful for time-division multiplexed (TDM) stream, Inter-Integrated Sound (I2S) protocols, and inter-component digital audio interface transmission (DIT). 8.14.1 McASP Device-Specific Information The device includes two multichannel audio serial port (McASP) interface peripherals (McASP0 and McASP1). The McASP module consists of a transmit and receive section. These sections can operate completely independently with different data formats, separate master clocks, bit clocks, and frame syncs or, alternatively, the transmit and receive sections may be synchronized. The McASP module also includes shift registers that may be configured to operate as either transmit data or receive data. The transmit section of the McASP can transmit data in either a time-division-multiplexed (TDM) synchronous serial format or in a digital audio interface (DIT) format where the bit stream is encoded for S/PDIF, AES-3, IEC-60958, CP-430 transmission. The receive section of the McASP peripheral supports the TDM synchronous serial format. The McASP module can support one transmit data format (either a TDM format or DIT format) and one receive format at a time. All transmit shift registers use the same format and all receive shift registers use the same format; however, the transmit and receive formats need not be the same. Both the transmit and receive sections of the McASP also support burst mode, which is useful for non-audio data (for example, passing control information between two devices). The McASP peripheral has additional capability for flexible clock generation and error detection/handling, as well as error management. The device McASP0 module has up to 6 serial data pins, while McASP1 has 2 serial data pins. The McASP FIFO size is 256 bytes and two DMA and two interrupt requests are supported. Buffers are used transparently to better manage DMA, which can be leveraged to manage data flow more efficiently. For more detailed information on and the functionality of the McASP peripheral, see the Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.14.2 McASP0 and McASP1 Peripheral Registers Descriptions The McASP0 and McASP1 peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 251 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.14.3 McASP (McASP[1:0]) Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-72. Timing Requirements for McASP (1) (see Figure 8-83) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN 1 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, MCA[x]_AHCLKR/X 2 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, MCA[x]_AHCLKR/X high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, MCA[x]_ACLKR/X 4 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, MCA[x]_ACLKR/X high or low 5 tsu(AFSRX-ACLKRX) Setup time, MCA[x]_AFSR/X input valid before MCA[X]_ACLKR/X ACLKR/X int ACLKR/X int th(ACLKRX-AFSRX) Hold time, MCA[x]_AFSR/X input valid after MCA[X]_ACLKR/X ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X int tsu(AXR-ACLKRX) Setup time, MCA[x]_AXR input valid before MCA[X]_ACLKR/X ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X int (1) (2) (3) 252 th(ACLKRX-AXR) Hold time, MCA[x]_AXR input valid after MCA[X]_ACLKR/X 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns 0.5R 2.5 (3) ns 4 ns 4 1 ns 1 10.5 ACLKR/X ext out 8 ns -1 ACLKR/X ext out 7 20 10.5 ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 6 UNIT MAX 4 ns 4 -1 ACLKR/X ext in 1 ACLKR/X ext out 1 ns ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 P = MCA[x]_AHCLKR/X period in nano seconds (ns). R = MCA[x]_ACLKR/X period in ns. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 2 1 2 MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (Falling Edge Polarity) MCA[x]_AHCLKR/X (Rising Edge Polarity) 4 4 3 MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0) MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1) (A) (B) 6 5 MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) 8 7 MCA[x]_AXR[x] (Data In/Receive) A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). C31 Figure 8-83. McASP Input Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 253 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com Table 8-73. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP (1) (see Figure 8-84) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN 9 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, MCA[X]_AHCLKR/X 10 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, MCA[X]_AHCLKR/X high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, MCA[X]_ACLKR/X 12 13 tw(ACLKRX) td(ACLKRX-AFSRX) Pulse duration, MCA[X]_ACLKR/X high or low Delay time, MCA[X]_ACLKR/X transmit edge to MCA[X]_AFSR/X output valid Delay time, MCA[X]_ACLKR/X transmit edge to MCA[X]_AFSR/X output valid with Pad Loopback 14 td(ACLKX-AXR) Delay time, MCA[X]_ACLKX transmit edge to MCA[X]_AXR output valid Delay time, MCA[X]_ACLKX transmit edge to MCA[X]_AXR output valid with Pad Loopback Disable time, MCA[X]_ACLKX transmit edge to MCA[X]_AXR output high impedance 15 (1) (2) (3) 254 tdis(ACLKX-AXR) Disable time, MCA[X]_ACLKX transmit edge to MCA[X]_AXR output high impedance with Pad Loopback ACLKR/X int UNIT MAX 20 (2) ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns -2 5 ACLKR/X ext in 1 11.5 ACLKR/X ext out 1 11.5 ACLKX int -2 5 ACLKX ext in 1 11.5 ACLKX ext out 1 11.5 ACLKX int ACLKX ext in -2 5 1 11.5 ns ns ns ACLKX ext out 1 11.5 ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 50 MHz P = AHCLKR/X period. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 10 10 9 MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (Falling Edge Polarity) MCA[x]_AHCLKR/X (Rising Edge Polarity) 12 11 MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1) MCA[x]_ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0) 12 (A) (B) 13 13 13 13 MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) 13 13 13 MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) MCA[x]_AXR[x] (Data Out/Transmit) 14 15 A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 C31 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). Figure 8-84. McASP Output Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 255 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.15 MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output (MMC/SD/SDIO) The device includes 3 MMC/SD/SDIO Controllers which are compliant with MMC V4.3, Secure Digital Part 1 Physical Layer Specification V2.00 and Secure Digital Input Output (SDIO) V2.00 specifications. The device MMC/SD/SDIO Controller has the following features: • MultiMedia card (MMC) • Secure Digital (SD) memory card • MMC/SD protocol support • SDIO protocol support • Programmable clock frequency • 1024 byte read/write FIFO to lower system overhead • Slave EDMA transfer capability • SD High capacity support • SDXC card support – Supports only SDHC clock rates – Booting from SDXC cards is not supported 8.15.1 MMC/SD/SDIO Peripheral Register Descriptions The MMC/SD/SDIO peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.15.2 MMC/SD/SDIO Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-74. Timing Requirements for MMC/SD/SDIO (see Figure 8-86, Figure 8-88) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO . UNIT ALL MODES MIN MAX 1 tsu(CMDV-CLKH) Setup time, SD_CMD valid before SD_CLK rising clock edge 4.1 ns 2 th(CLKH-CMDV) Hold time, SD_CMD valid after SD_CLK rising clock edge 1.9 ns 3 tsu(DATV-CLKH) Setup time, SD_DATx valid before SD_CLK rising clock edge 4.1 ns 4 th(CLKH-DATV) Hold time, SD_DATx valid after SD_CLK rising clock edge 1.9 ns Table 8-75. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for MMC/SD/SDIO (see Figure 8-85 through Figure 8-88) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. PARAMETER MODES 3.3 V STD 1.8 V SDR12 MIN 7 8 9 10 (1) 256 fop(CLK) Operating frequency, SD_CLK tc(CLK) Operating period: SD_CLK fop(CLKID) Identification mode frequency, SD_CLK tc(CLKID) Identification mode period: SD_CLK tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, SD_CLK low tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, SD_CLK high UNIT 3.3 V HS 1.8 V SDR25 MAX MIN 24 41.7 MAX 48 20.8 400 MHz ns 400 kHz 2500.0 2500.0 ns 0.5*P (1) 0.5*P (1) ns (1) (1) ns 0.5*P 0.5*P P = SD_CLK period. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-75. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for MMC/SD/SDIO (continued) (see Figure 8-85 through Figure 8-88) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MODES PARAMETER 3.3 V STD 1.8 V SDR12 MIN UNIT 3.3 V HS 1.8 V SDR25 MAX MIN MAX 11 tr(CLK) Rise time, All Signals (10% to 90%) 2.2 2.2 ns 12 tf(CLK) Fall time, All Signals (10% to 90%) 2.2 2.2 ns 13 td(CLKL-CMD) Delay time, SD_CLK rising clock edge to SD_CMD transition -4 4 2.3 14 ns 14 td(CLKL-DAT) Delay time, SD_CLK rising clock edge to SD_DATx transition -4 4 2.3 14 ns 10 7 9 SDx_CLK 13 13 START SDx_CMD 13 13 XMIT Valid Valid Valid END Figure 8-85. MMC/SD/SDIO Host Command Timing 9 7 10 SDx_CLK 1 2 SDx_CMD START XMIT Valid Valid Valid END Figure 8-86. MMC/SD/SDIO Card Response Timing 10 9 7 SDx_CLK 14 14 START SDx_DAT[x] 14 14 D0 D1 Dx END Figure 8-87. MMC/SD/SDIO Host Write Timing 9 10 7 SDx_CLK 4 4 3 3 SDx_DAT[x] Start D0 D1 Dx End Figure 8-88. MMC/SD/SDIO Host Read and Card CRC Status Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 257 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.16 Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) The device supports connections to PCIe-compliant devices via the integrated PCIe master/slave bus interface. The PCIe module is comprised of a dual-mode PCIe core and a SerDes PHY. The device implements a single one-lane PCIe 2.0 (5.0 GT/s) Endpoint/Root Complex port. The device PCIe supports the following features: • Supports Gen1/Gen2 in x1 or x2 mode • One port with one 5 GT/s lane • Single virtual channel (VC), single traffic class (TC) • Single function in end-point mode • Automatic width and speed negotiation and lane reversal • Max payload: 128 byte outbound, 256 byte inbound • Automatic credit management • ECRC generation and checking • Configurable BAR filtering • Supports PCIe messages • Legacy interrupt reception (RC) and generation (EP) • MSI generation and reception • PCI device power management, except D3 cold with vaux • Active state power management state L0 and L1. For more detailed information on the PCIe port peripheral module, see the PCI Express (PCIe) Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. The PCIe peripheral on the device conforms to the PCI Express Base 2.0 Specification. Note: PCIe is supported on all DM385 devices and also on DM388 devices with PCIe enabled. 8.16.1 PCIe Peripheral Register Descriptions The PCIe peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). 8.16.2 PCIe Electrical Data/Timing Texas Instruments (TI) has performed the simulation and system characterization to ensure that the PCIe peripheral meets all AC timing specifications as required by the PCI Express Base 2.0 Specification. Therefore, the AC timing specifications are not reproduced here. For more information on the AC timing specifications, see Sections 4.3.3.5 and 4.3.4.4 of the PCI Express Base 2.0 Specification. 8.16.3 PCIe Design and Layout Guidelines 8.16.3.1 Clock Source A standard 100-MHz PCIe differential clock source must be used for PCIe operation (for more details, see Section 7.4.2, SERDES CLKN/P Input Clock). 8.16.3.2 PCIe Connections and Interface Compliance The PCIe interface on the device is compliant with the PCI Express Base 2.0 Specification. Refer to the PCIe specifications for all connections that are described in it. For coupling capacitor selection, see Section 8.16.3.2.1, Coupling Capacitors. The use of PCIe-compatible bridges and switches is allowed for interfacing with more than one other processor or PCIe device. 258 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.16.3.2.1 Coupling Capacitors AC coupling capacitors are required on the transmit data pair. Table 8-76 shows the requirements for these capacitors. Table 8-76. AC Coupling Capacitors Requirements PARAMETER MIN PCIe AC coupling capacitor value PCIe AC coupling capacitor package size (1) (1) (2) TYP 75 0402 MAX UNIT 200 nF 0603 EIA (2) The physical size of the capacitor should be as small as practical. Use the same size on both lines in each pair, placed side by side. EIA LxW units; that is, a 0402 is a 40x20 mil (thousandths of an inch) surface-mount capacitor. 8.16.3.2.2 Polarity Inversion The PCIe specification requires polarity inversion support. This means, for layout purposes, polarity is unimportant since each signal can change its polarity on-die inside the chip. This means polarity within a lane is unimportant for layout. 8.16.3.3 Non-Standard PCIe Connections The following sections contain suggestions for any PCIe connection that is not described in the official PCIe specification, such as an on-board device-to-device connection, or device-to-other PCIe-compliant processor connection. 8.16.3.3.1 PCB Stackup Specifications Table 8-77 shows the stackup and feature sizes required for these types of PCIe connections. Table 8-77. PCIe PCB Stackup Specifications MIN TYP MAX PCB Routing/Plane Layers PARAMETER 4 6 - Layers Signal Routing Layers 2 3 - Layers Number of ground plane cuts allowed within PCIe routing region - - 0 Cuts Number of layers between PCIe routing area and reference plane (1) - - 0 Layers PCB Routing clearance - 4 - Mils PCB Trace width (2) - 4 - Mils PCB BGA escape via pad size - 20 - Mils PCB BGA escape via hole size - 10 Mils 0.4 mm Processor BGA pad size (1) (2) (3) (4) (3) (4) UNIT A reference plane may be a ground plane or the power plane referencing the PCIe signals. In breakout area. Non-solder mask defined pad. Per IPC-7351A BGA pad size guideline. 8.16.3.3.2 Routing Specifications The PCIe data signal traces must be routed to achieve 100 Ω (±20%) differential impedance and 60 Ω (±15%) single-ended impedance. The single-ended impedance is required because differential signals are extremely difficult to closely couple on PCBs and, therefore, single-ended impedance becomes important. These requirements are the same as those recommended in the PCIe Motherboard Checklist 1.0 document, available from PCI-SIG. These impedances are impacted by trace width, trace spacing, distance between signals and referencing planes, and dielectric material. Verify with a PCB design tool that the trace geometry for both data signal pairs result in as close to 100 Ω differential impedance and 60 Ω single-ended impedance as possible. For best accuracy, work with your PCB fabricator to ensure this impedance is met. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 259 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com In general, closely coupled differential signal traces are not an advantage on PCBs. When differential signals are closely coupled, tight spacing and width control is necessary. Very small width and spacing variations affect impedance dramatically, so tight impedance control can be more problematic to maintain in production. Loosely coupled PCB differential signals make impedance control much easier. Wider traces and spacing make obstacle avoidance easier, and trace width variations do not affect impedance as much; therefore, it is easier to maintain an accurate impedance over the length of the signal. The wider traces also show reduced skin effect and, therefore, often result in better signal integrity. Table 8-78 shows the routing specifications for the PCIe data signals. Table 8-78. PCIe Routing Specifications MAX UNIT PCIe signal trace length PARAMETER MIN TYP 10 (1) Inches Differential pair trace matching 10 (2) Number of stubs allowed on PCIe traces (3) 0 TX/RX pair differential impedance 80 100 120 TX/RX single ended impedance 51 60 69 Mils Stubs Ω Ω Pad size of vias on PCIe trace 25 (4) Hole size of vias on PCIe trace 14 Mils 3 Vias (5) Number of vias on each PCIe trace 2*DS (6) PCIe differential pair to any other trace spacing (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) 260 Mils Beyond this, signal integrity may suffer. For example, RXP0 within 10 Mils of RXN0. In-line pads may be used for probing. 35-Mil antipad max recommended. Vias must be used in pairs with their distance minimized. DS = differential spacing of the PCIe traces. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.17 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) The SPI is a high-speed synchronous serial input/output port that allows a serial bit stream of programmed length (4 to 32 bits) to be shifted into and out of the device at a programmed bit-transfer rate. The SPI is normally used for communication between the device and external peripherals. Typical applications include an interface-to-external I/O or peripheral expansion via devices such as shift registers, display drivers, SPI EEPROMs, and Analog-to-Digital Converters (ADCs). The SPI supports the following features: • Master/Slave operation • Four chip selects for interfacing/control to up to four SPI Slave devices and connection to a single external Master • 32-bit shift register • Buffered receive/transmit data register per channel (1 word deep), FIFO size is 64 bytes • Programmable SPI configuration per channel (clock definition, enable polarity and word width) • Supports one interrupt request and two DMA requests per channel. For more detailed information on the SPI, see the Multichannel Serial Port Interface (McSPI) chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.17.1 SPI Peripheral Register Descriptions The SPI peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 261 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.17.2 SPI Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-79. Timing Requirements for SPI - Master Mode (see Figure 8-89 and Figure 8-90) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN UNIT MAX MASTER: SPI0, SPI1, SPI2 (M0) and SPI3 (M0)1 LOAD AT A MAXIMUM OF 5 pF 1 tc(SPICLK) Cycle time, SPI_CLK (1) (2) (1) 2 tw(SPICLKL) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK low 3 tw(SPICLKH) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK high (1) 4 tsu(MISO-SPICLK) Setup time, SPI_D[x] valid before SPI_CLK active edge (1) 5 th(SPICLK-MISO) Hold time, SPI_D[x] valid after SPI_CLK active edge (1) 4 2.67 ns 3.57 ns Delay time, SPI_SCS[x] active edge to SPI_D[x] transition td(SPICLK-SCS) ns 3.57 Delay time, SPI_CLK active edge to SPI_D[x] transition 9 ns (1) td(SCS-MOSI) Delay time, SPI_CLK last edge to SPI_SCS[x] inactive (1) ns 2.29 td(SPICLK-MOSI) Delay time, SPI_SCS[x] active to SPI_CLK first edge (1) ns 0.5*P - 1 (4) SPI2, SPI3 7 td(SCS-SPICLK) ns 0.5*P - 1 (4) SPI0, SPI1 6 8 20.8 (3) MASTER_PH A0 (5) B-4.2 (6) ns MASTER_PH A1 (5) A-4.2 (7) ns MASTER_PH A0 (5) A-4.2 (7) ns MASTER_PH A1 (5) B-4.2 (6) ns MASTER: SPI0, SPI1, SPI2 (M0) and SPI3 (M0) LOAD AT MAX 25pF MASTER: SPI2 (M1, M2, M3) and SPI3 (M1, M2, M3) 1 to 4 LOAD AT 5 to 25pF 1 2 3 tc(SPICLK) tw(SPICLKL) Cycle time, SPI_CLK (1) (2) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK low (1) (1) tw(SPICLKH) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK high 4 tsu(MISO-SPICLK) Setup time, SPI_D[x] valid before SPI_CLK active edge (1) 5 th(SPICLK-MISO) Hold time, SPI_D[x] valid after SPI_CLK active edge (1) SPI2, SPI3 6 Delay time, SPI_CLK active edge to SPI_D[x] transition Delay time, SPI_SCS[x] active edge to SPI_D[x] transition 9 (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) 262 td(SPICLK-SCS) ns 3.8 (1) td(SCS-MOSI) Delay time, SPI_CLK last edge to SPI_SCS[x] inactive (1) ns 4 td(SPICLK-MOSI) Delay time, SPI_SCS[x] active to SPI_CLK first edge (1) ns (4) 0.5*P - 2 7 td(SCS-SPICLK) ns 0.5*P - 2 (4) SPI0, SPI1 6 8 41.7 (8) -5.5 ns 5.5 ns 5.5 ns MASTER_PH A0 (5) B-3.5 (6) ns MASTER_PH A1 (5) A-3.5 (7) ns MASTER_PH A0 (5) A-3.5 (7) ns MASTER_PH A1 (5) B-3.5 (6) ns This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. Related to the SPI_CLK maximum frequency. Maximum frequency = 48 MHz P = SPICLK period. SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. B = (TCS + 0.5) * TSPICLKREF * Fratio, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register and Fratio = Even ≥2. When P = 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 1) * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. When P > 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 0.5) * Fratio * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. Maximum frequency = 24 MHz Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 PHA=0 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (Out) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (Out) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (Out) 6 7 SPI_D[x] (Out) Bit n-1 6 Bit n-3 Bit n-2 Bit 0 Bit n-4 PHA=1 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (Out) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (Out) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (Out) 6 SPI_D[x] (Out) Bit n-1 6 Bit n-2 6 Bit n-3 6 Bit 1 Bit 0 Figure 8-89. SPI Master Mode Transmit Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 263 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com PHA=0 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (Out) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (Out) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (Out) 4 4 5 SPI_D[x] (In) 5 Bit n-1 Bit n-3 Bit n-2 Bit 0 Bit n-4 PHA=1 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (Out) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (Out) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (Out) 4 4 5 SPI_D[x] (In) Bit n-1 5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 0 Bit 1 Figure 8-90. SPI Master Mode Receive Timing Table 8-80. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode (see Figure 8-91 and Figure 8-92) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o NO. MIN 1 tc(SPICLK) Cycle time, SPI_CLK (1) (2) (1) 2 tw(SPICLKL) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK low 3 tw(SPICLKH) Pulse duration, SPI_CLK high (1) (1) 62.5 (3) ns 0.5*P - 3 (4) ns 0.5*P - 3 (4) ns 12.92 ns 4 tsu(MOSI-SPICLK) Setup time, SPI_D[x] valid before SPI_CLK active edge 5 th(SPICLK-MOSI) Hold time, SPI_D[x] valid after SPI_CLK active edge (1) 12.92 6 td(SPICLK-MISO) Delay time, SPI_CLK active edge to SPI_D[x] transition (1) -4.00 7 td(SCS-MISO) Delay time, SPI_SCS[x] active edge to SPI_D[x] transition (5) (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) 264 UNIT MAX ns 17.1 ns 17.1 ns This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. Related to the input maximum frequency supported by the SPI module. Maximum frequency = 16 MHz P = SPICLK period. PHA = 0; SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 Table 8-80. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode (continued) (see Figure 8-91 and Figure 8-92) OPP100/OPP120/Turbo/Nitr o NO. MIN 8 9 tsu(SCS-SPICLK) th(SPICLK-SCS) Setup time, SPI_SCS[x] valid before SPI_CLK first edge (1) Hold time, SPI_SCS[x] valid after SPI_CLK last edge (1) UNIT MAX 12.92 ns 12.92 ns PHA=0 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (In) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (In) 2 9 POL=0 1 3 2 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (In) SPI_D[x] (Out) 6 7 6 Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 0 Bit n-4 PHA=1 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (In) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (In) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (In) 6 SPI_D[x] (Out) Bit n-1 6 6 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 6 Bit 1 Bit 0 Figure 8-91. SPI Slave Mode Transmit Timing Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 265 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com PHA=0 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (In) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (In) 2 9 POL=0 1 3 2 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (In) 4 4 5 SPI_D[x] (In) 5 Bit n-1 Bit n-3 Bit n-2 Bit 0 Bit n-4 PHA=1 EPOL=1 SPI_SCS[x] (In) 1 3 8 SPI_SCLK (In) 9 2 POL=0 1 2 3 POL=1 SPI_SCLK (In) 4 5 SPI_D[x] (In) Bit n-1 4 5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit 0 Figure 8-92. SPI Slave Mode Receive Timing 266 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.18 Timers The device has eight 32-bit general-purpose (GP) timers (TIMER8 - TIMER1) that have the following features: • TIMER8, TIMER1 are for software use and do not have an external connection • Dedicated input trigger for capture mode and dedicated output trigger/pulse width modulation (PWM) signal • Interrupts generated on overflow, compare, and capture • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • Supported modes: – Compare and capture modes – Auto-reload mode – Start-stop mode • TIMER[8:1] functional clock is sourced from either the DEVOSC, AUXOSC, AUD_CLK2/1/0, TCLKIN, or SYSCLK18 27 MHz as selected by the timer clock multiplexers. • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) • Generates interrupts to the ARM and Media Controller. The device has one system watchdog timer that have the following features: • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) • Reset upon occurrence of a timer overflow condition • The system watchdog timer has two possible clock sources: – RCOSC32K oscillator – RTCDIVIDER • The watchdog timer is used to provide a recovery mechanism for the device in the event of a fault condition, such as a non-exiting code loop. For more detailed information on the GP and Watchdog Timers, see the Timers and Watchdog Timer chapters in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.18.1 Timer Peripheral Register Descriptions The Timer peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 267 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.18.2 Timer Electrical/Data Timing Table 8-81. Timing Requirements for Timer (see Figure 8-93) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. MIN 1 tw(EVTIH) 2 (1) tw(EVTIL) Pulse duration, high Pulse duration, low UNIT MAX 4P (1) ns (1) ns 4P P = module clock. Table 8-82. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for Timer (see Figure 8-93) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN UNIT MAX 3 tw(EVTOH) Pulse duration, high 4P-3 (1) ns 4 tw(EVTOL) Pulse duration, low 4P-3 (1) ns (1) P = module clock. 1 2 TCLKIN 3 4 TIMx_IO Figure 8-93. Timer Timing 268 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.19 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) The UART performs serial-to-parallel conversions on data received from a peripheral device and parallelto-serial conversion on data received from the CPU. The device provides up to three UART peripheral interfaces, depending on the selected pin multiplexing. Each UART has the following features: • Selectable UART/IrDA (SIR/MIR)/CIR modes • Dual 64-entry FIFOs for received and transmitted data payload • Programmable and selectable transmit and receive FIFO trigger levels for DMA and interrupt generation • Baud-rate generation based upon programmable divisors N (N=1…16384) • Two DMA requests and one interrupt request to the system • Can connect to any RS-232 compliant device. UART functions include: • Baud-rate up to 3.6 Mbit/s on UART0, UART1, and UART2 • Programmable serial interfaces characteristics – 5, 6, 7, or 8-bit characters – Even, odd, or no parity-bit generation and detection – 1, 1.5, or 2 stop-bit generation – Flow control: hardware (RTS/CTS) or software (XON/XOFF) • Additional modem control functions (UART0_DTR, UART0_DSR, UART0_DCD, and UART0_RIN) for UART0 only; UART1 and UART2 do not support full-flow control signaling. IR-IrDA functions include: • Support of IrDA 1.4 slow infrared (SIR, baud-rate up to 115.2 Kbits/s), medium infrared (MIR, baudrate up to 1.152 Mbits/s) and fast infrared (FIR baud-rate up to 4.0 Mbits/s) communications • Supports framing error, cyclic redundancy check (CRC) error, illegal symbol (FIR), and abort pattern (SIR, MIR) detection • 8-entry status FIFO (with selectable trigger levels) available to monitor frame length and frame errors. IR-CIR functions include: • Consumer infrared (CIR) remote control mode with programmable data encoding • Free data format (supports any remote control private standards) • Selectable bit rate and configurable carrier frequency. For more detailed information on the UART peripheral, see the UART/IrDA/CIR Module chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.19.1 UART Peripheral Register Descriptions The UART peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 269 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.19.2 UART Electrical/Data Timing Table 8-83. Timing Requirements for UART (see Figure 8-94) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. 4 (1) (2) MAX Pulse width, receive data bit, 15/30/100pF high or low 0.96U (1) 1.05U (1) ns tw(CTS) Pulse width, receive start bit, 15/30/100pF high or low (1) (1) ns td(RTS-TX) Delay time, transmit start bit to transmit data P (2) ns td(CTS-TX) Delay time, receive start bit to transmit data P (2) ns tw(RX) 5 UNIT MIN 0.96U 1.05U U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate P = Clock period of the reference clock (FCLK, usually 48 MHz). Table 8-84. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for UART (see Figure 8-94) NO. OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro PARAMETER MIN f(baud) 2 3 (1) tw(TX) tw(RTS) Maximum programmable baud rate UNIT MAX 15 pF 5 30 pF 0.23 100 pF 0.115 MHz Pulse width, transmit data bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low U - 2 (1) U + 2 (1) ns Pulse width, transmit start bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low (1) (1) ns U-2 U+2 U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate 3 2 UARTx_TXD Start Bit Data Bits 5 4 UARTx_RXD Start Bit Data Bits Figure 8-94. UART Timing 270 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 8.20 Universal Serial Bus (USB2.0) The device includes two USB2.0 modules which support the Universal Serial Bus Specification Revision 2.0. The following are some of the major USB features that are supported: • USB 2.0 peripheral at high speed (HS: 480 Mbps) and full speed (FS: 12 Mbps) • USB 2.0 host at HS, FS, and low speed (LS: 1.5 Mbps) • Each endpoint (other than endpoint 0, control only) can support all transfer modes (control, bulk, interrupt, and isochronous) • Supports high-bandwidth ISO mode • Supports 15 Transmit (TX) and 15 Receive (RX) endpoints including endpoint 0 • FIFO RAM – 32K endpoint – Programmable size • Includes two integrated PHYs • RNDIS-like mode for terminating RNDIS-type protocols without using short-packet termination for support of MSC applications. • USB Dual Role Device: Host Negotiation Protocol (HNP) The USB2.0 peripherals do not support the following features: • On-chip charge pump (VBUS Power must be generated external to the device.) • RNDIS mode acceleration for USB sizes that are not multiples of 64 bytes • Endpoint max USB packet sizes that do not conform to the USB 2.0 spec (for FS/LS: 8, 16, 32, 64, – and 1023 are defined; for HS: 64, 128, 512, and 1024 are defined • USB OTG extension: Session Request Protocol (SRP) For more detailed information on the USB2.0 peripheral, see the Universal Serial Bus (USB) chapter in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. 8.20.1 USB2.0 Peripheral Register Descriptions The USB peripheral registers are described in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. Each register is documented as an offset from a base address for the peripheral. The base addresses for all of the peripherals are in the device memory map (see Section 2.10). Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 271 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 8.20.2 USB2.0 Electrical Data/Timing Table 8-85. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for USB2.0 (see Figure 8-95) OPP100/OPP120/ Turbo/Nitro NO. PARAMETER LOW SPEED 1.5 Mbps (1) FULL SPEED 12 Mbps HIGH SPEED 480 Mbps MIN MAX MIN MAX MIN 1 tr(D) Rise time, USBx_DP and USBx_DM signals 75 300 4 20 0.5 2 tf(D) Fall time, USBx_DP and USBx_DM signals (1) 75 300 4 20 0.5 3 trfM Rise/Fall time, matching (2) 80 125 90 111 – 1.3 2 1.3 2 – (1) 4 VCRS Output signal cross-over voltage 5 tjr(source)NT Source (Host) Driver jitter, next transition tjr(FUNC)NT Function Driver jitter, next transition tjr(source)PT Source (Host) Driver jitter, paired transition (4) 6 tjr(FUNC)PT Function Driver jitter, paired transition 7 tw(EOPT) Pulse duration, EOP transmitter 1250 8 tw(EOPR) Pulse duration, EOP receiver (5) 670 9 t(DRATE) Data Rate 10 ZDRV Driver Output Resistance 11 ZINP Receiver Input Impedance (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) ns ns – % – V 2 (3) ns 25 2 (3) ns 1 1 (3) ns 1 (3) ns – ns 1500 160 175 82 – – – 1.5 300 MAX 2 10 – UNIT 12 ns 480 Mb/s 28 49.5 40.5 49.5 Ω 300 – – – kΩ Low Speed: CL = 200 pF, Full Speed: CL = 50 pF, High Speed: CL = 50 pF tRFM = (tr/tf) x 100. [Excluding the first transaction from the Idle state.] For more detailed information, see the Universal Serial Bus Specification Revision 2.0, Chapter 7, Electrical. tjr = tpx(1) - tpx(0) Must accept as valid EOP. USBx_DM VCRS USBx_DP t per − t jr 90% VOH 10% VOL tr tf Figure 8-95. USB2.0 Integrated Transceiver Interface Timing For more detailed information on USB2.0 board design, routing, and layout guidelines, see the USB 2.0 Board Design and Layout Guidelines Application Report (Literature Number: SPRAAR7). 272 Peripheral Information and Timings Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 9 Device and Documentation Support 9.1 9.1.1 Device Support Development Support TI offers an extensive line of development tools, including tools to evaluate the performance of the processors, generate code, develop algorithm implementations, and fully integrate and debug software and hardware modules. The tool's support documentation is electronically available within the Code Composer Studio™ Integrated Development Environment (IDE). The following products support development of DM385 processor applications: Software Development Tools: Code Composer Studio™ Integrated Development Environment (IDE): including Editor C/C++/Assembly Code Generation, and Debug plus additional development tools Scalable, Real-Time Foundation Software ( Device/BIOS™), which provides the basic run-time target software needed to support any DM385 processor application. Reference Design Kits: Production ready reference kits including hardware collaterals and software, for a faster time-to-market. Hardware Development Tools: Extended Development System ( XDS™) Emulator For a complete listing of development-support tools for the DM385 processor platform, visit the Texas Instruments website at www.ti.com. For information on pricing and availability, contact the nearest TI field sales office or authorized distributor. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 273 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 9.1.2 www.ti.com Device and Development Support-Tool Nomenclature To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers of all MPUs and support tools. Each device has one of three prefixes: X, P, or null (no prefix). Texas Instruments recommends two of three possible prefix designators for its support tools: TMDX and TMDS. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes (TMDX) through fully qualified production devices/tools (TMDS). Device development evolutionary flow: X Pre-production device that is not necessarily representative of the final device's electrical specifications and may not use production assembly flow. P Prototype device that is not necessarily the final silicon die and may not necessarily meet final electrical specifications. null Production version of the silicon die that is fully qualified. Support tool development evolutionary flow: TMDX Development-support product that has not yet completed Texas Instruments internal qualification testing. TMDS Fully-qualified development-support product. X and P devices and TMDX development-support tools are shipped against the following disclaimer: "Developmental product is intended for internal evaluation purposes." Production devices and TMDS development-support tools have been characterized fully, and the quality and reliability of the device have been demonstrated fully. TI's standard warranty applies. Predictions show that prototype devices (X or P) have a greater failure rate than the standard production devices. Texas Instruments recommends that these devices not be used in any production system because their expected end-use failure rate still is undefined. Only qualified production devices are to be used. 9.1.3 Device Nomenclature TI device nomenclature also includes a suffix with the device family name. This suffix indicates the package type (for example, AAR), the temperature range (for example, blank is the default commercial temperature range), and the device speed range (for example, 01 is the 720 MHz ARM device). Figure 9-1 provides a legend for reading the complete device name for any DM385 device. For device part numbers and further ordering information of DM385 devices in the AAR package type, see the TI website (www.ti.com) or contact your TI sales representative. 274 Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 DM385, DM388 www.ti.com SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 ( ) DM385 ( ) AAR ( ) ( ) ( ) ( ) PCIe Blank = Enabled on DM385, Disabled on DM388 P = Enabled on DM388 PREFIX Blank = Production Device (TMS) X = Pre-production Device P = Prototype Device Face Detect Blank = Disabled F = Enabled DEVICE DM38x DaVinci™ Digital Media Processors DM385 DM388 DEVICE SPEED RANGE 01 = 720-MHz ARM, 290-MHz HDVICP2 11 = 970-MHz ARM, 410-MHz HDVICP2 21 = 1000-MHz ARM, 450-MHz HDVICP2 TEMPERATURE RANGE Blank = 0°C to 95°C, Commercial Temperature D = -40°C to 95°C, Extended Temperature SILICON REVISION Blank = Revision 1.0 A = Revision 1.1 (A) PACKAGE TYPE AAR = 609-Pin Plastic BGA, with Pb-Free Die Bump and Solder Ball Figure 9-1. Device Nomenclature 9.2 Documentation Support Contact your TI sales representative for support documents. For additional peripheral information, see the latest version of the DM38x DaVinci™ Digital Media Processor Technical Reference Manual (Literature Number: SPRUHG1). 9.3 Community Resources The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. TI E2E Community TI's Engineer-to-Engineer (E2E) Community. Created to foster collaboration among engineers. At e2e.ti.com, you can ask questions, share knowledge, explore ideas and help solve problems with fellow engineers. TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help developers get started with Embedded Processors from Texas Instruments and to foster innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding these devices. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 275 DM385, DM388 SPRS821D – MARCH 2013 – REVISED DECEMBER 2013 www.ti.com 10 Mechanical Table 10-1 shows the thermal resistance characteristics for the PBGA–AAR mechanical package. The device package has been specially engineered with a new technology called Via Channel™, allowing 0.8 mm PCB design rules to be employed. This allows larger than normal PCB via and trace sizes and reduced PCB signal layers to be used in a PCB design with this 0.5 mm pitch package, and will substantially reduce PCB costs. It also allows PCB routing in only two signal layers (four layers total deleted) due to the increased layer efficiency of the Via Channel™ BGA technology. 10.1 Thermal Data for the AAR Table 10-1. Thermal Resistance Characteristics (PBGA Package) [AAR] ΘJA/JMA Junction-to-air/ Junction-to-moving air PsiJT Junction-to-package top PsiJB Junction-to-board Air Flow (m/s) (1) ºC/W (2) still air 17.79 1.0 m/s 13.36 2.0 m/s 12.54 3.0 m/s 12.04 still air 0.08 1.0 m/s 0.16 2.0 m/s 0.20 3.0 m/s 0.23 still air 4.90 1.0 m/s 4.81 2.0 m/s 4.78 3.0 m/s 4.76 ΘJB Junction-to-board 4.86 ΘJC (1SOP board) Junction-to-case 3.84 (1) (2) m/s = meters per second. These measurements were conducted in a JEDEC defined 2S2P system (with the exception of the Theta JC [ΘJC] measurement, which was conducted in a JEDEC defined 1S0P system) and will change based on environment as well as application. For more information, see these EIA/JEDEC standards: • JESD51-2, Integrated Circuits Thermal Test Method Environment Conditions - Natural Convection (Still Air). • JESD51-3, Low Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages. • JESD51-7, High Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages. • JESD51-9, Test Boards for Area Array Surface Mount Packages. 10.2 Packaging Information The following packaging information and addendum reflect the most current data available for the designated device(s). This data is subject to change without notice and without revision of this document. 276 Mechanical Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback Product Folder Links: DM385 DM388 PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 22-Nov-2013 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) DM385AAAR01 ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR01 DM385AAAR01F ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR01F DM385AAAR11 ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR11 DM385AAAR11F ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR11F DM385AAAR21 ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR21 DM385AAAR21F ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAAR21F DM385AAARD21F ACTIVE FCBGA AAR 609 90 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR DM385AAARD21F XDM385AAR01F PREVIEW FCBGA AAR 609 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR XDM385AAR01F XDM385AAR11F PREVIEW FCBGA AAR 609 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR XDM385AAR11F XDM385AAR21F PREVIEW FCBGA AAR 609 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-260C-168 HR XDM385AAR21F 90 (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) Addendum-Page 1 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 22-Nov-2013 (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. Addendum-Page 2 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2013, Texas Instruments Incorporated